28cc1f4d800ed589e7d5f2261b4ea8266f668f71
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
66 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
67 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
68 development.''
69 @end ifinfo
70
71 @titlepage
72 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
73 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
74 @sp 1
75 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
76 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
77 @page
78 @tex
79 {\parskip=0pt
80 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
81 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
82 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
83 }
84 @end tex
85
86 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
87 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
88 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
89 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
90 @sp 2
91 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
92 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
93 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
94 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
95
96 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
97 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
98 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
99 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
100 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
101 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
102
103 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
104 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
105 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
106 development.''
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
118 @value{GDBVN}.
119
120 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
121
122 @menu
123 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
124 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
125
126 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
127 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
128 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
129 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
130 * Stack:: Examining the stack
131 * Source:: Examining source files
132 * Data:: Examining data
133 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
134 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
135 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
136
137 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
138
139 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
140 * Altering:: Altering execution
141 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
142 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
143 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
144 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
145 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
146 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
147 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
148 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
149 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
151 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
152
153 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
155
156 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
157 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
158 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
159 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
160 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
161 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
162 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
163 how you can copy and share GDB
164 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
165 * Index:: Index
166 @end menu
167
168 @end ifnottex
169
170 @contents
171
172 @node Summary
173 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
174
175 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
176 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
177 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
178
179 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
180 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
181
182 @itemize @bullet
183 @item
184 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
185
186 @item
187 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
188
189 @item
190 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
191
192 @item
193 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
194 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
195 @end itemize
196
197 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
198 For more information, see @ref{Supported languages,,Supported languages}.
199 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
200
201 @cindex Modula-2
202 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
203 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
204
205 @cindex Pascal
206 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
207 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
208 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
209 syntax.
210
211 @cindex Fortran
212 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
213 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
214 underscore.
215
216 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
217 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
218
219 @menu
220 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
221 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
222 @end menu
223
224 @node Free Software
225 @unnumberedsec Free software
226
227 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
228 General Public License
229 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
230 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
231 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
232 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
233 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
234 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
235
236 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
237 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
238 from anyone else.
239
240 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
241
242 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
243 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
244 include with the free software. Many of our most important
245 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
246 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
247 when an important free software package does not come with a free
248 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
249 gaps today.
250
251 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
252 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
253 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
254 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
255 them from the free software world.
256
257 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
258 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
259 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
260 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
261 contract to make it non-free.
262
263 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
264 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
265 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
266 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
267 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
268 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
269 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
270
271 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
272 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
273 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
274 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
275
276 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
277 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
278 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
279 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
280 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
281 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
282 community.
283
284 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
285 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
286 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
287 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
288 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
289 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
290 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
291 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
292 of the manual.
293
294 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
295 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
296 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
297 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
298 manual to replace it.
299
300 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
301 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
302 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
303 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
304 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
305 the free software community.
306
307 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
308 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
309 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
310 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
311 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
312 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
313 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
314 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
315 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
316
317 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
318 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
319 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
320 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
321 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
322 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
323 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
324 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
325
326 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
327 published by other publishers, at
328 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
329
330 @node Contributors
331 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
332
333 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
334 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
335 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
336 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
337 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
338 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
339 blow-by-blow account.
340
341 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
342
343 @quotation
344 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
345 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
346 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
347 @end quotation
348
349 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
350 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
351 releases:
352 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
353 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
354 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
355 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
356 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
357 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
358 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
359 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
360 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
361
362 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
363 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
364
365 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
366 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
367 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
368 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
369 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
370
371 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
372 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
373 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
374
375 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
376 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
377
378 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
379
380 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
381 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
382 support.
383 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
384 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
385 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
386 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
387 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
388 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
389 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
390 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
391 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
392 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
393 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
394 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
395 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
396 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
397 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
398 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
399
400 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
401
402 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
403 libraries.
404
405 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
406 about several machine instruction sets.
407
408 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
409 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
410 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
411 and RDI targets, respectively.
412
413 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
414 command-line editing and command history.
415
416 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
417 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
418
419 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
420 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
421 symbols.
422
423 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
424 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
425
426 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
427
428 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
429 processors.
430
431 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
432
433 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
434
435 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
436
437 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
438 watchpoints.
439
440 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
441
442 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
443
444 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
445 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
446
447 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
448 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
449 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
450 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
451 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
452 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
453 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
454
455 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
456 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
457
458 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
459 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
460 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
461 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
462 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
463 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
464 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
465 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
466 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
467 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
468 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
469 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
470 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
471 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
472 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
473
474 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
475 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
476
477 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
478 Hat.
479
480 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
481 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
482 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
483 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
484 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
485 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
486
487 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
488 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
489 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
490 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
491 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
492 trad unwinders. The architecture specific changes, each involving a
493 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
494 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
495 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
496 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
497 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
498 Weigand.
499
500 @node Sample Session
501 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
502
503 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
504 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
505 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
506
507 @iftex
508 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
509 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
510 @end iftex
511
512 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
513 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
514
515 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
516 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
517 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
518 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
519 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
520 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
521 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
522 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
523 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
524
525 @smallexample
526 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
527 $ @b{./m4}
528 @b{define(foo,0000)}
529
530 @b{foo}
531 0000
532 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
533
534 @b{bar}
535 0000
536 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
537
538 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
539 @b{baz}
540 @b{Ctrl-d}
541 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
542 @end smallexample
543
544 @noindent
545 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
546
547 @smallexample
548 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
549 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
550 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
551 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
552 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
553 the conditions.
554 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
555 for details.
556
557 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
558 (@value{GDBP})
559 @end smallexample
560
561 @noindent
562 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
563 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
564 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
565 that examples fit in this manual.
566
567 @smallexample
568 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
569 @end smallexample
570
571 @noindent
572 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
573 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
574 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
575 @code{break} command.
576
577 @smallexample
578 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
579 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
580 @end smallexample
581
582 @noindent
583 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
584 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
585 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
586
587 @smallexample
588 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
589 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
590 @b{define(foo,0000)}
591
592 @b{foo}
593 0000
594 @end smallexample
595
596 @noindent
597 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
598 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
599 context where it stops.
600
601 @smallexample
602 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
603
604 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
605 at builtin.c:879
606 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
607 @end smallexample
608
609 @noindent
610 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
611 the next line of the current function.
612
613 @smallexample
614 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
615 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
616 : nil,
617 @end smallexample
618
619 @noindent
620 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
621 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
622 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
623 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
624
625 @smallexample
626 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
627 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
628 at input.c:530
629 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
630 @end smallexample
631
632 @noindent
633 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
634 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
635 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
636 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
637 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
638 stack frame for each active subroutine.
639
640 @smallexample
641 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
642 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
643 at input.c:530
644 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
645 at builtin.c:882
646 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
647 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
648 at macro.c:71
649 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
650 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
655 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
656 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
657
658 @smallexample
659 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
660 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
661 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
662 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
663 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
665 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
666 : xstrdup(rq);
667 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
668 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
669 @end smallexample
670
671 @noindent
672 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
673 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
674 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
675 (@code{print}) to see their values.
676
677 @smallexample
678 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
679 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
681 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
682 @end smallexample
683
684 @noindent
685 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
686 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
687 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
688
689 @smallexample
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
691 533 xfree(rquote);
692 534
693 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
694 : xstrdup (lq);
695 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
696 : xstrdup (rq);
697 537
698 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
699 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
700 540 @}
701 541
702 542 void
703 @end smallexample
704
705 @noindent
706 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
707 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
708
709 @smallexample
710 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
711 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
712 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
713 540 @}
714 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
715 $3 = 9
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
717 $4 = 7
718 @end smallexample
719
720 @noindent
721 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
722 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
723 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
724 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
725 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
726 assignments.
727
728 @smallexample
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
730 $5 = 7
731 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
732 $6 = 9
733 @end smallexample
734
735 @noindent
736 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
737 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
738 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
739 example that caused trouble initially:
740
741 @smallexample
742 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
743 Continuing.
744
745 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
746
747 baz
748 0000
749 @end smallexample
750
751 @noindent
752 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
753 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
754 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
755
756 @smallexample
757 @b{Ctrl-d}
758 Program exited normally.
759 @end smallexample
760
761 @noindent
762 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
763 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
764 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
765
766 @smallexample
767 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
768 @end smallexample
769
770 @node Invocation
771 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
772
773 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
774 The essentials are:
775 @itemize @bullet
776 @item
777 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
778 @item
779 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
780 @end itemize
781
782 @menu
783 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
784 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
785 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
786 * Logging output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
787 @end menu
788
789 @node Invoking GDB
790 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
791
792 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
793 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
794
795 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
796 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
797
798 The command-line options described here are designed
799 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
800 options may effectively be unavailable.
801
802 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
803 specifying an executable program:
804
805 @smallexample
806 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
807 @end smallexample
808
809 @noindent
810 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
811 specified:
812
813 @smallexample
814 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
815 @end smallexample
816
817 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
818 to debug a running process:
819
820 @smallexample
821 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
822 @end smallexample
823
824 @noindent
825 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
826 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
827
828 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
829 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
830 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
831 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
832 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
833
834 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
835 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
836 option processing.
837 @smallexample
838 gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
839 @end smallexample
840 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
841 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
842
843 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
844 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
845
846 @smallexample
847 @value{GDBP} -silent
848 @end smallexample
849
850 @noindent
851 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
852 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
853
854 @noindent
855 Type
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} -help
859 @end smallexample
860
861 @noindent
862 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
863 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
864
865 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
866 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
867 @samp{-x} option is used.
868
869
870 @menu
871 * File Options:: Choosing files
872 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
873 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
874 @end menu
875
876 @node File Options
877 @subsection Choosing files
878
879 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
880 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
881 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
882 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
883 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
884 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
885 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
886 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
887 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
888 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
889 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
890 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
891 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
892
893 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
894 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
895 argument and ignore it.
896
897 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
898 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
899 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
900 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
901 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
902
903 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
904 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
905 @c it.
906
907 @table @code
908 @item -symbols @var{file}
909 @itemx -s @var{file}
910 @cindex @code{--symbols}
911 @cindex @code{-s}
912 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
913
914 @item -exec @var{file}
915 @itemx -e @var{file}
916 @cindex @code{--exec}
917 @cindex @code{-e}
918 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
919 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
920
921 @item -se @var{file}
922 @cindex @code{--se}
923 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
924 file.
925
926 @item -core @var{file}
927 @itemx -c @var{file}
928 @cindex @code{--core}
929 @cindex @code{-c}
930 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
931
932 @item -c @var{number}
933 @item -pid @var{number}
934 @itemx -p @var{number}
935 @cindex @code{--pid}
936 @cindex @code{-p}
937 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
938 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
939 file named @var{number}.
940
941 @item -command @var{file}
942 @itemx -x @var{file}
943 @cindex @code{--command}
944 @cindex @code{-x}
945 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
946 Files,, Command files}.
947
948 @item -eval-command @var{command}
949 @itemx -ex @var{command}
950 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
951 @cindex @code{-ex}
952 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
953
954 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
955 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
956
957 @smallexample
958 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
959 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
960 @end smallexample
961
962 @item -directory @var{directory}
963 @itemx -d @var{directory}
964 @cindex @code{--directory}
965 @cindex @code{-d}
966 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
967
968 @item -r
969 @itemx -readnow
970 @cindex @code{--readnow}
971 @cindex @code{-r}
972 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
973 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
974 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
975
976 @end table
977
978 @node Mode Options
979 @subsection Choosing modes
980
981 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
982 batch mode or quiet mode.
983
984 @table @code
985 @item -nx
986 @itemx -n
987 @cindex @code{--nx}
988 @cindex @code{-n}
989 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
990 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
991 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
992 files}.
993
994 @item -quiet
995 @itemx -silent
996 @itemx -q
997 @cindex @code{--quiet}
998 @cindex @code{--silent}
999 @cindex @code{-q}
1000 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1001 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1002
1003 @item -batch
1004 @cindex @code{--batch}
1005 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1006 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1007 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1008 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1009 in the command files.
1010
1011 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1012 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1013 make this more useful, the message
1014
1015 @smallexample
1016 Program exited normally.
1017 @end smallexample
1018
1019 @noindent
1020 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1021 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1022 mode.
1023
1024 @item -batch-silent
1025 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1026 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1027 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1028 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1029 for an interactive session.
1030
1031 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1032 messages, for example.
1033
1034 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1035 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1036
1037 @item -return-child-result
1038 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1039 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1040 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1041
1042 @itemize @bullet
1043 @item
1044 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1045 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1046 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1047 @item
1048 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1049 @item
1050 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1051 the exit code will be -1.
1052 @end itemize
1053
1054 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1055 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1056 interface.
1057
1058 @item -nowindows
1059 @itemx -nw
1060 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1061 @cindex @code{-nw}
1062 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1063 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1064 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1065
1066 @item -windows
1067 @itemx -w
1068 @cindex @code{--windows}
1069 @cindex @code{-w}
1070 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1071 used if possible.
1072
1073 @item -cd @var{directory}
1074 @cindex @code{--cd}
1075 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1076 instead of the current directory.
1077
1078 @item -fullname
1079 @itemx -f
1080 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1081 @cindex @code{-f}
1082 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1083 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1084 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1085 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1086 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1087 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1088 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1089 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1090 frame.
1091
1092 @item -epoch
1093 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1094 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1095 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1096 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1097 separate window.
1098
1099 @item -annotate @var{level}
1100 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1101 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1102 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1103 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1104 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1105 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1106 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1107 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1108 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1109
1110 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1111 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1112
1113 @item --args
1114 @cindex @code{--args}
1115 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1116 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1117 This option stops option processing.
1118
1119 @item -baud @var{bps}
1120 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1121 @cindex @code{--baud}
1122 @cindex @code{-b}
1123 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1124 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1125
1126 @item -l @var{timeout}
1127 @cindex @code{-l}
1128 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1129 for remote debugging.
1130
1131 @item -tty @var{device}
1132 @itemx -t @var{device}
1133 @cindex @code{--tty}
1134 @cindex @code{-t}
1135 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1136 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1137
1138 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1139 @item -tui
1140 @cindex @code{--tui}
1141 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1142 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1143 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1144 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1145 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1146 @samp{gdbtui}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1147 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1148
1149 @c @item -xdb
1150 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1151 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1152 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1153 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1154 @c systems.
1155
1156 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1157 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1158 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1159 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1160 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1161 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1162
1163 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1164 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1165 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1166 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1167 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1168 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1169
1170 @item -write
1171 @cindex @code{--write}
1172 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1173 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1174 (@pxref{Patching}).
1175
1176 @item -statistics
1177 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1178 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1179 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1180
1181 @item -version
1182 @cindex @code{--version}
1183 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1184 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1185
1186 @end table
1187
1188 @node Startup
1189 @subsection What @value{GDBN} does during startup
1190 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1191
1192 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1193
1194 @enumerate
1195 @item
1196 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1197 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1198
1199 @item
1200 @cindex init file
1201 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1202 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1203 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1204 that file.
1205
1206 @item
1207 Processes command line options and operands.
1208
1209 @item
1210 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1211 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1212 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1213 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1214 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1215 @value{GDBN}.
1216
1217 @item
1218 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1219 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1220
1221 @item
1222 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1223 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1224 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1225 @end enumerate
1226
1227 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1228 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1229 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1230 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1231 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1232 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
1233
1234 @cindex init file name
1235 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1236 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1237 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
1238 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
1239 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
1240 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
1241 environments with special init file names:
1242
1243 @itemize @bullet
1244 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1245 @item
1246 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1247 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1248 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1249 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1250 the file to the standard name.
1251
1252 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
1253 @item
1254 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
1255
1256 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
1257 @item
1258 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
1259
1260 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
1261 @item
1262 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
1263
1264 @item
1265 CISCO 68k: @file{.cisco-gdbinit}
1266 @end itemize
1267
1268
1269 @node Quitting GDB
1270 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1271 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1272 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1273
1274 @table @code
1275 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1276 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1277 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1278 @itemx q
1279 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1280 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1281 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1282 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1283 error code.
1284 @end table
1285
1286 @cindex interrupt
1287 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1288 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1289 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1290 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1291 until a time when it is safe.
1292
1293 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1294 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1295 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1296
1297 @node Shell Commands
1298 @section Shell commands
1299
1300 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1301 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1302 just use the @code{shell} command.
1303
1304 @table @code
1305 @kindex shell
1306 @cindex shell escape
1307 @item shell @var{command string}
1308 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1309 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1310 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1311 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1312 @end table
1313
1314 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1315 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1316 @value{GDBN}:
1317
1318 @table @code
1319 @kindex make
1320 @cindex calling make
1321 @item make @var{make-args}
1322 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1323 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1324 @end table
1325
1326 @node Logging output
1327 @section Logging output
1328 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1329 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1330
1331 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1332 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1333
1334 @table @code
1335 @kindex set logging
1336 @item set logging on
1337 Enable logging.
1338 @item set logging off
1339 Disable logging.
1340 @cindex logging file name
1341 @item set logging file @var{file}
1342 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1343 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1344 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1345 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1346 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1347 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1348 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1349 @kindex show logging
1350 @item show logging
1351 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1352 @end table
1353
1354 @node Commands
1355 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1356
1357 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1358 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1359 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1360 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1361 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1362
1363 @menu
1364 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1365 * Completion:: Command completion
1366 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1367 @end menu
1368
1369 @node Command Syntax
1370 @section Command syntax
1371
1372 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1373 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1374 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1375 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1376 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1377 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1378
1379 @cindex abbreviation
1380 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1381 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1382 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1383 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1384 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1385 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1386 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1387
1388 @cindex repeating commands
1389 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1390 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1391 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1392 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1393 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1394 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1395 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1396
1397 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1398 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1399 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1400
1401 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1402 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1403 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1404 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1405 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1406
1407 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1408 @cindex comment
1409 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1410 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1411 Files,,Command files}).
1412
1413 @cindex repeating command sequences
1414 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1415 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1416 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1417 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1418 for editing.
1419
1420 @node Completion
1421 @section Command completion
1422
1423 @cindex completion
1424 @cindex word completion
1425 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1426 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1427 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1428 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1429
1430 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1431 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1432 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1433 enter it). For example, if you type
1434
1435 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1436 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1437 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1438 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1439 @smallexample
1440 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1441 @end smallexample
1442
1443 @noindent
1444 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1445 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1446
1447 @smallexample
1448 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1449 @end smallexample
1450
1451 @noindent
1452 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1453 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1454 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1455 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1456 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1457 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1458
1459 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1460 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1461 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1462 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1463 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1464 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1465 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1466 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1467 example:
1468
1469 @smallexample
1470 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1471 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1472 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1473 make_abs_section make_function_type
1474 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1475 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1476 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1477 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1478 @end smallexample
1479
1480 @noindent
1481 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1482 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1483 command.
1484
1485 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1486 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1487 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1488 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1489 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1490
1491 @cindex quotes in commands
1492 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1493 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1494 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1495 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1496 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1497 @value{GDBN} commands.
1498
1499 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1500 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1501 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1502 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1503 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1504 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1505 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1506 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1507 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1508 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1509 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1510
1511 @smallexample
1512 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1513 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1514 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1515 @end smallexample
1516
1517 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1518 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1519 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1520 place:
1521
1522 @smallexample
1523 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1524 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1525 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1526 @end smallexample
1527
1528 @noindent
1529 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1530 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1531 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1532
1533 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1534 expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1535 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1536 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1537
1538
1539 @node Help
1540 @section Getting help
1541 @cindex online documentation
1542 @kindex help
1543
1544 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1545 using the command @code{help}.
1546
1547 @table @code
1548 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1549 @item help
1550 @itemx h
1551 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1552 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1553
1554 @smallexample
1555 (@value{GDBP}) help
1556 List of classes of commands:
1557
1558 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1559 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1560 data -- Examining data
1561 files -- Specifying and examining files
1562 internals -- Maintenance commands
1563 obscure -- Obscure features
1564 running -- Running the program
1565 stack -- Examining the stack
1566 status -- Status inquiries
1567 support -- Support facilities
1568 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1569 stopping the program
1570 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1571
1572 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1573 commands in that class.
1574 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1575 documentation.
1576 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1577 (@value{GDBP})
1578 @end smallexample
1579 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1580
1581 @item help @var{class}
1582 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1583 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1584 help display for the class @code{status}:
1585
1586 @smallexample
1587 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1588 Status inquiries.
1589
1590 List of commands:
1591
1592 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1593 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1594 info -- Generic command for showing things
1595 about the program being debugged
1596 show -- Generic command for showing things
1597 about the debugger
1598
1599 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1600 documentation.
1601 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1602 (@value{GDBP})
1603 @end smallexample
1604
1605 @item help @var{command}
1606 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1607 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1608
1609 @kindex apropos
1610 @item apropos @var{args}
1611 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1612 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1613 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1614
1615 @smallexample
1616 apropos reload
1617 @end smallexample
1618
1619 @noindent
1620 results in:
1621
1622 @smallexample
1623 @c @group
1624 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1625 multiple times in one run
1626 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1627 multiple times in one run
1628 @c @end group
1629 @end smallexample
1630
1631 @kindex complete
1632 @item complete @var{args}
1633 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1634 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1635 command you want completed. For example:
1636
1637 @smallexample
1638 complete i
1639 @end smallexample
1640
1641 @noindent results in:
1642
1643 @smallexample
1644 @group
1645 if
1646 ignore
1647 info
1648 inspect
1649 @end group
1650 @end smallexample
1651
1652 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1653 @end table
1654
1655 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1656 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1657 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1658 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1659 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1660 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1661
1662 @c @group
1663 @table @code
1664 @kindex info
1665 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1666 @item info
1667 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1668 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1669 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1670 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1671 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1672 @w{@code{help info}}.
1673
1674 @kindex set
1675 @item set
1676 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1677 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1678 @code{set prompt $}.
1679
1680 @kindex show
1681 @item show
1682 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1683 @value{GDBN} itself.
1684 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1685 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1686 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1687 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1688
1689 @kindex info set
1690 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1691 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1692 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1693 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1694 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1695 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1696 @end table
1697 @c @end group
1698
1699 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1700 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1701
1702 @table @code
1703 @kindex show version
1704 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1705 @item show version
1706 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1707 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1708 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1709 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1710 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1711 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1712 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1713 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1714 @value{GDBN}.
1715
1716 @kindex show copying
1717 @kindex info copying
1718 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1719 @item show copying
1720 @itemx info copying
1721 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1722
1723 @kindex show warranty
1724 @kindex info warranty
1725 @item show warranty
1726 @itemx info warranty
1727 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1728 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1729
1730 @end table
1731
1732 @node Running
1733 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1734
1735 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1736 debugging information when you compile it.
1737
1738 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1739 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1740 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1741 kill a child process.
1742
1743 @menu
1744 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1745 * Starting:: Starting your program
1746 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1747 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1748
1749 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1750 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1751 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1752 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1753
1754 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1755 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1756 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1757 @end menu
1758
1759 @node Compilation
1760 @section Compiling for debugging
1761
1762 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1763 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1764 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1765 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1766 and addresses in the executable code.
1767
1768 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1769 the compiler.
1770
1771 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1772 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1773 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1774 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1775 executables containing debugging information.
1776
1777 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1778 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1779 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1780 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1781 in pushing your luck.
1782
1783 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1784 @cindex debugging optimized code
1785 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1786 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1787 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1788 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1789 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1790 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1791
1792 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1793 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1794 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1795 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1796 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1797
1798 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1799 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1800 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1801
1802 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1803 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1804 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1805 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1806 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1807 provides macro information if you specify the options
1808 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1809 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1810 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1811 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1812 @option{-g} alone.
1813
1814 @need 2000
1815 @node Starting
1816 @section Starting your program
1817 @cindex starting
1818 @cindex running
1819
1820 @table @code
1821 @kindex run
1822 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1823 @item run
1824 @itemx r
1825 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1826 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1827 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1828 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1829 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1830
1831 @end table
1832
1833 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1834 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1835 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1836 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1837
1838 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1839 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1840 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1841 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1842 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1843 divided into four categories:
1844
1845 @table @asis
1846 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1847 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1848 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1849 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1850 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1851 the arguments.
1852 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1853 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1854 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1855
1856 @item The @emph{environment.}
1857 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1858 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1859 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1860 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1861
1862 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1863 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1864 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1865 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1866
1867 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1868 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1869 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1870 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1871 set a different device for your program.
1872 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1873
1874 @cindex pipes
1875 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1876 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1877 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1878 wrong program.
1879 @end table
1880
1881 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1882 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1883 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1884 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1885 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1886
1887 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1888 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1889 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1890 your current breakpoints.
1891
1892 @table @code
1893 @kindex start
1894 @item start
1895 @cindex run to main procedure
1896 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1897 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1898 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1899 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1900 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1901 procedure, depending on the language used.
1902
1903 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1904 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1905 the @samp{run} command.
1906
1907 @cindex elaboration phase
1908 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1909 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1910 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1911 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1912 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1913 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1914 will remain to halt execution.
1915
1916 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1917 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1918 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1919 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1920 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1921
1922 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1923 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1924 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1925 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1926 elaboration code before running your program.
1927 @end table
1928
1929 @node Arguments
1930 @section Your program's arguments
1931
1932 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1933 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1934 @code{run} command.
1935 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1936 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1937 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1938 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1939 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1940
1941 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1942 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1943 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1944 the program, not by the shell.
1945
1946 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1947 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1948
1949 @table @code
1950 @kindex set args
1951 @item set args
1952 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1953 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1954 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1955 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1956 it again without arguments.
1957
1958 @kindex show args
1959 @item show args
1960 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1961 @end table
1962
1963 @node Environment
1964 @section Your program's environment
1965
1966 @cindex environment (of your program)
1967 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1968 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1969 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1970 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1971 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1972 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1973 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1974
1975 @table @code
1976 @kindex path
1977 @item path @var{directory}
1978 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1979 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1980 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1981 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1982 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1983 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1984 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1985
1986 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1987 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1988 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1989 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1990 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1991 @var{directory} to the search path.
1992 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1993 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1994
1995 @kindex show paths
1996 @item show paths
1997 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1998 environment variable).
1999
2000 @kindex show environment
2001 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2002 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2003 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2004 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2005 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2006
2007 @kindex set environment
2008 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2009 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2010 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2011 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2012 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2013 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2014 null value.
2015 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2016 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2017
2018 For example, this command:
2019
2020 @smallexample
2021 set env USER = foo
2022 @end smallexample
2023
2024 @noindent
2025 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2026 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2027 are not actually required.)
2028
2029 @kindex unset environment
2030 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2031 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2032 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2033 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2034 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2035 @end table
2036
2037 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2038 the shell indicated
2039 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2040 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2041 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2042 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2043 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2044 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2045 @file{.profile}.
2046
2047 @node Working Directory
2048 @section Your program's working directory
2049
2050 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2051 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2052 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2053 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2054 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2055 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2056
2057 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2058 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2059 specify files}.
2060
2061 @table @code
2062 @kindex cd
2063 @cindex change working directory
2064 @item cd @var{directory}
2065 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2066
2067 @kindex pwd
2068 @item pwd
2069 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2070 @end table
2071
2072 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2073 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2074 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2075 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2076 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2077 current working directory of the debuggee.
2078
2079 @node Input/Output
2080 @section Your program's input and output
2081
2082 @cindex redirection
2083 @cindex i/o
2084 @cindex terminal
2085 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2086 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2087 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2088 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2089 running your program.
2090
2091 @table @code
2092 @kindex info terminal
2093 @item info terminal
2094 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2095 program is using.
2096 @end table
2097
2098 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2099 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2100
2101 @smallexample
2102 run > outfile
2103 @end smallexample
2104
2105 @noindent
2106 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2107
2108 @kindex tty
2109 @cindex controlling terminal
2110 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2111 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2112 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2113 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2114 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2115
2116 @smallexample
2117 tty /dev/ttyb
2118 @end smallexample
2119
2120 @noindent
2121 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2122 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2123 that as their controlling terminal.
2124
2125 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2126 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2127 terminal.
2128
2129 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2130 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2131 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2132 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2133
2134 @cindex inferior tty
2135 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2136 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2137 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2138 program.
2139
2140 @table @code
2141 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2142 @kindex set inferior-tty
2143 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2144
2145 @item show inferior-tty
2146 @kindex show inferior-tty
2147 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2148 @end table
2149
2150 @node Attach
2151 @section Debugging an already-running process
2152 @kindex attach
2153 @cindex attach
2154
2155 @table @code
2156 @item attach @var{process-id}
2157 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2158 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2159 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2160 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2161 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2162
2163 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2164 executing the command.
2165 @end table
2166
2167 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2168 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2169 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2170 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2171
2172 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2173 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2174 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2175 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
2176 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2177 Specify Files}.
2178
2179 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2180 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2181 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2182 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2183 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2184 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2185 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2186
2187 @table @code
2188 @kindex detach
2189 @item detach
2190 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2191 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2192 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2193 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2194 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2195 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2196 executing the command.
2197 @end table
2198
2199 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
2200 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
2201 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
2202 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
2203 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
2204 messages}).
2205
2206 @node Kill Process
2207 @section Killing the child process
2208
2209 @table @code
2210 @kindex kill
2211 @item kill
2212 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2213 @end table
2214
2215 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2216 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2217 is running.
2218
2219 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2220 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2221 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2222 outside the debugger.
2223
2224 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2225 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2226 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2227 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2228 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2229 breakpoint settings).
2230
2231 @node Threads
2232 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
2233
2234 @cindex threads of execution
2235 @cindex multiple threads
2236 @cindex switching threads
2237 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2238 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2239 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2240 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2241 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2242 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2243 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2244
2245 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2246 programs:
2247
2248 @itemize @bullet
2249 @item automatic notification of new threads
2250 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2251 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2252 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2253 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2254 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2255 @end itemize
2256
2257 @quotation
2258 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2259 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2260 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2261 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2262 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2263 like this:
2264
2265 @smallexample
2266 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2267 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2268 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2269 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2270 @end smallexample
2271 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2272 @c doesn't support threads"?
2273 @end quotation
2274
2275 @cindex focus of debugging
2276 @cindex current thread
2277 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2278 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2279 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2280 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2281 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2282
2283 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2284 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2285 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2286 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2287 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2288 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2289 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2290 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2291 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2292 LynxOS, you might see
2293
2294 @smallexample
2295 [New process 35 thread 27]
2296 @end smallexample
2297
2298 @noindent
2299 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2300 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2301 further qualifier.
2302
2303 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2304 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2305 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2306 @c program?
2307 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2308 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2309 @c threads ab initio?
2310
2311 @cindex thread number
2312 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2313 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2314 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2315
2316 @table @code
2317 @kindex info threads
2318 @item info threads
2319 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2320 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2321
2322 @enumerate
2323 @item
2324 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2325
2326 @item
2327 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2328
2329 @item
2330 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2331 @end enumerate
2332
2333 @noindent
2334 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2335 indicates the current thread.
2336
2337 For example,
2338 @end table
2339 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2340
2341 @smallexample
2342 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2343 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2344 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2345 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2346 at threadtest.c:68
2347 @end smallexample
2348
2349 On HP-UX systems:
2350
2351 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2352 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2353 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2354 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2355 thread in your program.
2356
2357 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2358 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2359 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2360 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2361 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2362 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2363 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2364 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2365 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2366 HP-UX, you see
2367
2368 @smallexample
2369 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2370 @end smallexample
2371
2372 @noindent
2373 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2374
2375 @table @code
2376 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2377 @item info threads
2378 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2379 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2380
2381 @enumerate
2382 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2383
2384 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2385
2386 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2387 @end enumerate
2388
2389 @noindent
2390 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2391 indicates the current thread.
2392
2393 For example,
2394 @end table
2395 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2396
2397 @smallexample
2398 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2399 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2400 at quicksort.c:137
2401 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2402 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2403 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2404 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2405 @end smallexample
2406
2407 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2408 Solaris-specific command:
2409
2410 @table @code
2411 @item maint info sol-threads
2412 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2413 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2414 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2415 @end table
2416
2417 @table @code
2418 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2419 @item thread @var{threadno}
2420 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2421 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2422 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2423 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2424 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2425
2426 @smallexample
2427 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2428 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2429 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2430 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2431 @end smallexample
2432
2433 @noindent
2434 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2435 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2436 threads.
2437
2438 @kindex thread apply
2439 @cindex apply command to several threads
2440 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2441 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2442 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2443 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2444 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2445 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2446 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2447 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2448 @end table
2449
2450 @cindex automatic thread selection
2451 @cindex switching threads automatically
2452 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2453 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2454 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2455 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2456 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2457 thread.
2458
2459 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2460 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2461 programs with multiple threads.
2462
2463 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2464 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2465
2466 @node Processes
2467 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2468
2469 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2470 @cindex multiple processes
2471 @cindex processes, multiple
2472 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2473 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2474 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2475 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2476 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2477 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2478 will cause it to terminate.
2479
2480 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2481 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2482 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2483 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2484 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2485 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2486 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2487 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2488 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2489 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2490
2491 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2492 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2493 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2494 only?) and GNU/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2495
2496 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2497 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2498
2499 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2500 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2501
2502 @table @code
2503 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2504 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2505 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2506 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2507 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2508
2509 @table @code
2510 @item parent
2511 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2512 unimpeded. This is the default.
2513
2514 @item child
2515 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2516 unimpeded.
2517
2518 @end table
2519
2520 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2521 @item show follow-fork-mode
2522 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2523 @end table
2524
2525 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2526 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2527 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2528
2529 @table @code
2530 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2531 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2532 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2533 retain debugger control over them both.
2534
2535 @table @code
2536 @item on
2537 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2538 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2539 independently. This is the default.
2540
2541 @item off
2542 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2543 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2544 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2545 is held suspended.
2546
2547 @end table
2548
2549 @kindex show detach-on-follow
2550 @item show detach-on-follow
2551 Show whether detach-on-follow mode is on/off.
2552 @end table
2553
2554 If you choose to set @var{detach-on-follow} mode off, then
2555 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2556 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2557 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2558 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2559
2560 @table @code
2561 @kindex info forks
2562 @item info forks
2563 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2564 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2565 position (program counter) of the process.
2566
2567
2568 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2569 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2570 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2571 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2572 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2573
2574 @end table
2575
2576 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2577 from it by using the @w{@code{detach-fork}} command (allowing it to
2578 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2579 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2580
2581 @table @code
2582 @kindex detach-fork @var{fork-id}
2583 @item detach-fork @var{fork-id}
2584 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2585 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2586 allowed to run independently.
2587
2588 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2589 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2590 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2591 and remove it from the fork list.
2592
2593 @end table
2594
2595 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2596 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2597 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2598 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2599 the child process's @code{main}.
2600
2601 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2602 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2603
2604 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2605 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2606 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2607 argument.
2608
2609 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2610 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2611 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2612
2613 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2614 @section Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
2615
2616 @cindex checkpoint
2617 @cindex restart
2618 @cindex bookmark
2619 @cindex snapshot of a process
2620 @cindex rewind program state
2621
2622 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2623 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2624 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2625 later.
2626
2627 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2628 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2629 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2630 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2631 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2632
2633 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2634 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2635 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2636 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2637 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2638 start again from there.
2639
2640 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2641 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2642
2643 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2644
2645 @table @code
2646 @kindex checkpoint
2647 @item checkpoint
2648 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2649 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2650 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2651
2652 @kindex info checkpoints
2653 @item info checkpoints
2654 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2655 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2656 listed:
2657
2658 @table @code
2659 @item Checkpoint ID
2660 @item Process ID
2661 @item Code Address
2662 @item Source line, or label
2663 @end table
2664
2665 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2666 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2667 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2668 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2669 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2670 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2671 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2672
2673 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2674 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2675 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2676 the debugger.
2677
2678 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2679 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2680 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2681
2682 @end table
2683
2684 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2685 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2686 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2687 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2688 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2689 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2690 previously read data can be read again.
2691
2692 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2693 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2694 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2695 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2696 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2697 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2698
2699 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2700 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2701 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2702 different execution path this time.
2703
2704 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2705 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2706 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2707 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2708 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2709 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2710 potentially pose a problem.
2711
2712 @subsection A non-obvious benefit of using checkpoints
2713
2714 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2715 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2716 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2717 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2718 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2719 next.
2720
2721 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2722 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2723 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2724 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2725 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2726
2727 @node Stopping
2728 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2729
2730 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2731 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2732 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2733
2734 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2735 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2736 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2737 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2738 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2739 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2740 explicitly request this information at any time.
2741
2742 @table @code
2743 @kindex info program
2744 @item info program
2745 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2746 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2747 @end table
2748
2749 @menu
2750 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2751 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2752 * Signals:: Signals
2753 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2754 @end menu
2755
2756 @node Breakpoints
2757 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2758
2759 @cindex breakpoints
2760 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2761 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2762 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2763 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2764 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2765 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2766 program.
2767
2768 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2769 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2770 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2771 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2772 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2773 call).
2774
2775 @cindex watchpoints
2776 @cindex memory tracing
2777 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2778 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2779 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2780 when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2781 command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2782 watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2783 any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2784 and watchpoints using the same commands.
2785
2786 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2787 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2788 Automatic display}.
2789
2790 @cindex catchpoints
2791 @cindex breakpoint on events
2792 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2793 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2794 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2795 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2796 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2797 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2798 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2799
2800 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2801 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2802 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2803 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2804 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2805 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2806 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2807 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2808 enable it again.
2809
2810 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2811 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2812 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2813 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2814 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2815 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2816 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2817
2818 @menu
2819 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2820 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2821 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2822 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2823 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2824 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2825 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2826 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2827 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2828 * Breakpoint related warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2829 @end menu
2830
2831 @node Set Breaks
2832 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2833
2834 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2835 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2836 @c
2837 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2838
2839 @kindex break
2840 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2841 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2842 @cindex latest breakpoint
2843 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2844 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2845 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2846 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2847 convenience variables.
2848
2849 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2850
2851 @table @code
2852 @item break @var{function}
2853 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2854 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2855 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2856 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2857
2858 @item break +@var{offset}
2859 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2860 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2861 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2862 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2863
2864 @item break @var{linenum}
2865 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2866 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2867 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2868 code on that line.
2869
2870 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2871 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2872
2873 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2874 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2875 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2876 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2877 functions.
2878
2879 @item break *@var{address}
2880 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2881 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2882 information or source files.
2883
2884 @item break
2885 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2886 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2887 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2888 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2889 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2890 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2891 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2892 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2893 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2894 inside loops.
2895
2896 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2897 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2898 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2899 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2900 existed when your program stopped.
2901
2902 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2903 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2904 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2905 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2906 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2907 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2908 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2909
2910 @kindex tbreak
2911 @item tbreak @var{args}
2912 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2913 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2914 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2915 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2916
2917 @kindex hbreak
2918 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2919 @item hbreak @var{args}
2920 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2921 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2922 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2923 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2924 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2925 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2926 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2927 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2928 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2929 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2930 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2931 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2932 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2933 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2934 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2935 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2936 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2937
2938
2939 @kindex thbreak
2940 @item thbreak @var{args}
2941 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2942 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2943 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2944 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2945 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2946 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2947 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2948 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2949
2950 @kindex rbreak
2951 @cindex regular expression
2952 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2953 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2954 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2955 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2956 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2957 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2958 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2959 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2960 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2961
2962 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2963 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2964 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2965 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2966 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2967 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2968
2969 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2970 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2971 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2972 classes.
2973
2974 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2975 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2976 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2977
2978 @smallexample
2979 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2980 @end smallexample
2981
2982 @kindex info breakpoints
2983 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2984 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2985 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2986 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2987 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2988 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
2989 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
2990 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
2991
2992 @table @emph
2993 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2994 @item Type
2995 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2996 @item Disposition
2997 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2998 @item Enabled or Disabled
2999 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3000 that are not enabled.
3001 @item Address
3002 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. If the
3003 breakpoint is pending (see below for details) on a future load of a shared library, the address
3004 will be listed as @samp{<PENDING>}.
3005 @item What
3006 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3007 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3008 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3009 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3010 @end table
3011
3012 @noindent
3013 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3014 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3015 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3016 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3017 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3018 valid location.
3019
3020 @noindent
3021 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3022 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3023 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3024 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3025 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
3026
3027 @noindent
3028 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3029 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3030 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3031 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3032 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3033 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3034 @end table
3035
3036 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3037 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3038 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3039 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3040
3041 @cindex pending breakpoints
3042 If a specified breakpoint location cannot be found, it may be due to the fact
3043 that the location is in a shared library that is yet to be loaded. In such
3044 a case, you may want @value{GDBN} to create a special breakpoint (known as
3045 a @dfn{pending breakpoint}) that
3046 attempts to resolve itself in the future when an appropriate shared library
3047 gets loaded.
3048
3049 Pending breakpoints are useful to set at the start of your
3050 @value{GDBN} session for locations that you know will be dynamically loaded
3051 later by the program being debugged. When shared libraries are loaded,
3052 a check is made to see if the load resolves any pending breakpoint locations.
3053 If a pending breakpoint location gets resolved,
3054 a regular breakpoint is created and the original pending breakpoint is removed.
3055
3056 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling pending
3057 breakpoint support:
3058
3059 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3060 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3061 @table @code
3062 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3063 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3064 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3065
3066 @item set breakpoint pending on
3067 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3068 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3069
3070 @item set breakpoint pending off
3071 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3072 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3073 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3074
3075 @item show breakpoint pending
3076 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3077 @end table
3078
3079 @cindex operations allowed on pending breakpoints
3080 Normal breakpoint operations apply to pending breakpoints as well. You may
3081 specify a condition for a pending breakpoint and/or commands to run when the
3082 breakpoint is reached. You can also enable or disable
3083 the pending breakpoint. When you specify a condition for a pending breakpoint,
3084 the parsing of the condition will be deferred until the point where the
3085 pending breakpoint location is resolved. Disabling a pending breakpoint
3086 tells @value{GDBN} to not attempt to resolve the breakpoint on any subsequent
3087 shared library load. When a pending breakpoint is re-enabled,
3088 @value{GDBN} checks to see if the location is already resolved.
3089 This is done because any number of shared library loads could have
3090 occurred since the time the breakpoint was disabled and one or more
3091 of these loads could resolve the location.
3092
3093 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3094 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3095 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3096 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3097 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3098 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3099 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3100 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3101
3102
3103 @node Set Watchpoints
3104 @subsection Setting watchpoints
3105
3106 @cindex setting watchpoints
3107 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3108 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3109 this may happen.
3110
3111 @cindex software watchpoints
3112 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3113 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3114 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3115 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3116 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3117 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3118 culprit.)
3119
3120 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3121 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3122 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3123
3124 @table @code
3125 @kindex watch
3126 @item watch @var{expr}
3127 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
3128 is written into by the program and its value changes.
3129
3130 @kindex rwatch
3131 @item rwatch @var{expr}
3132 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3133 by the program.
3134
3135 @kindex awatch
3136 @item awatch @var{expr}
3137 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3138 or written into by the program.
3139
3140 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3141 @item info watchpoints
3142 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3143 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3144 @end table
3145
3146 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3147 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3148 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3149 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3150 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3151 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3152
3153 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3154 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3155 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3156 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3157 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3158 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3159 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3160 mechanism of watching expressiion values.)
3161
3162 @table @code
3163 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3164 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3165 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3166
3167 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3168 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3169 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3170 @end table
3171
3172 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3173 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3174 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3175
3176 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3177
3178 @smallexample
3179 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3180 @end smallexample
3181
3182 @noindent
3183 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3184
3185 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3186 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3187 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3188 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3189 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3190 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3191 will print a message like this:
3192
3193 @smallexample
3194 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3195 @end smallexample
3196
3197 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3198 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3199 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3200 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3201 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3202 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3203 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3204 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3205
3206 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3207 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3208 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3209 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3210 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3211 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3212
3213 @smallexample
3214 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3215 @end smallexample
3216
3217 @noindent
3218 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3219
3220 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
3221 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
3222 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
3223 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
3224 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
3225 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
3226 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
3227 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
3228 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
3229 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
3230
3231 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3232 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3233 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3234
3235 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3236 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3237 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3238 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3239 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3240 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3241 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3242 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3243 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3244
3245 @quotation
3246 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3247 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3248 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
3249 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
3250 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
3251 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
3252 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
3253 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
3254 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
3255 the expression.
3256
3257 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
3258 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
3259 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3260 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3261 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3262 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3263 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3264 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3265 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3266 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3267 @end quotation
3268
3269 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3270
3271 @node Set Catchpoints
3272 @subsection Setting catchpoints
3273 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3274 @cindex exception handlers
3275 @cindex event handling
3276
3277 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3278 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3279 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3280
3281 @table @code
3282 @kindex catch
3283 @item catch @var{event}
3284 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3285 @table @code
3286 @item throw
3287 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3288 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3289
3290 @item catch
3291 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3292
3293 @item exec
3294 @cindex break on fork/exec
3295 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3296
3297 @item fork
3298 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3299
3300 @item vfork
3301 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3302
3303 @item load
3304 @itemx load @var{libname}
3305 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3306 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3307 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3308
3309 @item unload
3310 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3311 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3312 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3313 @end table
3314
3315 @item tcatch @var{event}
3316 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3317 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3318
3319 @end table
3320
3321 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3322
3323 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3324 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3325
3326 @itemize @bullet
3327 @item
3328 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3329 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3330 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3331 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3332 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3333 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3334 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3335 disabled within interactive calls.
3336
3337 @item
3338 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3339
3340 @item
3341 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3342 @end itemize
3343
3344 @cindex raise exceptions
3345 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3346 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3347 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3348 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3349 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3350 out where the exception was raised.
3351
3352 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3353 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3354 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3355 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3356
3357 @smallexample
3358 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3359 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3360 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3361 @end smallexample
3362
3363 @noindent
3364 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3365 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3366 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
3367
3368 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
3369 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3370 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3371 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3372 raised.
3373
3374
3375 @node Delete Breaks
3376 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
3377
3378 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3379 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3380 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3381 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3382 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3383 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3384
3385 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3386 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3387 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3388 their breakpoint numbers.
3389
3390 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3391 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3392 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3393
3394 @table @code
3395 @kindex clear
3396 @item clear
3397 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3398 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
3399 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3400 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3401
3402 @item clear @var{function}
3403 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3404 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3405
3406 @item clear @var{linenum}
3407 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3408 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3409 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3410
3411 @cindex delete breakpoints
3412 @kindex delete
3413 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3414 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3415 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3416 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3417 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3418 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3419 @end table
3420
3421 @node Disabling
3422 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
3423
3424 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3425 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3426 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3427 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3428 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3429
3430 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3431 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3432 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3433 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3434 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3435
3436 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3437 states of enablement:
3438
3439 @itemize @bullet
3440 @item
3441 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3442 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3443 @item
3444 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3445 @item
3446 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3447 disabled.
3448 @item
3449 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3450 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3451 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3452 @end itemize
3453
3454 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3455 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3456
3457 @table @code
3458 @kindex disable
3459 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3460 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3461 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3462 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3463 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3464 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3465 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3466
3467 @kindex enable
3468 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3469 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3470 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3471
3472 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3473 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3474 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3475
3476 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3477 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3478 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3479 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3480 @end table
3481
3482 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3483 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3484 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3485 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3486 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3487 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3488 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3489 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3490 stepping}.)
3491
3492 @node Conditions
3493 @subsection Break conditions
3494 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3495 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3496
3497 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3498 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3499 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3500 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3501 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3502 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3503 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3504 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3505
3506 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3507 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3508 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3509 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3510 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3511
3512 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3513 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3514 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3515 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3516 one.
3517
3518 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3519 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3520 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3521 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3522 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3523 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3524 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3525 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3526 conditions for the
3527 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3528 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3529
3530 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3531 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3532 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3533 with the @code{condition} command.
3534
3535 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3536 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3537 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3538 catchpoint.
3539
3540 @table @code
3541 @kindex condition
3542 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3543 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3544 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3545 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3546 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3547 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3548 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3549 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3550 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3551 prints an error message:
3552
3553 @smallexample
3554 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3555 @end smallexample
3556
3557 @noindent
3558 @value{GDBN} does
3559 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3560 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3561 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3562
3563 @item condition @var{bnum}
3564 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3565 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3566 @end table
3567
3568 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3569 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3570 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3571 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3572 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3573 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3574 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3575 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3576 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3577 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3578 your program reaches it.
3579
3580 @table @code
3581 @kindex ignore
3582 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3583 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3584 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3585 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3586 takes no action.
3587
3588 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3589 a count of zero.
3590
3591 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3592 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3593 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3594 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3595
3596 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3597 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3598 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3599
3600 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3601 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3602 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3603 variables}.
3604 @end table
3605
3606 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3607
3608
3609 @node Break Commands
3610 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3611
3612 @cindex breakpoint commands
3613 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3614 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3615 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3616 enable other breakpoints.
3617
3618 @table @code
3619 @kindex commands
3620 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3621 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3622 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3623 @itemx end
3624 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3625 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3626 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3627
3628 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3629 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3630
3631 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3632 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3633 recently encountered).
3634 @end table
3635
3636 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3637 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3638
3639 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3640 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3641 that resumes execution.
3642
3643 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3644 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3645 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3646 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3647 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3648
3649 @kindex silent
3650 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3651 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3652 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3653 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3654 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3655 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3656
3657 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3658 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3659 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3660
3661 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3662 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3663
3664 @smallexample
3665 break foo if x>0
3666 commands
3667 silent
3668 printf "x is %d\n",x
3669 cont
3670 end
3671 @end smallexample
3672
3673 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3674 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3675 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3676 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3677 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3678 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3679 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3680
3681 @smallexample
3682 break 403
3683 commands
3684 silent
3685 set x = y + 4
3686 cont
3687 end
3688 @end smallexample
3689
3690 @node Breakpoint Menus
3691 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3692 @cindex overloading
3693 @cindex symbol overloading
3694
3695 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3696 single function name
3697 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3698 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3699 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3700 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3701 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3702 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3703 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3704 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3705 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3706 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3707 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3708 breakpoints.
3709
3710 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3711 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3712 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3713
3714 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3715 @smallexample
3716 @group
3717 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3718 [0] cancel
3719 [1] all
3720 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3721 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3722 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3723 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3724 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3725 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3726 > 2 4 6
3727 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3728 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3729 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3730 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3731 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3732 breakpoints.
3733 (@value{GDBP})
3734 @end group
3735 @end smallexample
3736
3737 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3738 @node Error in Breakpoints
3739 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3740 @c
3741 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3742 @c
3743 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3744 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3745 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3746 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3747
3748 @smallexample
3749 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3750 The same program may be running in another process.
3751 @end smallexample
3752
3753 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3754
3755 @enumerate
3756 @item
3757 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3758
3759 @item
3760 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3761 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3762 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3763 Then start your program again.
3764
3765 @item
3766 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3767 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3768 to nonsharable executables.
3769 @end enumerate
3770 @c @end ifclear
3771
3772 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3773 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3774
3775 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3776 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3777 @smallexample
3778 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3779 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3780 @end smallexample
3781
3782 @noindent
3783 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3784 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3785 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3786
3787 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3788 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3789
3790 @node Breakpoint related warnings
3791 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3792 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3793
3794 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3795 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3796 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3797 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3798
3799 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3800 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3801 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3802 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3803 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3804 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3805 first in the bundle.
3806
3807 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3808 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3809 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3810 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3811 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3812 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3813 is hit.
3814
3815 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3816 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3817
3818 @smallexample
3819 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3820 @end smallexample
3821
3822 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3823 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3824 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3825 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3826 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3827 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3828 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3829 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3830
3831 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3832 adjusted breakpoints:
3833
3834 @smallexample
3835 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3836 to 0x00010410.
3837 @end smallexample
3838
3839 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3840 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3841 frequently than expected.
3842
3843 @node Continuing and Stepping
3844 @section Continuing and stepping
3845
3846 @cindex stepping
3847 @cindex continuing
3848 @cindex resuming execution
3849 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3850 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3851 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3852 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3853 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3854 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3855 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3856 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3857
3858 @table @code
3859 @kindex continue
3860 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3861 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3862 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3863 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3864 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3865 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3866 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3867 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3868 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3869 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3870
3871 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3872 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3873 @code{continue} is ignored.
3874
3875 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3876 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3877 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3878 @code{continue}.
3879 @end table
3880
3881 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3882 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3883 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3884 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3885
3886 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3887 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3888 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3889 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3890 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3891 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3892
3893 @table @code
3894 @kindex step
3895 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3896 @item step
3897 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3898 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3899 abbreviated @code{s}.
3900
3901 @quotation
3902 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3903 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3904 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3905 @c distinction here.
3906 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3907 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3908 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3909 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3910 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3911 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3912 below.
3913 @end quotation
3914
3915 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3916 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3917 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3918 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3919 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3920 called within the line.
3921
3922 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3923 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3924 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3925 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3926 was any debugging information about the routine.
3927
3928 @item step @var{count}
3929 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3930 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3931 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3932
3933 @kindex next
3934 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3935 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3936 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3937 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3938 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3939 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3940 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3941 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3942
3943 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3944
3945
3946 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3947 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3948 @c
3949 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3950 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3951 @c function are executed without stopping.
3952
3953 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3954 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3955 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
3956
3957 @kindex set step-mode
3958 @item set step-mode
3959 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3960 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3961 @itemx set step-mode on
3962 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
3963 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3964 information rather than stepping over it.
3965
3966 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3967 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3968 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
3969
3970 @item set step-mode off
3971 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
3972 debug information. This is the default.
3973
3974 @item show step-mode
3975 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
3976 source line debug information.
3977
3978 @kindex finish
3979 @item finish
3980 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3981 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3982
3983 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3984 ,Returning from a function}).
3985
3986 @kindex until
3987 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
3988 @cindex run until specified location
3989 @item until
3990 @itemx u
3991 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3992 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3993 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3994 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3995 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3996 than the address of the jump.
3997
3998 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3999 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4000 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4001 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4002 through the next iteration.
4003
4004 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4005 stack frame.
4006
4007 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4008 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4009 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4010 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4011 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4012
4013 @smallexample
4014 (@value{GDBP}) f
4015 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4016 206 expand_input();
4017 (@value{GDBP}) until
4018 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4019 @end smallexample
4020
4021 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4022 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4023 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4024 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4025 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4026 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4027 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4028
4029 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4030 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4031 argument.
4032
4033 @item until @var{location}
4034 @itemx u @var{location}
4035 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4036 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4037 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4038 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
4039 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4040 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4041 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4042 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4043 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4044 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
4045 invocations have returned.
4046
4047 @smallexample
4048 94 int factorial (int value)
4049 95 @{
4050 96 if (value > 1) @{
4051 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4052 98 @}
4053 99 return (value);
4054 100 @}
4055 @end smallexample
4056
4057
4058 @kindex advance @var{location}
4059 @itemx advance @var{location}
4060 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4061 required, which should be of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
4062 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4063 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4064 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4065 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4066
4067
4068 @kindex stepi
4069 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4070 @item stepi
4071 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4072 @itemx si
4073 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4074
4075 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4076 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4077 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4078 Display,, Automatic display}.
4079
4080 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4081
4082 @need 750
4083 @kindex nexti
4084 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4085 @item nexti
4086 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4087 @itemx ni
4088 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4089 proceed until the function returns.
4090
4091 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4092 @end table
4093
4094 @node Signals
4095 @section Signals
4096 @cindex signals
4097
4098 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4099 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4100 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4101 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4102 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4103 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4104 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4105 requested an alarm).
4106
4107 @cindex fatal signals
4108 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4109 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4110 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4111 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4112 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4113 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4114
4115 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4116 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4117 signal.
4118
4119 @cindex handling signals
4120 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4121 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4122 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4123 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4124 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4125
4126 @table @code
4127 @kindex info signals
4128 @kindex info handle
4129 @item info signals
4130 @itemx info handle
4131 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4132 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4133 the defined types of signals.
4134
4135 @item info signals @var{sig}
4136 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4137
4138 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4139
4140 @kindex handle
4141 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4142 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4143 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4144 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4145 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4146 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4147 say what change to make.
4148 @end table
4149
4150 @c @group
4151 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4152 Their full names are:
4153
4154 @table @code
4155 @item nostop
4156 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4157 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4158
4159 @item stop
4160 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4161 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4162
4163 @item print
4164 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4165
4166 @item noprint
4167 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4168 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4169
4170 @item pass
4171 @itemx noignore
4172 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4173 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4174 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4175
4176 @item nopass
4177 @itemx ignore
4178 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4179 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4180 @end table
4181 @c @end group
4182
4183 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4184 program until you
4185 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4186 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4187 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4188 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4189 program sees that signal when you continue.
4190
4191 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4192 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4193 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4194 erroneous signals.
4195
4196 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4197 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4198 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4199 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4200 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4201 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4202 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4203 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4204 program a signal}.
4205
4206 @node Thread Stops
4207 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
4208
4209 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4210 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
4211 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4212
4213 @table @code
4214 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4215 @cindex thread breakpoints
4216 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4217 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4218 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4219 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4220 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4221
4222 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4223 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4224 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4225 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4226 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4227
4228 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4229 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4230 program.
4231
4232 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4233 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4234 breakpoint condition, like this:
4235
4236 @smallexample
4237 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4238 @end smallexample
4239
4240 @end table
4241
4242 @cindex stopped threads
4243 @cindex threads, stopped
4244 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4245 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4246 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4247 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4248 underfoot.
4249
4250 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4251 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4252 @cindex premature return from system calls
4253 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4254 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4255 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4256 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4257 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4258 stop execution.
4259
4260 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4261 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4262 style anyways.
4263
4264 For example, do not write code like this:
4265
4266 @smallexample
4267 sleep (10);
4268 @end smallexample
4269
4270 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4271 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4272
4273 Instead, write this:
4274
4275 @smallexample
4276 int unslept = 10;
4277 while (unslept > 0)
4278 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4279 @end smallexample
4280
4281 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4282 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4283 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4284 @value{GDBN}.
4285
4286 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4287 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4288 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4289 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4290
4291 @cindex continuing threads
4292 @cindex threads, continuing
4293 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4294 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4295 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4296
4297 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4298 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4299 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4300 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4301 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4302 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4303 stops.
4304
4305 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4306 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4307 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4308 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4309
4310 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4311 thread to run.
4312
4313 @table @code
4314 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4315 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4316 @cindex lock scheduler
4317 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4318 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4319 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4320 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4321 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4322 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4323 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4324 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4325 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4326 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4327 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4328
4329 @item show scheduler-locking
4330 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4331 @end table
4332
4333
4334 @node Stack
4335 @chapter Examining the Stack
4336
4337 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4338 stopped and how it got there.
4339
4340 @cindex call stack
4341 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4342 is generated.
4343 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4344 the arguments of the call,
4345 and the local variables of the function being called.
4346 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4347 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4348 stack}.
4349
4350 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4351 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4352
4353 @cindex selected frame
4354 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4355 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4356 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4357 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4358 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4359 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4360
4361 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4362 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4363 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
4364
4365 @menu
4366 * Frames:: Stack frames
4367 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4368 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4369 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4370
4371 @end menu
4372
4373 @node Frames
4374 @section Stack frames
4375
4376 @cindex frame, definition
4377 @cindex stack frame
4378 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4379 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4380 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4381 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4382 which the function is executing.
4383
4384 @cindex initial frame
4385 @cindex outermost frame
4386 @cindex innermost frame
4387 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4388 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4389 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4390 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4391 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4392 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4393 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4394 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4395
4396 @cindex frame pointer
4397 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4398 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4399 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4400 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4401 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4402 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4403
4404 @cindex frame number
4405 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4406 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4407 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4408 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4409 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4410
4411 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4412 @c underflow problems.
4413 @cindex frameless execution
4414 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4415 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
4416 @smallexample
4417 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4418 @end smallexample
4419 generates functions without a frame.)
4420 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4421 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4422 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4423 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4424 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4425 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4426 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4427
4428 @table @code
4429 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4430 @cindex current stack frame
4431 @item frame @var{args}
4432 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4433 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4434 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4435 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4436
4437 @kindex select-frame
4438 @cindex selecting frame silently
4439 @item select-frame
4440 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4441 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4442 @code{frame}.
4443 @end table
4444
4445 @node Backtrace
4446 @section Backtraces
4447
4448 @cindex traceback
4449 @cindex call stack traces
4450 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4451 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4452 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4453 stack.
4454
4455 @table @code
4456 @kindex backtrace
4457 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4458 @item backtrace
4459 @itemx bt
4460 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4461 frames in the stack.
4462
4463 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4464 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4465
4466 @item backtrace @var{n}
4467 @itemx bt @var{n}
4468 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4469
4470 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4471 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4472 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4473
4474 @item backtrace full
4475 @itemx bt full
4476 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4477 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4478 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4479 number of frames to print, like described above.
4480 @end table
4481
4482 @kindex where
4483 @kindex info stack
4484 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4485 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4486
4487 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4488 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4489 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4490 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4491 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4492 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4493 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4494 multi-threaded program.
4495
4496 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4497 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4498 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4499 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4500 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4501 line number.
4502
4503 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4504 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4505
4506 @smallexample
4507 @group
4508 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4509 at builtin.c:993
4510 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4511 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4512 at macro.c:71
4513 (More stack frames follow...)
4514 @end group
4515 @end smallexample
4516
4517 @noindent
4518 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4519 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4520 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4521
4522 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4523 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4524 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4525 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4526 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4527 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4528 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4529 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4530 such a backtrace might look like:
4531
4532 @smallexample
4533 @group
4534 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4535 at builtin.c:993
4536 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4537 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4538 at macro.c:71
4539 (More stack frames follow...)
4540 @end group
4541 @end smallexample
4542
4543 @noindent
4544 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4545 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4546
4547 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4548 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4549 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4550
4551 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4552 @cindex program entry point
4553 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4554 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4555 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4556 @code{main}@footnote{
4557 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4558 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4559 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4560 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4561 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4562 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4563
4564 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4565 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4566
4567 @table @code
4568 @item set backtrace past-main
4569 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4570 @kindex set backtrace
4571 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4572
4573 @item set backtrace past-main off
4574 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4575 default.
4576
4577 @item show backtrace past-main
4578 @kindex show backtrace
4579 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4580
4581 @item set backtrace past-entry
4582 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4583 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4584 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4585 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4586
4587 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4588 Backtraces will stop when they encouter the internal entry point of an
4589 application. This is the default.
4590
4591 @item show backtrace past-entry
4592 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4593
4594 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4595 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4596 @cindex backtrace limit
4597 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4598 unlimited.
4599
4600 @item show backtrace limit
4601 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4602 @end table
4603
4604 @node Selection
4605 @section Selecting a frame
4606
4607 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4608 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4609 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4610 of the stack frame just selected.
4611
4612 @table @code
4613 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4614 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4615 @item frame @var{n}
4616 @itemx f @var{n}
4617 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4618 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4619 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4620 @code{main}.
4621
4622 @item frame @var{addr}
4623 @itemx f @var{addr}
4624 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4625 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4626 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4627 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4628 switches between them.
4629
4630 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4631 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4632
4633 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4634 pointer and a program counter.
4635
4636 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4637 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4638
4639 @kindex up
4640 @item up @var{n}
4641 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4642 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4643 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4644
4645 @kindex down
4646 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4647 @item down @var{n}
4648 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4649 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4650 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4651 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4652 @end table
4653
4654 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4655 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4656 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4657 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4658
4659 @need 1000
4660 For example:
4661
4662 @smallexample
4663 @group
4664 (@value{GDBP}) up
4665 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4666 at env.c:10
4667 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4668 @end group
4669 @end smallexample
4670
4671 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4672 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4673 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4674 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4675 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
4676 for details.
4677
4678 @table @code
4679 @kindex down-silently
4680 @kindex up-silently
4681 @item up-silently @var{n}
4682 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4683 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4684 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4685 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4686 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4687 distracting.
4688 @end table
4689
4690 @node Frame Info
4691 @section Information about a frame
4692
4693 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4694 stack frame.
4695
4696 @table @code
4697 @item frame
4698 @itemx f
4699 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4700 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4701 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4702 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4703 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4704
4705 @kindex info frame
4706 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4707 @item info frame
4708 @itemx info f
4709 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4710 including:
4711
4712 @itemize @bullet
4713 @item
4714 the address of the frame
4715 @item
4716 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4717 @item
4718 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4719 @item
4720 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4721 @item
4722 the address of the frame's arguments
4723 @item
4724 the address of the frame's local variables
4725 @item
4726 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4727 @item
4728 which registers were saved in the frame
4729 @end itemize
4730
4731 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4732 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4733 the usual conventions.
4734
4735 @item info frame @var{addr}
4736 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4737 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4738 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4739 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4740 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4741 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4742
4743 @kindex info args
4744 @item info args
4745 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4746
4747 @item info locals
4748 @kindex info locals
4749 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4750 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4751 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4752
4753 @kindex info catch
4754 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4755 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4756 @item info catch
4757 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4758 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4759 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4760 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4761 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
4762
4763 @end table
4764
4765
4766 @node Source
4767 @chapter Examining Source Files
4768
4769 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4770 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4771 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4772 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4773 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4774 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4775 source files by explicit command.
4776
4777 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4778 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4779 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4780
4781 @menu
4782 * List:: Printing source lines
4783 * Edit:: Editing source files
4784 * Search:: Searching source files
4785 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4786 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4787 @end menu
4788
4789 @node List
4790 @section Printing source lines
4791
4792 @kindex list
4793 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4794 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4795 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4796 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4797
4798 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4799
4800 @table @code
4801 @item list @var{linenum}
4802 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4803 current source file.
4804
4805 @item list @var{function}
4806 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4807 @var{function}.
4808
4809 @item list
4810 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4811 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4812 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4813 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4814 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4815
4816 @item list -
4817 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4818 @end table
4819
4820 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4821 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4822 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4823
4824 @table @code
4825 @kindex set listsize
4826 @item set listsize @var{count}
4827 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4828 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4829
4830 @kindex show listsize
4831 @item show listsize
4832 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4833 @end table
4834
4835 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4836 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4837 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4838 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4839 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4840
4841 @cindex linespec
4842 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4843 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4844 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4845 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4846
4847 @table @code
4848 @item list @var{linespec}
4849 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4850
4851 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4852 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4853 linespecs.
4854
4855 @item list ,@var{last}
4856 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4857
4858 @item list @var{first},
4859 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4860
4861 @item list +
4862 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4863
4864 @item list -
4865 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4866
4867 @item list
4868 As described in the preceding table.
4869 @end table
4870
4871 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4872 kinds of linespec.
4873
4874 @table @code
4875 @item @var{number}
4876 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4877 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4878 the same source file as the first linespec.
4879
4880 @item +@var{offset}
4881 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4882 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4883 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4884 first linespec.
4885
4886 @item -@var{offset}
4887 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4888
4889 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4890 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4891
4892 @item @var{function}
4893 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4894 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4895
4896 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4897 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4898 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4899 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4900 identically named functions in different source files.
4901
4902 @item *@var{address}
4903 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4904 @var{address} may be any expression.
4905 @end table
4906
4907 @node Edit
4908 @section Editing source files
4909 @cindex editing source files
4910
4911 @kindex edit
4912 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4913 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4914 The editing program of your choice
4915 is invoked with the current line set to
4916 the active line in the program.
4917 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4918 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4919
4920 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4921
4922 @table @code
4923 @item edit
4924 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4925
4926 @item edit @var{number}
4927 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4928
4929 @item edit @var{function}
4930 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4931
4932 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4933 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4934
4935 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4936 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4937 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4938 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4939 identically named functions in different source files.
4940
4941 @item edit *@var{address}
4942 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4943 @var{address} may be any expression.
4944 @end table
4945
4946 @subsection Choosing your editor
4947 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4948 @footnote{
4949 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4950 following command-line syntax:
4951 @smallexample
4952 ex +@var{number} file
4953 @end smallexample
4954 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
4955 the file where to start editing.}.
4956 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
4957 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4958 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4959 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4960 @smallexample
4961 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4962 export EDITOR
4963 gdb @dots{}
4964 @end smallexample
4965 or in the @code{csh} shell,
4966 @smallexample
4967 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4968 gdb @dots{}
4969 @end smallexample
4970
4971 @node Search
4972 @section Searching source files
4973 @cindex searching source files
4974
4975 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4976 regular expression.
4977
4978 @table @code
4979 @kindex search
4980 @kindex forward-search
4981 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
4982 @itemx search @var{regexp}
4983 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4984 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
4985 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
4986 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4987 @code{fo}.
4988
4989 @kindex reverse-search
4990 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4991 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4992 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4993 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4994 this command as @code{rev}.
4995 @end table
4996
4997 @node Source Path
4998 @section Specifying source directories
4999
5000 @cindex source path
5001 @cindex directories for source files
5002 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5003 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5004 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5005 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5006 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5007 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5008 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5009
5010 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5011 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5012 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5013 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5014 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5015 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5016 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5017 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5018 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5019 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5020 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5021
5022 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5023 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5024 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5025 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5026 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5027 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5028
5029 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5030 source files.
5031
5032 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5033 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5034 each line is in the file.
5035
5036 @kindex directory
5037 @kindex dir
5038 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5039 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5040 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5041
5042 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5043 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5044
5045 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5046 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5047 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5048 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5049 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5050 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5051 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5052 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5053 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5054 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5055 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5056 name to look up the sources.
5057
5058 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5059 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5060 GDB to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5061 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5062 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5063 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5064 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5065 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5066
5067 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5068 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5069 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5070 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5071 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5072 is applied only at the begining of the directory name, this rule will
5073 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5074
5075 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5076 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5077 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5078 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5079 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5080 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5081 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5082 command.
5083
5084 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5085 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5086 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5087 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5088 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5089 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5090 method available to point GDB at the new location.
5091
5092 @table @code
5093 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5094 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5095 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5096 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5097 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5098 part of absolute file names) or
5099 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5100 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5101
5102 @kindex cdir
5103 @kindex cwd
5104 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5105 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
5106 @cindex compilation directory
5107 @cindex current directory
5108 @cindex working directory
5109 @cindex directory, current
5110 @cindex directory, compilation
5111 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5112 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5113 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5114 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5115 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5116 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5117
5118 @item directory
5119 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5120
5121 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5122 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5123
5124 @item show directories
5125 @kindex show directories
5126 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5127
5128 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5129 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5130 @kindex set substitute-path
5131 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5132 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5133 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5134
5135 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5136 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5137
5138 @smallexample
5139 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5140 @end smallexample
5141
5142 @noindent
5143 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5144 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5145 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5146
5147 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5148 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5149 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5150 the substitution.
5151
5152 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5153
5154 @smallexample
5155 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5156 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5157 @end smallexample
5158
5159 @noindent
5160 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5161 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5162 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5163 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5164
5165
5166 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5167 @kindex unset substitute-path
5168 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5169 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5170 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5171
5172 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5173
5174 @item show substitute-path [path]
5175 @kindex show substitute-path
5176 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5177 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5178
5179 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5180 rules.
5181
5182 @end table
5183
5184 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5185 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5186 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5187
5188 @enumerate
5189 @item
5190 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5191
5192 @item
5193 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5194 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5195 directories in one command.
5196 @end enumerate
5197
5198 @node Machine Code
5199 @section Source and machine code
5200 @cindex source line and its code address
5201
5202 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5203 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5204 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5205 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5206 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5207 well as hex.
5208
5209 @table @code
5210 @kindex info line
5211 @item info line @var{linespec}
5212 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5213 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5214 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
5215 source lines}).
5216 @end table
5217
5218 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5219 the object code for the first line of function
5220 @code{m4_changequote}:
5221
5222 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5223 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5224 @smallexample
5225 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5226 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5227 @end smallexample
5228
5229 @noindent
5230 @cindex code address and its source line
5231 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5232 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5233 @smallexample
5234 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5235 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5236 @end smallexample
5237
5238 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5239 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5240 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5241 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5242 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5243 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5244 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5245 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5246 variables}).
5247
5248 @table @code
5249 @kindex disassemble
5250 @cindex assembly instructions
5251 @cindex instructions, assembly
5252 @cindex machine instructions
5253 @cindex listing machine instructions
5254 @item disassemble
5255 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5256 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5257 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5258 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5259 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5260 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5261 @end table
5262
5263 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5264 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5265
5266 @smallexample
5267 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5268 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5269 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5270 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5271 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5272 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5273 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5274 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5275 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5276 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5277 End of assembler dump.
5278 @end smallexample
5279
5280 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5281 mnemonics or other syntax.
5282
5283 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5284 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5285 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5286 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5287 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5288
5289 @table @code
5290 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5291 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5292 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5293 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5294 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5295 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5296
5297 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5298 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5299 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5300 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5301
5302 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5303 @item show disassembly-flavor
5304 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5305 @end table
5306
5307
5308 @node Data
5309 @chapter Examining Data
5310
5311 @cindex printing data
5312 @cindex examining data
5313 @kindex print
5314 @kindex inspect
5315 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5316 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5317 @c different window or something like that.
5318 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5319 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5320 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5321 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5322 Different Languages}).
5323
5324 @table @code
5325 @item print @var{expr}
5326 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5327 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5328 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5329 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5330 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5331 formats}.
5332
5333 @item print
5334 @itemx print /@var{f}
5335 @cindex reprint the last value
5336 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5337 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
5338 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5339 @end table
5340
5341 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5342 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5343 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5344
5345 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5346 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5347 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5348 Table}.
5349
5350 @menu
5351 * Expressions:: Expressions
5352 * Variables:: Program variables
5353 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5354 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5355 * Memory:: Examining memory
5356 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5357 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5358 * Value History:: Value history
5359 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5360 * Registers:: Registers
5361 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5362 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5363 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5364 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5365 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5366 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5367 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5368 character set than GDB does
5369 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5370 @end menu
5371
5372 @node Expressions
5373 @section Expressions
5374
5375 @cindex expressions
5376 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5377 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5378 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5379 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5380 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5381 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5382 @ref{Compilation}.
5383
5384 @cindex arrays in expressions
5385 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5386 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5387 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5388 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5389
5390 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5391 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5392 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5393 languages.
5394
5395 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5396 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5397
5398 @cindex casts, in expressions
5399 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5400 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5401 at that address in memory.
5402 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5403
5404 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5405 to programming languages:
5406
5407 @table @code
5408 @item @@
5409 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5410 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
5411
5412 @item ::
5413 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5414 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
5415
5416 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5417 @cindex type casting memory
5418 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5419 @cindex casts, to view memory
5420 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5421 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5422 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5423 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5424 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5425 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5426 @end table
5427
5428 @node Variables
5429 @section Program variables
5430
5431 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5432 in your program.
5433
5434 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5435 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
5436
5437 @itemize @bullet
5438 @item
5439 global (or file-static)
5440 @end itemize
5441
5442 @noindent or
5443
5444 @itemize @bullet
5445 @item
5446 visible according to the scope rules of the
5447 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5448 @end itemize
5449
5450 @noindent This means that in the function
5451
5452 @smallexample
5453 foo (a)
5454 int a;
5455 @{
5456 bar (a);
5457 @{
5458 int b = test ();
5459 bar (b);
5460 @}
5461 @}
5462 @end smallexample
5463
5464 @noindent
5465 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5466 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5467 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5468 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5469
5470 @cindex variable name conflict
5471 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5472 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5473 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5474 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5475 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5476 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5477 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5478
5479 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5480 @iftex
5481 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5482 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5483 @end iftex
5484 @smallexample
5485 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5486 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5487 @end smallexample
5488
5489 @noindent
5490 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5491 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5492 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5493 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5494
5495 @smallexample
5496 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5497 @end smallexample
5498
5499 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5500 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5501 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5502 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5503 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5504 @c conflict?? --mew
5505
5506 @cindex wrong values
5507 @cindex variable values, wrong
5508 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5509 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5510 @quotation
5511 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5512 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5513 scope, and just before exit.
5514 @end quotation
5515 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5516 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5517 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5518 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5519 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5520 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5521 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5522 variable definitions may be gone.
5523
5524 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5525 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5526 when compiling.
5527
5528 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5529 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5530 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5531 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5532 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5533 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5534 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5535
5536 @smallexample
5537 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5538 @end smallexample
5539
5540 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5541 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5542 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5543 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5544 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5545 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5546 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5547 for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
5548 @xref{C, , Debugging C++}, for more info about debug info formats
5549 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5550
5551 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5552 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5553 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5554 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5555
5556 @node Arrays
5557 @section Artificial arrays
5558
5559 @cindex artificial array
5560 @cindex arrays
5561 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5562 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5563 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5564 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5565 program.
5566
5567 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5568 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5569 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5570 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5571 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5572 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5573 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5574 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5575 example. If a program says
5576
5577 @smallexample
5578 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5579 @end smallexample
5580
5581 @noindent
5582 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5583
5584 @smallexample
5585 p *array@@len
5586 @end smallexample
5587
5588 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5589 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5590 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5591 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5592 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
5593
5594 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5595 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5596 The value need not be in memory:
5597 @smallexample
5598 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5599 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5600 @end smallexample
5601
5602 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5603 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5604 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5605 @smallexample
5606 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5607 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5608 @end smallexample
5609
5610 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5611 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5612 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5613 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5614 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5615 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5616 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5617 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5618 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5619 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5620
5621 @smallexample
5622 set $i = 0
5623 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5624 @key{RET}
5625 @key{RET}
5626 @dots{}
5627 @end smallexample
5628
5629 @node Output Formats
5630 @section Output formats
5631
5632 @cindex formatted output
5633 @cindex output formats
5634 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5635 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5636 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5637 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5638 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5639
5640 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5641 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5642 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5643 letters supported are:
5644
5645 @table @code
5646 @item x
5647 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5648 hexadecimal.
5649
5650 @item d
5651 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5652
5653 @item u
5654 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5655
5656 @item o
5657 Print as integer in octal.
5658
5659 @item t
5660 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5661 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5662 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5663 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
5664
5665 @item a
5666 @cindex unknown address, locating
5667 @cindex locate address
5668 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5669 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5670 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5671
5672 @smallexample
5673 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5674 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5675 @end smallexample
5676
5677 @noindent
5678 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5679 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5680
5681 @item c
5682 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5683 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5684 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5685 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5686
5687 @item f
5688 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5689 using typical floating point syntax.
5690 @end table
5691
5692 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5693
5694 @smallexample
5695 p/x $pc
5696 @end smallexample
5697
5698 @noindent
5699 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5700 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5701
5702 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5703 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5704 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5705
5706 @node Memory
5707 @section Examining memory
5708
5709 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5710 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5711
5712 @cindex examining memory
5713 @table @code
5714 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5715 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5716 @itemx x @var{addr}
5717 @itemx x
5718 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5719 @end table
5720
5721 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5722 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5723 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5724 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5725 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5726
5727 @table @r
5728 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5729 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5730 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5731 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5732 @c 4.1.2.
5733
5734 @item @var{f}, the display format
5735 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5736 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5737 @samp{f}), and in addition @samp{s} (for null-terminated strings) and
5738 @samp{i} (for machine instructions). The default is @samp{x}
5739 (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes each time you use either
5740 @code{x} or @code{print}.
5741
5742 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5743 The unit size is any of
5744
5745 @table @code
5746 @item b
5747 Bytes.
5748 @item h
5749 Halfwords (two bytes).
5750 @item w
5751 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5752 @item g
5753 Giant words (eight bytes).
5754 @end table
5755
5756 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5757 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5758 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5759
5760 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5761 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5762 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5763 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5764 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5765 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5766 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5767 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5768 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5769 a value from memory).
5770 @end table
5771
5772 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5773 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5774 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5775 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5776 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5777
5778 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5779 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5780 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5781 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5782 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5783
5784 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5785 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5786 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5787 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
5788 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
5789 Code,,Source and machine code}.
5790
5791 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
5792 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
5793 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
5794 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
5795 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
5796 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
5797 for successive uses of @code{x}.
5798
5799 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
5800 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
5801 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5802 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5803 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5804 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5805 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5806 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5807 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5808
5809 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5810 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5811 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5812
5813 @cindex remote memory comparison
5814 @cindex verify remote memory image
5815 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
5816 (@pxref{Remote}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
5817 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
5818 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
5819 situations.
5820
5821 @table @code
5822 @kindex compare-sections
5823 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
5824 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
5825 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
5826 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
5827 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
5828 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
5829 remote request.
5830 @end table
5831
5832 @node Auto Display
5833 @section Automatic display
5834 @cindex automatic display
5835 @cindex display of expressions
5836
5837 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5838 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
5839 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
5840 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
5841 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
5842 The automatic display looks like this:
5843
5844 @smallexample
5845 2: foo = 38
5846 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
5847 @end smallexample
5848
5849 @noindent
5850 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
5851 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
5852 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
5853 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
5854 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
5855 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5856 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5857
5858 @table @code
5859 @kindex display
5860 @item display @var{expr}
5861 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
5862 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5863
5864 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5865
5866 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
5867 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
5868 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
5869 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5870 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5871
5872 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5873 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5874 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5875 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5876 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5877 @end table
5878
5879 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5880 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
5881 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5882
5883 @table @code
5884 @kindex delete display
5885 @kindex undisplay
5886 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5887 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5888 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5889
5890 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5891 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5892
5893 @kindex disable display
5894 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5895 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5896 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5897 enabled again later.
5898
5899 @kindex enable display
5900 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5901 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5902 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5903
5904 @item display
5905 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5906 done when your program stops.
5907
5908 @kindex info display
5909 @item info display
5910 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5911 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5912 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5913 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5914 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5915 @end table
5916
5917 @cindex display disabled out of scope
5918 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5919 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5920 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5921 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5922 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5923 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5924 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5925 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5926 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5927 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5928
5929 @node Print Settings
5930 @section Print settings
5931
5932 @cindex format options
5933 @cindex print settings
5934 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5935 and symbols are printed.
5936
5937 @noindent
5938 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5939
5940 @table @code
5941 @kindex set print
5942 @item set print address
5943 @itemx set print address on
5944 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
5945 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5946 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5947 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5948 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5949 @code{set print address on}:
5950
5951 @smallexample
5952 @group
5953 (@value{GDBP}) f
5954 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5955 at input.c:530
5956 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5957 @end group
5958 @end smallexample
5959
5960 @item set print address off
5961 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5962 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5963
5964 @smallexample
5965 @group
5966 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5967 (@value{GDBP}) f
5968 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5969 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5970 @end group
5971 @end smallexample
5972
5973 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5974 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5975 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5976 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5977
5978 @kindex show print
5979 @item show print address
5980 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5981 @end table
5982
5983 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5984 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5985 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5986 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5987 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5988 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5989 it prints a symbolic address:
5990
5991 @table @code
5992 @item set print symbol-filename on
5993 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
5994 @cindex symbol, source file and line
5995 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5996 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5997
5998 @item set print symbol-filename off
5999 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6000 default.
6001
6002 @item show print symbol-filename
6003 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6004 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6005 @end table
6006
6007 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6008 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6009 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6010
6011 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6012 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6013
6014 @table @code
6015 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6016 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6017 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6018 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6019 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6020 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6021
6022 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6023 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6024 symbolic address.
6025 @end table
6026
6027 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6028 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6029 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6030 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6031 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6032 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6033 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6034 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6035
6036 @smallexample
6037 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6038 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6039 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6040 @end smallexample
6041
6042 @quotation
6043 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6044 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6045 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6046 @end quotation
6047
6048 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6049
6050 @table @code
6051 @item set print array
6052 @itemx set print array on
6053 @cindex pretty print arrays
6054 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6055 but uses more space. The default is off.
6056
6057 @item set print array off
6058 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6059
6060 @item show print array
6061 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6062 arrays.
6063
6064 @cindex print array indexes
6065 @item set print array-indexes
6066 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6067 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6068 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6069 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6070
6071 @item set print array-indexes off
6072 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6073
6074 @item show print array-indexes
6075 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6076 arrays.
6077
6078 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6079 @cindex number of array elements to print
6080 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6081 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6082 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6083 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6084 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6085 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6086 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6087
6088 @item show print elements
6089 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6090 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6091
6092 @item set print repeats
6093 @cindex repeated array elements
6094 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6095 elelments. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6096 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6097 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6098 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6099 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6100 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6101
6102 @item show print repeats
6103 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6104 elements.
6105
6106 @item set print null-stop
6107 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6108 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6109 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6110 contain only short strings.
6111 The default is off.
6112
6113 @item show print null-stop
6114 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6115 @sc{null} character.
6116
6117 @item set print pretty on
6118 @cindex print structures in indented form
6119 @cindex indentation in structure display
6120 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6121 per line, like this:
6122
6123 @smallexample
6124 @group
6125 $1 = @{
6126 next = 0x0,
6127 flags = @{
6128 sweet = 1,
6129 sour = 1
6130 @},
6131 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6132 @}
6133 @end group
6134 @end smallexample
6135
6136 @item set print pretty off
6137 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6138
6139 @smallexample
6140 @group
6141 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6142 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6143 @end group
6144 @end smallexample
6145
6146 @noindent
6147 This is the default format.
6148
6149 @item show print pretty
6150 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6151
6152 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6153 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6154 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6155 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6156 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6157 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6158 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6159 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6160
6161 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6162 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6163 international character sets, and is the default.
6164
6165 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6166 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6167
6168 @item set print union on
6169 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6170 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6171 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6172
6173 @item set print union off
6174 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6175 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6176 instead.
6177
6178 @item show print union
6179 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6180 structures and other unions.
6181
6182 For example, given the declarations
6183
6184 @smallexample
6185 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6186 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6187 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6188 Bug_forms;
6189
6190 struct thing @{
6191 Species it;
6192 union @{
6193 Tree_forms tree;
6194 Bug_forms bug;
6195 @} form;
6196 @};
6197
6198 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6199 @end smallexample
6200
6201 @noindent
6202 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6203
6204 @smallexample
6205 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6206 @end smallexample
6207
6208 @noindent
6209 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6210
6211 @smallexample
6212 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6213 @end smallexample
6214
6215 @noindent
6216 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6217 and in Pascal.
6218 @end table
6219
6220 @need 1000
6221 @noindent
6222 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6223
6224 @table @code
6225 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6226 @item set print demangle
6227 @itemx set print demangle on
6228 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6229 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6230 linkage. The default is on.
6231
6232 @item show print demangle
6233 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6234
6235 @item set print asm-demangle
6236 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6237 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6238 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6239 The default is off.
6240
6241 @item show print asm-demangle
6242 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6243 or demangled form.
6244
6245 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6246 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6247 @kindex set demangle-style
6248 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6249 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6250 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6251
6252 @table @code
6253 @item auto
6254 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6255
6256 @item gnu
6257 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6258 This is the default.
6259
6260 @item hp
6261 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6262
6263 @item lucid
6264 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6265
6266 @item arm
6267 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6268 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6269 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6270 require further enhancement to permit that.
6271
6272 @end table
6273 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6274
6275 @item show demangle-style
6276 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6277
6278 @item set print object
6279 @itemx set print object on
6280 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6281 @cindex display derived types
6282 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6283 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6284 the virtual function table.
6285
6286 @item set print object off
6287 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6288 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6289
6290 @item show print object
6291 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6292
6293 @item set print static-members
6294 @itemx set print static-members on
6295 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6296 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6297
6298 @item set print static-members off
6299 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6300
6301 @item show print static-members
6302 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6303
6304 @item set print pascal_static-members
6305 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6306 @cindex static members of Pacal objects
6307 @cindex Pacal objects, static members display
6308 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6309
6310 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6311 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6312
6313 @item show print pascal_static-members
6314 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6315
6316 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6317 @item set print vtbl
6318 @itemx set print vtbl on
6319 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6320 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6321 @cindex VTBL display
6322 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6323 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6324 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6325
6326 @item set print vtbl off
6327 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6328
6329 @item show print vtbl
6330 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6331 @end table
6332
6333 @node Value History
6334 @section Value history
6335
6336 @cindex value history
6337 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6338 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6339 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6340 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6341 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6342 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6343 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6344 symbol table.
6345
6346 @cindex @code{$}
6347 @cindex @code{$$}
6348 @cindex history number
6349 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6350 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6351 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6352 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6353 history number.
6354
6355 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6356 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6357 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6358 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6359 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6360 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6361 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6362
6363 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6364 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6365
6366 @smallexample
6367 p *$
6368 @end smallexample
6369
6370 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6371 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6372
6373 @smallexample
6374 p *$.next
6375 @end smallexample
6376
6377 @noindent
6378 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6379 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6380
6381 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6382 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6383
6384 @smallexample
6385 print x
6386 set x=5
6387 @end smallexample
6388
6389 @noindent
6390 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6391 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6392
6393 @table @code
6394 @kindex show values
6395 @item show values
6396 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6397 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6398 values} does not change the history.
6399
6400 @item show values @var{n}
6401 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6402
6403 @item show values +
6404 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6405 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6406 @end table
6407
6408 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6409 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6410
6411 @node Convenience Vars
6412 @section Convenience variables
6413
6414 @cindex convenience variables
6415 @cindex user-defined variables
6416 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6417 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6418 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6419 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6420 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6421
6422 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6423 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6424 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6425 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6426 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
6427
6428 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6429 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6430 For example:
6431
6432 @smallexample
6433 set $foo = *object_ptr
6434 @end smallexample
6435
6436 @noindent
6437 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6438 @code{object_ptr}.
6439
6440 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6441 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6442 value with another assignment at any time.
6443
6444 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6445 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6446 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6447 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6448
6449 @table @code
6450 @kindex show convenience
6451 @cindex show all user variables
6452 @item show convenience
6453 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6454 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6455
6456 @kindex init-if-undefined
6457 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6458 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6459 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6460 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6461 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6462 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6463 override default values used in a command script.
6464
6465 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6466 any side-effects do not occur.
6467 @end table
6468
6469 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6470 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6471 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6472
6473 @smallexample
6474 set $i = 0
6475 print bar[$i++]->contents
6476 @end smallexample
6477
6478 @noindent
6479 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6480
6481 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6482 values likely to be useful.
6483
6484 @table @code
6485 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6486 @item $_
6487 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6488 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
6489 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6490 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6491 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6492 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6493 to the type of @code{$__}.
6494
6495 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6496 @item $__
6497 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6498 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6499 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6500
6501 @item $_exitcode
6502 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6503 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6504 the program being debugged terminates.
6505 @end table
6506
6507 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6508 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6509 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6510
6511 @node Registers
6512 @section Registers
6513
6514 @cindex registers
6515 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6516 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6517 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6518 your machine.
6519
6520 @table @code
6521 @kindex info registers
6522 @item info registers
6523 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6524 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6525
6526 @kindex info all-registers
6527 @cindex floating point registers
6528 @item info all-registers
6529 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6530 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6531
6532 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6533 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6534 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6535 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6536 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6537 @end table
6538
6539 @cindex stack pointer register
6540 @cindex program counter register
6541 @cindex process status register
6542 @cindex frame pointer register
6543 @cindex standard registers
6544 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6545 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6546 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6547 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6548 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6549 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6550 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6551 you could print the program counter in hex with
6552
6553 @smallexample
6554 p/x $pc
6555 @end smallexample
6556
6557 @noindent
6558 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6559
6560 @smallexample
6561 x/i $pc
6562 @end smallexample
6563
6564 @noindent
6565 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6566 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6567 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6568 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6569 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6570 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6571 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
6572
6573 @smallexample
6574 set $sp += 4
6575 @end smallexample
6576
6577 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6578 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6579 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6580 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6581 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6582 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6583 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6584
6585 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6586 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6587 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6588 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6589 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6590 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6591 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6592
6593 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6594 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6595 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6596 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6597 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6598 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6599 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6600 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6601 prints the data in both formats.
6602
6603 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
6604 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
6605 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6606 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6607 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6608 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6609 registers in @code{struct} notation:
6610
6611 @smallexample
6612 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6613 $1 = @{
6614 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6615 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6616 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6617 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6618 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6619 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6620 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6621 @}
6622 @end smallexample
6623
6624 @noindent
6625 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6626 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6627 value to a @code{struct} member:
6628
6629 @smallexample
6630 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6631 @end smallexample
6632
6633 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6634 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
6635 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6636 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6637 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6638 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6639
6640 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6641 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6642 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6643 frame makes no difference.
6644
6645 @node Floating Point Hardware
6646 @section Floating point hardware
6647 @cindex floating point
6648
6649 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6650 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6651
6652 @table @code
6653 @kindex info float
6654 @item info float
6655 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6656 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6657 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6658 the ARM and x86 machines.
6659 @end table
6660
6661 @node Vector Unit
6662 @section Vector Unit
6663 @cindex vector unit
6664
6665 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6666 more information about the status of the vector unit.
6667
6668 @table @code
6669 @kindex info vector
6670 @item info vector
6671 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6672 layout vary depending on the hardware.
6673 @end table
6674
6675 @node OS Information
6676 @section Operating system auxiliary information
6677 @cindex OS information
6678
6679 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6680 you debug your program.
6681
6682 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6683 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
6684 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6685 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6686 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6687 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6688 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6689 structure.
6690
6691 @table @code
6692 @item info udot
6693 @kindex info udot
6694 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6695 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6696 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6697 the @code{examine} command.
6698 @end table
6699
6700 @cindex auxiliary vector
6701 @cindex vector, auxiliary
6702 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6703 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6704 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6705 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6706 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6707 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6708 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6709 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6710 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6711 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see @ref{Remote
6712 configuration, auxiliary vector}.
6713
6714 @table @code
6715 @kindex info auxv
6716 @item info auxv
6717 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6718 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6719 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6720 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6721 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6722 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6723 an unrecognized tag.
6724 @end table
6725
6726
6727 @node Memory Region Attributes
6728 @section Memory region attributes
6729 @cindex memory region attributes
6730
6731 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
6732 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
6733 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
6734 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
6735 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
6736 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
6737 user can override the fetched regions.
6738
6739 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6740 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6741 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
6742 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
6743 all memory.
6744
6745 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
6746 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
6747
6748 @table @code
6749 @kindex mem
6750 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
6751 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
6752 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
6753 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
6754 case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
6755 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
6756
6757 @item mem auto
6758 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
6759 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
6760
6761 @kindex delete mem
6762 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6763 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
6764 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
6765
6766 @kindex disable mem
6767 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6768 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6769 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
6770 It may be enabled again later.
6771
6772 @kindex enable mem
6773 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6774 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6775
6776 @kindex info mem
6777 @item info mem
6778 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
6779 for each region:
6780
6781 @table @emph
6782 @item Memory Region Number
6783 @item Enabled or Disabled.
6784 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
6785 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
6786
6787 @item Lo Address
6788 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
6789
6790 @item Hi Address
6791 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
6792
6793 @item Attributes
6794 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
6795 @end table
6796 @end table
6797
6798
6799 @subsection Attributes
6800
6801 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
6802 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
6803 write accesses to a memory region.
6804
6805 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
6806 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
6807 etc.@: from accessing memory.
6808
6809 @table @code
6810 @item ro
6811 Memory is read only.
6812 @item wo
6813 Memory is write only.
6814 @item rw
6815 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
6816 @end table
6817
6818 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
6819 The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
6820 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
6821 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
6822 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
6823
6824 @table @code
6825 @item 8
6826 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
6827 @item 16
6828 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
6829 @item 32
6830 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
6831 @item 64
6832 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
6833 @end table
6834
6835 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
6836 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6837 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
6838 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
6839 @c
6840 @c @table @code
6841 @c @item hwbreak
6842 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
6843 @c @item swbreak (default)
6844 @c @end table
6845
6846 @subsubsection Data Cache
6847 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
6848 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
6849 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
6850 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
6851 registers.
6852
6853 @table @code
6854 @item cache
6855 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6856 @item nocache
6857 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
6858 @end table
6859
6860 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
6861 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6862 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
6863 @c
6864 @c @table @code
6865 @c @item verify
6866 @c @item noverify (default)
6867 @c @end table
6868
6869 @node Dump/Restore Files
6870 @section Copy between memory and a file
6871 @cindex dump/restore files
6872 @cindex append data to a file
6873 @cindex dump data to a file
6874 @cindex restore data from a file
6875
6876 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
6877 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
6878 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
6879 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
6880 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
6881 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
6882 files.
6883
6884 @table @code
6885
6886 @kindex dump
6887 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6888 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6889 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6890 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
6891
6892 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
6893 @table @code
6894 @item binary
6895 Raw binary form.
6896 @item ihex
6897 Intel hex format.
6898 @item srec
6899 Motorola S-record format.
6900 @item tekhex
6901 Tektronix Hex format.
6902 @end table
6903
6904 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
6905 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
6906 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
6907 form.
6908
6909 @kindex append
6910 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6911 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6912 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6913 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
6914 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
6915
6916 @kindex restore
6917 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
6918 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
6919 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
6920 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
6921 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
6922
6923 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
6924 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
6925 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
6926 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
6927 from that location.
6928
6929 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
6930 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
6931 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
6932 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
6933
6934 @end table
6935
6936 @node Core File Generation
6937 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
6938 @cindex dump core from inferior
6939
6940 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
6941 image of a running process and its process status (register values
6942 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
6943 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
6944 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
6945 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
6946 the post-mortem debugging mode.
6947
6948 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
6949 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
6950 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
6951
6952 @table @code
6953 @kindex gcore
6954 @kindex generate-core-file
6955 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
6956 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
6957 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
6958 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
6959 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
6960 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
6961
6962 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
6963 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
6964 @end table
6965
6966 @node Character Sets
6967 @section Character Sets
6968 @cindex character sets
6969 @cindex charset
6970 @cindex translating between character sets
6971 @cindex host character set
6972 @cindex target character set
6973
6974 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
6975 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
6976 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
6977 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
6978 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
6979 @dfn{target character set}.
6980
6981 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
6982 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
6983 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
6984 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
6985 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
6986 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
6987 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
6988 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
6989 character and string literals in expressions.
6990
6991 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
6992 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
6993 target-charset} command, described below.
6994
6995 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
6996 support:
6997
6998 @table @code
6999 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7000 @kindex set target-charset
7001 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7002 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7003 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7004 list the target character sets it supports.
7005 @end table
7006
7007 @table @code
7008 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7009 @kindex set host-charset
7010 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7011
7012 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7013 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7014 @code{set host-charset} command.
7015
7016 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7017 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7018 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7019 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7020 list the host character sets it supports.
7021
7022 @item set charset @var{charset}
7023 @kindex set charset
7024 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7025 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7026 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7027 for both host and target.
7028
7029
7030 @item show charset
7031 @kindex show charset
7032 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7033
7034 @itemx show host-charset
7035 @kindex show host-charset
7036 Show the name of the current host charset.
7037
7038 @itemx show target-charset
7039 @kindex show target-charset
7040 Show the name of the current target charset.
7041
7042 @end table
7043
7044 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7045 sets:
7046
7047 @table @code
7048
7049 @item ASCII
7050 @cindex ASCII character set
7051 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7052 character set.
7053
7054 @item ISO-8859-1
7055 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7056 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7057 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7058 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7059 this as its host character set.
7060
7061 @item EBCDIC-US
7062 @itemx IBM1047
7063 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7064 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7065 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7066 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7067 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7068
7069 @end table
7070
7071 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7072 GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7073 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7074
7075 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7076 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7077 @file{charset-test.c}:
7078
7079 @smallexample
7080 #include <stdio.h>
7081
7082 char ascii_hello[]
7083 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7084 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7085 char ibm1047_hello[]
7086 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7087 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7088
7089 main ()
7090 @{
7091 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7092 @}
7093 @end smallexample
7094
7095 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7096 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7097 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7098
7099 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7100
7101 @smallexample
7102 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7103 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7104 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7105 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7106 @dots{}
7107 (@value{GDBP})
7108 @end smallexample
7109
7110 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7111 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7112 strings:
7113
7114 @smallexample
7115 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7116 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7117 (@value{GDBP})
7118 @end smallexample
7119
7120 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7121 initial character set:
7122 @smallexample
7123 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7124 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7125 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7126 (@value{GDBP})
7127 @end smallexample
7128
7129 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7130 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7131 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7132 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7133 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7134
7135 @smallexample
7136 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7137 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7138 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7139 $2 = 72 'H'
7140 (@value{GDBP})
7141 @end smallexample
7142
7143 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7144 literals you use in expressions:
7145
7146 @smallexample
7147 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7148 $3 = 43 '+'
7149 (@value{GDBP})
7150 @end smallexample
7151
7152 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7153 character.
7154
7155 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7156 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7157 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7158
7159 @smallexample
7160 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7161 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7162 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7163 $5 = 200 '\310'
7164 (@value{GDBP})
7165 @end smallexample
7166
7167 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7168 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7169
7170 @smallexample
7171 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7172 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7173 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7174 @end smallexample
7175
7176 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7177 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7178 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7179 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7180 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7181
7182 @smallexample
7183 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7184 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7185 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7186 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7187 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7188 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7189 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7190 $7 = 72 '\110'
7191 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7192 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7193 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7194 $9 = 200 'H'
7195 (@value{GDBP})
7196 @end smallexample
7197
7198 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7199 string literals you use in expressions:
7200
7201 @smallexample
7202 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7203 $10 = 78 '+'
7204 (@value{GDBP})
7205 @end smallexample
7206
7207 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7208 character.
7209
7210 @node Caching Remote Data
7211 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7212 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7213
7214 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7215 remote target (@pxref{Remote}). Such caching generally improves
7216 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7217 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7218 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7219 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7220 volatile registers are in use.
7221
7222 @table @code
7223 @kindex set remotecache
7224 @item set remotecache on
7225 @itemx set remotecache off
7226 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7227 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7228
7229 @kindex show remotecache
7230 @item show remotecache
7231 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7232
7233 @kindex info dcache
7234 @item info dcache
7235 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7236 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7237 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7238 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7239 the data cache operation.
7240 @end table
7241
7242
7243 @node Macros
7244 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7245
7246 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7247 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7248 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7249 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7250 where it was defined.
7251
7252 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7253 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7254 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7255 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7256
7257 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7258 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7259 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7260 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7261 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7262 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7263 see @ref{List}.
7264
7265 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7266 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7267 variable-arity macros.
7268
7269 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7270 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7271 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7272
7273 @table @code
7274
7275 @kindex macro expand
7276 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7277 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7278 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7279 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7280 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7281 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7282 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7283 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7284 it can be any string of tokens.
7285
7286 @kindex macro exp1
7287 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7288 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7289 @cindex expand macro once
7290 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7291 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7292 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7293 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7294 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7295 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7296 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7297 can be any string of tokens.
7298
7299 @kindex info macro
7300 @cindex macro definition, showing
7301 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7302 @item info macro @var{macro}
7303 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7304 source location where that definition was established.
7305
7306 @kindex macro define
7307 @cindex user-defined macros
7308 @cindex defining macros interactively
7309 @cindex macros, user-defined
7310 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7311 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7312 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7313 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7314 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7315 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7316 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7317 given in @var{arglist}.
7318
7319 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7320 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7321 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7322 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7323 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7324
7325 @kindex macro undef
7326 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7327 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7328 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7329 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7330 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7331 debugged.
7332
7333 @kindex macro list
7334 @item macro list
7335 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7336 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7337 @end table
7338
7339 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7340 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7341 show our source files:
7342
7343 @smallexample
7344 $ cat sample.c
7345 #include <stdio.h>
7346 #include "sample.h"
7347
7348 #define M 42
7349 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7350
7351 main ()
7352 @{
7353 #define N 28
7354 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7355 #undef N
7356 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7357 #define N 1729
7358 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7359 @}
7360 $ cat sample.h
7361 #define Q <
7362 $
7363 @end smallexample
7364
7365 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7366 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7367 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7368 information.
7369
7370 @smallexample
7371 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7372 $
7373 @end smallexample
7374
7375 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7376
7377 @smallexample
7378 $ gdb -nw sample
7379 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7380 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7381 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7382 (@value{GDBP})
7383 @end smallexample
7384
7385 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7386 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7387 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7388
7389 @smallexample
7390 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7391 3
7392 4 #define M 42
7393 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7394 6
7395 7 main ()
7396 8 @{
7397 9 #define N 28
7398 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7399 11 #undef N
7400 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7401 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7402 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7403 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7404 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7405 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7406 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7407 #define Q <
7408 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7409 expands to: (42 + 1)
7410 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7411 expands to: once (M + 1)
7412 (@value{GDBP})
7413 @end smallexample
7414
7415 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7416 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7417 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7418 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7419
7420 Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
7421 the source line of the current stack frame:
7422
7423 @smallexample
7424 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7425 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7426 (@value{GDBP}) run
7427 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7428
7429 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7430 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7431 (@value{GDBP})
7432 @end smallexample
7433
7434 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7435
7436 @smallexample
7437 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7438 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7439 #define N 28
7440 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7441 expands to: 28 < 42
7442 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7443 $1 = 1
7444 (@value{GDBP})
7445 @end smallexample
7446
7447 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7448 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7449 thereof) in force at each point:
7450
7451 @smallexample
7452 (@value{GDBP}) next
7453 Hello, world!
7454 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7455 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7456 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7457 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7458 (@value{GDBP}) next
7459 We're so creative.
7460 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7461 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7462 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7463 #define N 1729
7464 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7465 expands to: 1729 < 42
7466 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7467 $2 = 0
7468 (@value{GDBP})
7469 @end smallexample
7470
7471
7472 @node Tracepoints
7473 @chapter Tracepoints
7474 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7475 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7476
7477 @cindex tracepoints
7478 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7479 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7480 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7481 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7482 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7483 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7484 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7485
7486 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7487 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7488 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7489 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7490 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7491 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7492 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7493 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7494 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7495 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7496 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7497
7498 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7499 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7500 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7501 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7502 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7503 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7504 Packets}.
7505
7506 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7507
7508 @menu
7509 * Set Tracepoints::
7510 * Analyze Collected Data::
7511 * Tracepoint Variables::
7512 @end menu
7513
7514 @node Set Tracepoints
7515 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7516
7517 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7518 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7519 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7520 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7521 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7522 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7523 work on.
7524
7525 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7526 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7527 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7528 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7529 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7530 tracepoint was hit.
7531
7532 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7533 conditions and actions.
7534
7535 @menu
7536 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7537 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7538 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7539 * Tracepoint Actions::
7540 * Listing Tracepoints::
7541 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
7542 @end menu
7543
7544 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7545 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7546
7547 @table @code
7548 @cindex set tracepoint
7549 @kindex trace
7550 @item trace
7551 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7552 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7553 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7554 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7555 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7556 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7557 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7558 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7559 running.
7560
7561 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7562
7563 @smallexample
7564 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7565
7566 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7567
7568 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7569
7570 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7571
7572 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7573 @end smallexample
7574
7575 @noindent
7576 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7577
7578 @vindex $tpnum
7579 @cindex last tracepoint number
7580 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7581 @cindex tracepoint number
7582 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7583 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7584
7585 @kindex delete tracepoint
7586 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7587 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7588 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7589 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7590
7591 Examples:
7592
7593 @smallexample
7594 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7595
7596 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7597 @end smallexample
7598
7599 @noindent
7600 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7601 @end table
7602
7603 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7604 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7605
7606 @table @code
7607 @kindex disable tracepoint
7608 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7609 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7610 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7611 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7612 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7613
7614 @kindex enable tracepoint
7615 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7616 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7617 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7618 run.
7619 @end table
7620
7621 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7622 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7623
7624 @table @code
7625 @kindex passcount
7626 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7627 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7628 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7629 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7630 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7631 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7632 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7633 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7634 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7635 user.
7636
7637 Examples:
7638
7639 @smallexample
7640 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7641 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7642
7643 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7644 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7645 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7646 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7647 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7649 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7650 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7651 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7652 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7653 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7654 @end smallexample
7655 @end table
7656
7657 @node Tracepoint Actions
7658 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7659
7660 @table @code
7661 @kindex actions
7662 @cindex tracepoint actions
7663 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7664 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7665 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7666 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7667 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7668 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7669 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7670 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7671 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7672 @code{while-stepping}.
7673
7674 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7675 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7676 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7677
7678 @smallexample
7679 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7680
7681 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7682
7683 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7684 @end smallexample
7685
7686 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7687 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7688 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7689 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7690 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7691 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7692 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7693 @code{end} command.
7694
7695 @smallexample
7696 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7698 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7699 > collect bar,baz
7700 > collect $regs
7701 > while-stepping 12
7702 > collect $fp, $sp
7703 > end
7704 end
7705 @end smallexample
7706
7707 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7708 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7709 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7710 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
7711 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
7712 special arguments are supported:
7713
7714 @table @code
7715 @item $regs
7716 collect all registers
7717
7718 @item $args
7719 collect all function arguments
7720
7721 @item $locals
7722 collect all local variables.
7723 @end table
7724
7725 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
7726 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
7727 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
7728
7729 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
7730 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
7731
7732 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
7733 @item while-stepping @var{n}
7734 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
7735 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
7736 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
7737 its own @code{end} command):
7738
7739 @smallexample
7740 > while-stepping 12
7741 > collect $regs, myglobal
7742 > end
7743 >
7744 @end smallexample
7745
7746 @noindent
7747 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
7748 @code{stepping}.
7749 @end table
7750
7751 @node Listing Tracepoints
7752 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
7753
7754 @table @code
7755 @kindex info tracepoints
7756 @kindex info tp
7757 @cindex information about tracepoints
7758 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7759 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
7760 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
7761 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
7762 shown:
7763
7764 @itemize @bullet
7765 @item
7766 its number
7767 @item
7768 whether it is enabled or disabled
7769 @item
7770 its address
7771 @item
7772 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
7773 @item
7774 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
7775 @item
7776 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
7777 @item
7778 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
7779 @end itemize
7780
7781 @smallexample
7782 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
7783 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
7784 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
7785 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
7786 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
7787 (@value{GDBP})
7788 @end smallexample
7789
7790 @noindent
7791 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
7792 @end table
7793
7794 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7795 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7796
7797 @table @code
7798 @kindex tstart
7799 @cindex start a new trace experiment
7800 @cindex collected data discarded
7801 @item tstart
7802 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
7803 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
7804 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
7805 experiment.
7806
7807 @kindex tstop
7808 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
7809 @item tstop
7810 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
7811 stops collecting data.
7812
7813 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
7814 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
7815 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
7816
7817 @kindex tstatus
7818 @cindex status of trace data collection
7819 @cindex trace experiment, status of
7820 @item tstatus
7821 This command displays the status of the current trace data
7822 collection.
7823 @end table
7824
7825 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
7826
7827 @smallexample
7828 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
7829 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7830 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
7831 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
7832 > while-stepping 11
7833 > collect $regs
7834 > end
7835 > end
7836 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7837 [time passes @dots{}]
7838 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
7839 @end smallexample
7840
7841
7842 @node Analyze Collected Data
7843 @section Using the collected data
7844
7845 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
7846 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
7847 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
7848 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
7849 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
7850 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
7851 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
7852 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
7853 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
7854 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
7855 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
7856 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
7857 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
7858 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
7859 the buffer will fail.
7860
7861 @menu
7862 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
7863 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
7864 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
7865 @end menu
7866
7867 @node tfind
7868 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
7869
7870 @kindex tfind
7871 @cindex select trace snapshot
7872 @cindex find trace snapshot
7873 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
7874 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
7875 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
7876 snapshot is selected.
7877
7878 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
7879
7880 @table @code
7881 @item tfind start
7882 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
7883 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
7884
7885 @item tfind none
7886 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
7887
7888 @item tfind end
7889 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
7890
7891 @item tfind
7892 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
7893
7894 @item tfind -
7895 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
7896 retracing earlier steps.
7897
7898 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
7899 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
7900 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
7901 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
7902 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
7903
7904 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
7905 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
7906 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
7907 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
7908 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
7909
7910 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
7911 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
7912 addresses.
7913
7914 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
7915 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
7916 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
7917
7918 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
7919 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
7920 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
7921 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
7922 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
7923 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
7924 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
7925 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
7926 @end table
7927
7928 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
7929 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
7930 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
7931 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
7932 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
7933 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
7934 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
7935 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
7936 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
7937 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
7938 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
7939 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
7940 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
7941 tracepoint as the current one.
7942
7943 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
7944 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
7945 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
7946 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
7947 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
7948
7949 @smallexample
7950 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7951 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
7952 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
7953 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
7954 > tfind
7955 > end
7956
7957 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
7958 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
7959 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
7960 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
7961 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
7962 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
7963 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
7964 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
7965 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
7966 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
7967 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
7968 @end smallexample
7969
7970 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
7971 the buffer:
7972
7973 @smallexample
7974 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7975 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
7976 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
7977 > tfind line
7978 > end
7979
7980 Frame 0, X = 1
7981 Frame 7, X = 2
7982 Frame 13, X = 255
7983 @end smallexample
7984
7985 @node tdump
7986 @subsection @code{tdump}
7987 @kindex tdump
7988 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
7989 @cindex tracepoint data, display
7990
7991 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
7992 the current trace snapshot.
7993
7994 @smallexample
7995 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
7996 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7997 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
7998 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
7999 > end
8000
8001 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8002
8003 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8004 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8005 at gdb_test.c:444
8006 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8007
8008 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8009 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8010 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8011 d1 0x18 24
8012 d2 0x80 128
8013 d3 0x33 51
8014 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8015 d5 0x22 34
8016 d6 0xe0 224
8017 d7 0x380035 3670069
8018 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8019 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8020 a2 0x100 256
8021 a3 0x322000 3284992
8022 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8023 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8024 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8025 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8026 ps 0x0 0
8027 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8028 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8029 fpstatus 0x0 0
8030 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8031 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8032 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8033 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8034 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8035 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8036 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8037 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8038 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8039
8040 (@value{GDBP})
8041 @end smallexample
8042
8043 @node save-tracepoints
8044 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8045 @kindex save-tracepoints
8046 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8047
8048 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8049 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8050 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8051 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8052 Files}).
8053
8054 @node Tracepoint Variables
8055 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8056 @cindex tracepoint variables
8057 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8058
8059 @table @code
8060 @vindex $trace_frame
8061 @item (int) $trace_frame
8062 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8063 snapshot is selected.
8064
8065 @vindex $tracepoint
8066 @item (int) $tracepoint
8067 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8068
8069 @vindex $trace_line
8070 @item (int) $trace_line
8071 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8072
8073 @vindex $trace_file
8074 @item (char []) $trace_file
8075 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8076
8077 @vindex $trace_func
8078 @item (char []) $trace_func
8079 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8080 @end table
8081
8082 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8083 use @code{output} instead.
8084
8085 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8086 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8087 data.
8088
8089 @smallexample
8090 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8091
8092 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8093 > output $trace_file
8094 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8095 > tfind
8096 > end
8097 @end smallexample
8098
8099 @node Overlays
8100 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8101 @cindex overlays
8102
8103 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8104 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8105 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8106 use overlays.
8107
8108 @menu
8109 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8110 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8111 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8112 mapped by asking the inferior.
8113 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8114 @end menu
8115
8116 @node How Overlays Work
8117 @section How Overlays Work
8118 @cindex mapped overlays
8119 @cindex unmapped overlays
8120 @cindex load address, overlay's
8121 @cindex mapped address
8122 @cindex overlay area
8123
8124 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8125 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8126 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8127 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8128 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8129
8130 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8131 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8132 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8133 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8134 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8135 largest overlay as well.
8136
8137 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8138 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8139 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8140 there.
8141
8142 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8143 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8144 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8145
8146 @smallexample
8147 @group
8148 Data Instruction Larger
8149 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8150 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8151 | | | | | |
8152 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8153 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8154 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8155 | and heap | | | | | |
8156 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8157 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8158 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8159 | | | | | |
8160 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8161 address | | | | | |
8162 | overlay | <-' | | |
8163 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8164 | | <---. | | load address
8165 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8166 | | | |
8167 +-----------+ | |
8168 +-----------+
8169 | |
8170 +-----------+
8171
8172 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8173 @end group
8174 @end smallexample
8175
8176 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8177 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8178 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8179 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8180 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8181 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8182 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8183 program and the overlay area.
8184
8185 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8186 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8187 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8188 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8189 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8190 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8191 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8192
8193 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8194 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8195 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8196
8197 @itemize @bullet
8198
8199 @item
8200 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8201 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8202 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8203 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8204
8205 @item
8206 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8207 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8208 your program's performance.
8209
8210 @item
8211 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8212 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8213 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8214 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8215 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8216 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8217 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8218
8219 @item
8220 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8221 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8222 instruction and data spaces.
8223
8224 @end itemize
8225
8226 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8227 improved in many ways:
8228
8229 @itemize @bullet
8230
8231 @item
8232 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8233 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8234 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8235 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8236 area in the usual way.
8237
8238 @item
8239 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8240 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8241
8242 @item
8243 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8244 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8245 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8246 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8247 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8248 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8249 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8250
8251 @end itemize
8252
8253
8254 @node Overlay Commands
8255 @section Overlay Commands
8256
8257 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8258 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8259 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8260 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8261 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8262 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8263
8264 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8265 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8266
8267 @table @code
8268 @item overlay off
8269 @kindex overlay
8270 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8271 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8272 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8273 overlay support is disabled.
8274
8275 @item overlay manual
8276 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8277 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8278 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8279 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8280 commands described below.
8281
8282 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8283 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8284 @cindex map an overlay
8285 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8286 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8287 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8288 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8289 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8290 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8291
8292 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8293 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8294 @cindex unmap an overlay
8295 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8296 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8297 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8298 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8299
8300 @item overlay auto
8301 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8302 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8303 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8304 Overlay Debugging}.
8305
8306 @item overlay load-target
8307 @itemx overlay load
8308 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8309 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8310 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8311 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8312 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8313 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8314
8315 @item overlay list-overlays
8316 @itemx overlay list
8317 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8318 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8319 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8320
8321 @end table
8322
8323 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8324 of the function the address falls in:
8325
8326 @smallexample
8327 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8328 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8329 @end smallexample
8330 @noindent
8331 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8332 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8333 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8334 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8335
8336 @smallexample
8337 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8338 No sections are mapped.
8339 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8340 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8341 @end smallexample
8342 @noindent
8343 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8344 name normally:
8345
8346 @smallexample
8347 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8348 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8349 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8350 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8351 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8352 @end smallexample
8353
8354 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8355 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8356 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8357 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8358 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8359
8360 @itemize @bullet
8361 @item
8362 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8363 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8364 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8365 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8366 @item
8367 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8368 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8369 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8370 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8371 breakpoints properly.
8372 @end itemize
8373
8374
8375 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8376 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8377 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8378
8379 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8380 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8381 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8382 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8383 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8384 current state of the overlays.
8385
8386 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8387 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8388
8389 @table @asis
8390
8391 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8392 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8393
8394 @smallexample
8395 struct
8396 @{
8397 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8398 unsigned long vma;
8399
8400 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8401 unsigned long size;
8402
8403 /* The overlay's load address. */
8404 unsigned long lma;
8405
8406 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8407 zero otherwise. */
8408 unsigned long mapped;
8409 @}
8410 @end smallexample
8411
8412 @item @code{_novlys}:
8413 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8414 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8415
8416 @end table
8417
8418 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8419 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8420 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8421 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8422 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8423 currently mapped.
8424
8425 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8426 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8427 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8428 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8429 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8430 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8431 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8432 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8433 are not being executed.
8434
8435 @node Overlay Sample Program
8436 @section Overlay Sample Program
8437 @cindex overlay example program
8438
8439 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8440 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8441 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8442 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8443 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8444 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8445 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8446
8447 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8448 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8449 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8450 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8451
8452 @table @file
8453 @item overlays.c
8454 The main program file.
8455 @item ovlymgr.c
8456 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8457 @item foo.c
8458 @itemx bar.c
8459 @itemx baz.c
8460 @itemx grbx.c
8461 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8462 @item d10v.ld
8463 @itemx m32r.ld
8464 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8465 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8466 @end table
8467
8468 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8469 cross-compiler like this:
8470
8471 @smallexample
8472 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8473 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8474 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8475 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8476 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8477 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8478 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8479 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8480 @end smallexample
8481
8482 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8483 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8484 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8485
8486
8487 @node Languages
8488 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8489 @cindex languages
8490
8491 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8492 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8493 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8494 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8495 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8496 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8497
8498 @cindex working language
8499 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8500 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8501 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8502 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8503 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8504 language}.
8505
8506 @menu
8507 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8508 * Show:: Displaying the language
8509 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8510 * Supported languages:: Supported languages
8511 * Unsupported languages:: Unsupported languages
8512 @end menu
8513
8514 @node Setting
8515 @section Switching between source languages
8516
8517 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8518 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8519 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8520 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8521 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8522 are printed, etc.
8523
8524 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8525 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8526 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8527 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8528 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8529 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8530 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8531 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8532 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8533 Displaying the language}.
8534
8535 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8536 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8537 another language. In that case, make the
8538 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8539 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8540 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8541
8542 @menu
8543 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8544 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8545 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8546 @end menu
8547
8548 @node Filenames
8549 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
8550
8551 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8552 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8553
8554 @table @file
8555 @item .ada
8556 @itemx .ads
8557 @itemx .adb
8558 @itemx .a
8559 Ada source file.
8560
8561 @item .c
8562 C source file
8563
8564 @item .C
8565 @itemx .cc
8566 @itemx .cp
8567 @itemx .cpp
8568 @itemx .cxx
8569 @itemx .c++
8570 C@t{++} source file
8571
8572 @item .m
8573 Objective-C source file
8574
8575 @item .f
8576 @itemx .F
8577 Fortran source file
8578
8579 @item .mod
8580 Modula-2 source file
8581
8582 @item .s
8583 @itemx .S
8584 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8585 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8586 @end table
8587
8588 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8589 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
8590
8591 @node Manually
8592 @subsection Setting the working language
8593
8594 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8595 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8596 your program.
8597
8598 @kindex set language
8599 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8600 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8601 a language, such as
8602 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8603 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8604
8605 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8606 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8607 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8608 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8609 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8610 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8611 command such as:
8612
8613 @smallexample
8614 print a = b + c
8615 @end smallexample
8616
8617 @noindent
8618 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8619 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8620 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8621 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8622
8623 @node Automatically
8624 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8625
8626 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8627 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8628 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8629 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8630 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8631 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8632 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8633 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8634 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8635
8636 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8637 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8638 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8639 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8640 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8641
8642 @node Show
8643 @section Displaying the language
8644
8645 The following commands help you find out which language is the
8646 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8647
8648 @table @code
8649 @item show language
8650 @kindex show language
8651 Display the current working language. This is the
8652 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8653 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8654
8655 @item info frame
8656 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8657 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8658 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8659 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
8660 information listed here.
8661
8662 @item info source
8663 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8664 Display the source language of this source file.
8665 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8666 information listed here.
8667 @end table
8668
8669 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8670 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8671 with a language explicitly:
8672
8673 @table @code
8674 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8675 @kindex set extension-language
8676 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8677 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8678
8679 @item info extensions
8680 @kindex info extensions
8681 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8682 @end table
8683
8684 @node Checks
8685 @section Type and range checking
8686
8687 @quotation
8688 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8689 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8690 section documents the intended facilities.
8691 @end quotation
8692 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8693
8694 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8695 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8696 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8697 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8698 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8699 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8700 errors when your program is running.
8701
8702 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8703 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8704 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8705 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8706 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8707 automatically based on your program's source language.
8708 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default
8709 settings of supported languages.
8710
8711 @menu
8712 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
8713 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
8714 @end menu
8715
8716 @cindex type checking
8717 @cindex checks, type
8718 @node Type Checking
8719 @subsection An overview of type checking
8720
8721 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
8722 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
8723 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
8724 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
8725
8726 @smallexample
8727 1 + 2 @result{} 3
8728 @exdent but
8729 @error{} 1 + 2.3
8730 @end smallexample
8731
8732 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
8733 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
8734
8735 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
8736 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
8737 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
8738 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
8739 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
8740 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
8741 also issues a warning.
8742
8743 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
8744 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
8745 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
8746 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
8747 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
8748 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
8749
8750 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
8751 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
8752 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
8753 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
8754 operators. @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for further
8755 details on specific languages.
8756
8757 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
8758
8759 @kindex set check type
8760 @kindex show check type
8761 @table @code
8762 @item set check type auto
8763 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
8764 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8765 each language.
8766
8767 @item set check type on
8768 @itemx set check type off
8769 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8770 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
8771 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
8772 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
8773 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
8774
8775 @item set check type warn
8776 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
8777 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
8778 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
8779 numbers and structures.
8780
8781 @item show type
8782 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
8783 is setting it automatically.
8784 @end table
8785
8786 @cindex range checking
8787 @cindex checks, range
8788 @node Range Checking
8789 @subsection An overview of range checking
8790
8791 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
8792 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
8793 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
8794 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
8795 not exceed the bounds of the array.
8796
8797 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
8798 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
8799 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
8800 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
8801
8802 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
8803 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
8804 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
8805 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
8806 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
8807 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
8808
8809 @smallexample
8810 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
8811 @end smallexample
8812
8813 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
8814 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported languages, ,
8815 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
8816
8817 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
8818
8819 @kindex set check range
8820 @kindex show check range
8821 @table @code
8822 @item set check range auto
8823 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
8824 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8825 each language.
8826
8827 @item set check range on
8828 @itemx set check range off
8829 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8830 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
8831 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
8832 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
8833
8834 @item set check range warn
8835 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
8836 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
8837 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
8838 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
8839 systems).
8840
8841 @item show range
8842 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
8843 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
8844 @end table
8845
8846 @node Supported languages
8847 @section Supported languages
8848
8849 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
8850 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
8851 @c This is false ...
8852 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
8853 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
8854 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
8855 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
8856 language.
8857
8858 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
8859 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
8860 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
8861 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
8862 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
8863 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
8864 language reference or tutorial.
8865
8866 @menu
8867 * C:: C and C@t{++}
8868 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
8869 * Fortran:: Fortran
8870 * Pascal:: Pascal
8871 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
8872 * Ada:: Ada
8873 @end menu
8874
8875 @node C
8876 @subsection C and C@t{++}
8877
8878 @cindex C and C@t{++}
8879 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
8880
8881 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
8882 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
8883 together.
8884
8885 @cindex C@t{++}
8886 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
8887 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
8888 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
8889 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
8890 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
8891 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
8892 compiler (@code{aCC}).
8893
8894 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
8895 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
8896 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
8897 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
8898 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
8899 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
8900
8901 @menu
8902 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
8903 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
8904 * C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
8905 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
8906 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
8907 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
8908 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
8909 @end menu
8910
8911 @node C Operators
8912 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
8913
8914 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
8915
8916 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8917 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8918 often defined on groups of types.
8919
8920 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
8921
8922 @itemize @bullet
8923
8924 @item
8925 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
8926 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
8927
8928 @item
8929 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
8930 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
8931
8932 @item
8933 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
8934
8935 @item
8936 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
8937
8938 @end itemize
8939
8940 @noindent
8941 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
8942 in order of increasing precedence:
8943
8944 @table @code
8945 @item ,
8946 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
8947 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
8948 expression being the last expression evaluated.
8949
8950 @item =
8951 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
8952 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
8953
8954 @item @var{op}=
8955 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
8956 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
8957 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
8958 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
8959 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
8960
8961 @item ?:
8962 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
8963 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
8964 integral type.
8965
8966 @item ||
8967 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8968
8969 @item &&
8970 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
8971
8972 @item |
8973 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8974
8975 @item ^
8976 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8977
8978 @item &
8979 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
8980
8981 @item ==@r{, }!=
8982 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
8983 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
8984
8985 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
8986 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
8987 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
8988 and non-zero for true.
8989
8990 @item <<@r{, }>>
8991 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
8992
8993 @item @@
8994 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8995
8996 @item +@r{, }-
8997 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
8998 pointer types.
8999
9000 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9001 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9002 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9003 integral types.
9004
9005 @item ++@r{, }--
9006 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9007 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9008 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9009 operation takes place.
9010
9011 @item *
9012 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9013 @code{++}.
9014
9015 @item &
9016 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9017
9018 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9019 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9020 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
9021 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9022 stored.
9023
9024 @item -
9025 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9026 precedence as @code{++}.
9027
9028 @item !
9029 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9030 @code{++}.
9031
9032 @item ~
9033 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9034 @code{++}.
9035
9036
9037 @item .@r{, }->
9038 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9039 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9040 pointer based on the stored type information.
9041 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9042
9043 @item .*@r{, }->*
9044 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9045
9046 @item []
9047 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9048 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9049
9050 @item ()
9051 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9052
9053 @item ::
9054 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9055 and @code{class} types.
9056
9057 @item ::
9058 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9059 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9060 above.
9061 @end table
9062
9063 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9064 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9065 predefined meaning.
9066
9067 @menu
9068 * C Constants::
9069 @end menu
9070
9071 @node C Constants
9072 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
9073
9074 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9075
9076 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9077 following ways:
9078
9079 @itemize @bullet
9080 @item
9081 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9082 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9083 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9084 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9085 @code{long} value.
9086
9087 @item
9088 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9089 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9090 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9091 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9092 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9093 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9094 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9095 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9096 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9097 constant.
9098
9099 @item
9100 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9101 integral equivalents.
9102
9103 @item
9104 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9105 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9106 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9107 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9108 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9109 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9110 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9111 @samp{\n} for newline.
9112
9113 @item
9114 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9115 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9116 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9117 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9118 characters.
9119
9120 @item
9121 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9122 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9123
9124 @item
9125 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9126 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9127 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9128 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9129 @end itemize
9130
9131 @menu
9132 * C plus plus expressions::
9133 * C Defaults::
9134 * C Checks::
9135
9136 * Debugging C::
9137 @end menu
9138
9139 @node C plus plus expressions
9140 @subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
9141
9142 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9143 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9144
9145 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9146 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9147 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9148 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9149 @quotation
9150 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9151 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9152 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9153 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9154 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9155 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9156 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9157 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9158 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9159 C@t{++} code.
9160 @end quotation
9161
9162 @enumerate
9163
9164 @cindex member functions
9165 @item
9166 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9167
9168 @smallexample
9169 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9170 @end smallexample
9171
9172 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9173 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9174 @item
9175 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9176 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9177 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9178 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9179
9180 @cindex call overloaded functions
9181 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9182 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9183 @item
9184 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9185 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9186 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9187 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9188 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9189 default arguments.
9190
9191 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9192 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9193 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9194 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9195 number of function arguments.
9196
9197 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9198 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
9199 ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
9200
9201 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9202 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9203 @smallexample
9204 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9205 @end smallexample
9206
9207 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9208 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
9209
9210 @cindex reference declarations
9211 @item
9212 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9213 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9214 dereferenced.
9215
9216 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9217 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9218 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9219 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9220 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9221
9222 @item
9223 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9224 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9225 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9226 necessary, for example in an expression like
9227 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9228 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9229 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
9230 @end enumerate
9231
9232 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9233 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9234 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9235 invoking user-defined operators.
9236
9237 @node C Defaults
9238 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
9239
9240 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9241
9242 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9243 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9244 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9245 selects the working language.
9246
9247 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9248 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9249 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9250 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9251 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
9252 for further details.
9253
9254 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9255 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9256 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9257
9258 @node C Checks
9259 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9260
9261 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9262
9263 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9264 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9265 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9266
9267 @itemize @bullet
9268 @item
9269 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9270 enumerated tag.
9271
9272 @item
9273 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9274 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9275
9276 @ignore
9277 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9278 @c FIXME--beers?
9279 @item
9280 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9281 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9282 compilers.)
9283 @end ignore
9284 @end itemize
9285
9286 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9287 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9288 that is not itself an array.
9289
9290 @node Debugging C
9291 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9292
9293 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9294 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9295 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9296 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9297
9298 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9299 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9300 ,Expressions}.
9301
9302 @menu
9303 * Debugging C plus plus::
9304 @end menu
9305
9306 @node Debugging C plus plus
9307 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9308
9309 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9310
9311 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9312 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9313
9314 @table @code
9315 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9316 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9317 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9318 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
9319 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
9320
9321 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9322 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9323 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9324 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9325 classes.
9326 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
9327
9328 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9329 @item catch throw
9330 @itemx catch catch
9331 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9332 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
9333
9334 @cindex inheritance
9335 @item ptype @var{typename}
9336 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9337 @var{typename}.
9338 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9339
9340 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9341 @item set print demangle
9342 @itemx show print demangle
9343 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9344 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9345 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9346 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9347 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9348
9349 @item set print object
9350 @itemx show print object
9351 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9352 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9353
9354 @item set print vtbl
9355 @itemx show print vtbl
9356 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9357 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9358 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9359 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9360
9361 @kindex set overload-resolution
9362 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9363 @item set overload-resolution on
9364 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9365 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9366 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9367 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
9368 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
9369 message.
9370
9371 @item set overload-resolution off
9372 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9373 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9374 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9375 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9376 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9377 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9378 argument types.
9379
9380 @kindex show overload-resolution
9381 @item show overload-resolution
9382 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9383
9384 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9385 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9386 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9387 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9388 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9389 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9390 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
9391 @end table
9392
9393 @node Objective-C
9394 @subsection Objective-C
9395
9396 @cindex Objective-C
9397 This section provides information about some commands and command
9398 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9399 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9400 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9401
9402 @menu
9403 * Method Names in Commands::
9404 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9405 @end menu
9406
9407 @node Method Names in Commands, The Print Command with Objective-C, Objective-C, Objective-C
9408 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9409
9410 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9411 names as line specifications:
9412
9413 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9414 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9415 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9416 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9417 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9418 @itemize
9419 @item @code{clear}
9420 @item @code{break}
9421 @item @code{info line}
9422 @item @code{jump}
9423 @item @code{list}
9424 @end itemize
9425
9426 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9427
9428 @smallexample
9429 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9430 @end smallexample
9431
9432 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9433 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9434 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9435 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9436 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9437 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9438 debugged, enter:
9439
9440 @smallexample
9441 break -[Fruit create]
9442 @end smallexample
9443
9444 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9445 enter:
9446
9447 @smallexample
9448 list +[NSText initialize]
9449 @end smallexample
9450
9451 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9452 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9453 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9454 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9455
9456 @smallexample
9457 break create
9458 @end smallexample
9459
9460 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9461 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9462 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9463 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9464 none apply.
9465
9466 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9467 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9468
9469 @smallexample
9470 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9471 @end smallexample
9472
9473 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9474 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9475 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9476 @kindex print-object
9477 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9478
9479 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9480
9481 @smallexample
9482 print -[@var{object} hash]
9483 @end smallexample
9484
9485 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9486 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9487 @noindent
9488 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9489 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9490 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9491 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9492 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9493 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9494
9495 @node Fortran
9496 @subsection Fortran
9497 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9498
9499 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9500 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9501
9502 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9503 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9504 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9505 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9506 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9507 underscore.
9508
9509 @menu
9510 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9511 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9512 * Special Fortran commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9513 @end menu
9514
9515 @node Fortran Operators
9516 @subsubsection Fortran operators and expressions
9517
9518 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9519
9520 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9521 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9522 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9523
9524 @table @code
9525 @item **
9526 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9527 of the second one.
9528
9529 @item :
9530 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9531 represent a section of array.
9532 @end table
9533
9534 @node Fortran Defaults
9535 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9536
9537 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9538
9539 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9540 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9541 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9542 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9543
9544 @node Special Fortran commands
9545 @subsubsection Special Fortran commands
9546
9547 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9548
9549 @value{GDBN} had some commands to support Fortran specific feature,
9550 such as common block displaying.
9551
9552 @table @code
9553 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9554 @kindex info common
9555 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9556 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9557 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9558 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at current program location are
9559 printed.
9560 @end table
9561
9562 @node Pascal
9563 @subsection Pascal
9564
9565 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9566 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9567 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9568 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9569 syntax.
9570
9571 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9572 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9573 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9574
9575 @node Modula-2
9576 @subsection Modula-2
9577
9578 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9579
9580 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9581 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9582 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9583 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9584 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9585 table.
9586
9587 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9588 @menu
9589 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9590 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9591 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9592 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9593 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9594 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9595 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9596 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9597 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9598 @end menu
9599
9600 @node M2 Operators
9601 @subsubsection Operators
9602 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9603
9604 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9605 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9606 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9607 following definitions hold:
9608
9609 @itemize @bullet
9610
9611 @item
9612 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9613 their subranges.
9614
9615 @item
9616 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9617
9618 @item
9619 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9620
9621 @item
9622 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9623 @var{type}}.
9624
9625 @item
9626 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9627
9628 @item
9629 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9630
9631 @item
9632 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9633 @end itemize
9634
9635 @noindent
9636 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9637 increasing precedence:
9638
9639 @table @code
9640 @item ,
9641 Function argument or array index separator.
9642
9643 @item :=
9644 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9645 @var{value}.
9646
9647 @item <@r{, }>
9648 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9649 types.
9650
9651 @item <=@r{, }>=
9652 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9653 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9654 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9655
9656 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9657 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9658 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9659 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9660 comment character.
9661
9662 @item IN
9663 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9664 Same precedence as @code{<}.
9665
9666 @item OR
9667 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9668
9669 @item AND@r{, }&
9670 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9671
9672 @item @@
9673 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9674
9675 @item +@r{, }-
9676 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9677 and difference on set types.
9678
9679 @item *
9680 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9681 on set types.
9682
9683 @item /
9684 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9685 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9686
9687 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
9688 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9689 precedence as @code{*}.
9690
9691 @item -
9692 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9693
9694 @item ^
9695 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9696
9697 @item NOT
9698 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9699 @code{^}.
9700
9701 @item .
9702 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
9703 precedence as @code{^}.
9704
9705 @item []
9706 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
9707
9708 @item ()
9709 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
9710 as @code{^}.
9711
9712 @item ::@r{, }.
9713 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
9714 @end table
9715
9716 @quotation
9717 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
9718 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
9719 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
9720 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
9721 @end quotation
9722
9723
9724 @node Built-In Func/Proc
9725 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
9726 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
9727
9728 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
9729 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
9730
9731 @table @var
9732
9733 @item a
9734 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
9735
9736 @item c
9737 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
9738
9739 @item i
9740 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
9741
9742 @item m
9743 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
9744 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
9745 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
9746
9747 @item n
9748 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
9749
9750 @item r
9751 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
9752
9753 @item t
9754 represents a type.
9755
9756 @item v
9757 represents a variable.
9758
9759 @item x
9760 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
9761 explanation of the function for details.
9762 @end table
9763
9764 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
9765
9766 @table @code
9767 @item ABS(@var{n})
9768 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
9769
9770 @item CAP(@var{c})
9771 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
9772 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
9773
9774 @item CHR(@var{i})
9775 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9776
9777 @item DEC(@var{v})
9778 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9779
9780 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
9781 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9782 new value.
9783
9784 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9785 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
9786 set.
9787
9788 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
9789 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
9790
9791 @item HIGH(@var{a})
9792 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
9793
9794 @item INC(@var{v})
9795 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9796
9797 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
9798 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9799 new value.
9800
9801 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9802 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
9803 there. Returns the new set.
9804
9805 @item MAX(@var{t})
9806 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
9807
9808 @item MIN(@var{t})
9809 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
9810
9811 @item ODD(@var{i})
9812 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
9813
9814 @item ORD(@var{x})
9815 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
9816 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
9817 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
9818 integral, character and enumerated types.
9819
9820 @item SIZE(@var{x})
9821 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
9822
9823 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
9824 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
9825
9826 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
9827 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9828 @end table
9829
9830 @quotation
9831 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
9832 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
9833 an error.
9834 @end quotation
9835
9836 @cindex Modula-2 constants
9837 @node M2 Constants
9838 @subsubsection Constants
9839
9840 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
9841 ways:
9842
9843 @itemize @bullet
9844
9845 @item
9846 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
9847 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
9848 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
9849 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
9850
9851 @item
9852 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
9853 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
9854 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
9855 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
9856 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
9857 digits.
9858
9859 @item
9860 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
9861 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
9862 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
9863 followed by a @samp{C}.
9864
9865 @item
9866 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
9867 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
9868 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
9869 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
9870 sequences.
9871
9872 @item
9873 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
9874
9875 @item
9876 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
9877 @code{FALSE}.
9878
9879 @item
9880 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
9881
9882 @item
9883 Set constants are not yet supported.
9884 @end itemize
9885
9886 @node M2 Types
9887 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
9888 @cindex Modula-2 types
9889
9890 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
9891 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
9892 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
9893 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
9894 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
9895 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
9896
9897 The first example contains the following section of code:
9898
9899 @smallexample
9900 VAR
9901 s: SET OF CHAR ;
9902 r: [20..40] ;
9903 @end smallexample
9904
9905 @noindent
9906 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
9907 @code{r} and @code{s}.
9908
9909 @smallexample
9910 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9911 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
9912 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9913 SET OF CHAR
9914 (@value{GDBP}) print r
9915 21
9916 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
9917 [20..40]
9918 @end smallexample
9919
9920 @noindent
9921 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
9922
9923 @smallexample
9924 VAR
9925 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
9926 @end smallexample
9927
9928 @noindent
9929 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
9930
9931 @smallexample
9932 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9933 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
9934 @end smallexample
9935
9936 @noindent
9937 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
9938 expressions using the debugger.
9939
9940 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
9941 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
9942
9943 @smallexample
9944 VAR
9945 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
9946 @end smallexample
9947
9948 @smallexample
9949 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9950 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
9951 @end smallexample
9952
9953 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
9954 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
9955 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
9956 above. Unbounded arrays are also not yet recognized in @value{GDBN}.
9957
9958 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
9959
9960 @smallexample
9961 TYPE
9962 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
9963 t = [blue..yellow] ;
9964 VAR
9965 s: t ;
9966 BEGIN
9967 s := blue ;
9968 @end smallexample
9969
9970 @noindent
9971 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
9972 and value of a variable.
9973
9974 @smallexample
9975 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9976 $1 = blue
9977 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
9978 type = [blue..yellow]
9979 @end smallexample
9980
9981 @noindent
9982 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
9983 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
9984 their @code{C} counterparts.
9985
9986 @smallexample
9987 VAR
9988 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
9989 BEGIN
9990 s[1] := 1 ;
9991 @end smallexample
9992
9993 @smallexample
9994 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9995 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
9996 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9997 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
9998 @end smallexample
9999
10000 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10001 pointer types as shown in this example:
10002
10003 @smallexample
10004 VAR
10005 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10006 BEGIN
10007 NEW(s) ;
10008 s^[1] := 1 ;
10009 @end smallexample
10010
10011 @noindent
10012 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10013
10014 @smallexample
10015 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10016 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10017 @end smallexample
10018
10019 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10020 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10021 types:
10022
10023 @smallexample
10024 TYPE
10025 foo = RECORD
10026 f1: CARDINAL ;
10027 f2: CHAR ;
10028 f3: myarray ;
10029 END ;
10030
10031 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10032 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10033 VAR
10034 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10035 @end smallexample
10036
10037 @noindent
10038 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10039 below.
10040
10041 @smallexample
10042 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10043 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10044 f1 : CARDINAL;
10045 f2 : CHAR;
10046 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10047 END
10048 @end smallexample
10049
10050 @node M2 Defaults
10051 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
10052 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10053
10054 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10055 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10056 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10057 selected the working language.
10058
10059 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10060 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10061 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
10062 the language automatically}, for further details.
10063
10064 @node Deviations
10065 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
10066 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10067
10068 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10069 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10070
10071 @itemize @bullet
10072 @item
10073 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10074 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10075 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10076 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10077 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10078 returned a pointer.)
10079
10080 @item
10081 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10082 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10083 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10084 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10085
10086 @item
10087 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10088 argument.
10089
10090 @item
10091 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10092 @end itemize
10093
10094 @node M2 Checks
10095 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
10096 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10097
10098 @quotation
10099 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10100 range checking.
10101 @end quotation
10102 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10103
10104 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10105
10106 @itemize @bullet
10107 @item
10108 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10109 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10110
10111 @item
10112 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10113 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10114 @end itemize
10115
10116 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10117 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10118
10119 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10120 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10121
10122 @node M2 Scope
10123 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10124 @cindex scope
10125 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10126 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10127 @ifinfo
10128 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10129 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10130 @end ifinfo
10131 @iftex
10132 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10133 @end iftex
10134
10135 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10136 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10137 similar syntax:
10138
10139 @smallexample
10140
10141 @var{module} . @var{id}
10142 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10143 @end smallexample
10144
10145 @noindent
10146 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10147 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10148 identifier within your program, except another module.
10149
10150 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10151 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10152 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10153 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10154
10155 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10156 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10157 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10158 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10159 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10160 @var{module}.
10161
10162 @node GDB/M2
10163 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10164
10165 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10166 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10167 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10168 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10169 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10170 analogue in Modula-2.
10171
10172 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10173 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10174 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10175 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10176 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10177 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10178
10179 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10180 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10181 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10182
10183 @node Ada
10184 @subsection Ada
10185 @cindex Ada
10186
10187 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10188 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10189 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10190 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10191 to be difficult.
10192
10193
10194 @cindex expressions in Ada
10195 @menu
10196 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10197 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10198 in @value{GDBN}.
10199 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10200 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10201 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10202 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10203 @end menu
10204
10205 @node Ada Mode Intro
10206 @subsubsection Introduction
10207 @cindex Ada mode, general
10208
10209 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10210 syntax, with some extensions.
10211 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10212
10213 @itemize @bullet
10214 @item
10215 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10216 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10217 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10218 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10219
10220 @item
10221 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10222 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10223
10224 @item
10225 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10226 @end itemize
10227
10228 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10229 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10230 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10231 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10232 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10233
10234 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10235 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10236 was translated from an Ada source file.
10237
10238 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10239 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10240 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10241 middle (to allow based literals).
10242
10243 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10244 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10245 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10246 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10247 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10248 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10249
10250 @node Omissions from Ada
10251 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10252 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10253
10254 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10255
10256 @itemize @bullet
10257 @item
10258 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10259
10260 @itemize @minus
10261 @item
10262 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10263 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10264
10265 @item
10266 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10267
10268 @item
10269 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10270
10271 @item
10272 @t{'Tag}.
10273
10274 @item
10275 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10276 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10277
10278 @item
10279 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10280 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10281
10282 @item
10283 @t{'Address}.
10284 @end itemize
10285
10286 @item
10287 The names in
10288 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10289 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10290 not currently available.
10291
10292 @item
10293 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10294 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10295 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10296 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10297 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10298 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10299 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10300 indeterminate values.
10301
10302 @item
10303 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10304 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10305 are not implemented.
10306
10307 @item
10308 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10309 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10310 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10311 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10312 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10313
10314 @smallexample
10315 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10316 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10317 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10318 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10319 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10320 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10321 @end smallexample
10322
10323 Changing a
10324 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10325 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10326 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10327 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10328 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10329 declared to have a type such as:
10330
10331 @smallexample
10332 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10333 Id : Integer;
10334 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10335 end record;
10336 @end smallexample
10337
10338 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10339 assignments:
10340
10341 @smallexample
10342 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10343 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10344 @end smallexample
10345
10346 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10347 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10348 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10349 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10350 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10351 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10352 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10353 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10354
10355 @item
10356 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10357
10358 @item
10359 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10360 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in which a subexpression
10361 appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much looser in its rules for allowing
10362 type matches. As a result, some function calls will be ambiguous, and the user
10363 will be asked to choose the proper resolution.
10364
10365 @item
10366 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10367
10368 @item
10369 Entry calls are not implemented.
10370
10371 @item
10372 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10373 formats are not supported.
10374
10375 @item
10376 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10377 @end itemize
10378
10379 @node Additions to Ada
10380 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10381 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10382
10383 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10384 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10385
10386 @itemize @bullet
10387 @item
10388 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory
10389 (typically a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is
10390 a positive integer, then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of
10391 @var{E} and the @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array.
10392 In Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use
10393 is in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in Ada.
10394 However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs
10395 in which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10396
10397 @item
10398 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that appears
10399 in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name, you must typically
10400 surround it in single quotes.
10401
10402 @item
10403 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10404 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10405
10406 @item
10407 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10408 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10409 @end itemize
10410
10411 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright additions specific
10412 to Ada:
10413
10414 @itemize @bullet
10415 @item
10416 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10417 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10418
10419 @smallexample
10420 set x := y + 3
10421 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10422 @end smallexample
10423
10424 @item
10425 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10426 the value of its right-hand operand.
10427 This allows, for example,
10428 complex conditional breaks:
10429
10430 @smallexample
10431 break f
10432 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10433 @end smallexample
10434
10435 @item
10436 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10437 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10438 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10439 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10440 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10441 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10442 in strings. For example,
10443 @smallexample
10444 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10445 @end smallexample
10446 @noindent
10447 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF}) after each
10448 period.
10449
10450 @item
10451 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10452 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10453 to write
10454
10455 @smallexample
10456 print 'max(x, y)
10457 @end smallexample
10458
10459 @item
10460 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10461 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10462 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound of 3 might print as
10463
10464 @smallexample
10465 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
10466 @end smallexample
10467
10468 @noindent
10469 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10470 clause.
10471
10472 @item
10473 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10474 multi-character subsequence of
10475 their names (an exact match gets preference).
10476 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10477 in place of @t{a'length}.
10478
10479 @item
10480 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10481 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10482 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10483 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10484 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10485 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10486 For example,
10487 @smallexample
10488 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10489 @end smallexample
10490
10491 @item
10492 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10493 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10494 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10495 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10496 object.
10497
10498 @end itemize
10499
10500 @node Stopping Before Main Program
10501 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10502
10503 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10504 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10505 before reaching the main procedure.
10506 As defined in the Ada Reference
10507 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10508 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10509 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10510 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10511
10512 @node Ada Glitches
10513 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10514 @cindex Ada, problems
10515
10516 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10517 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10518 @value{GDBN},
10519 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10520 and the GNU Ada compiler.
10521
10522 @itemize @bullet
10523 @item
10524 Currently, the debugger
10525 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10526 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10527 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10528 to get it printed properly.
10529
10530 @item
10531 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10532 storage are invisible to the debugger.
10533
10534 @item
10535 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10536 argument lists are treated as positional).
10537
10538 @item
10539 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10540
10541 @item
10542 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10543 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10544 the host machine.
10545
10546 @item
10547 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10548
10549 @item
10550 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10551 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10552 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10553 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10554 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10555 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10556 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10557 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10558 you can usually resolve the confusion
10559 by qualifying the problematic names with package
10560 @code{Standard} explicitly.
10561 @end itemize
10562
10563 @node Unsupported languages
10564 @section Unsupported languages
10565
10566 @cindex unsupported languages
10567 @cindex minimal language
10568 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10569 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10570 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10571 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10572 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10573 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10574
10575 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10576 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10577 language.
10578
10579 @node Symbols
10580 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10581
10582 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10583 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10584 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10585 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10586 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10587 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
10588 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10589
10590 @cindex symbol names
10591 @cindex names of symbols
10592 @cindex quoting names
10593 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10594 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10595 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10596 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
10597 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10598 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10599 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10600 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10601
10602 @smallexample
10603 p 'foo.c'::x
10604 @end smallexample
10605
10606 @noindent
10607 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10608
10609 @table @code
10610 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10611 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10612 @kindex set case-sensitive
10613 @item set case-sensitive on
10614 @itemx set case-sensitive off
10615 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
10616 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10617 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10618 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10619 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10620 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10621 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10622 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10623 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10624 case-insensitive matches.
10625
10626 @kindex show case-sensitive
10627 @item show case-sensitive
10628 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10629 lookups.
10630
10631 @kindex info address
10632 @cindex address of a symbol
10633 @item info address @var{symbol}
10634 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10635 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10636 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10637 is always stored.
10638
10639 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10640 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10641 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10642
10643 @kindex info symbol
10644 @cindex symbol from address
10645 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10646 @item info symbol @var{addr}
10647 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10648 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10649 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10650
10651 @smallexample
10652 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10653 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10654 @end smallexample
10655
10656 @noindent
10657 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10658 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10659
10660 @kindex whatis
10661 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
10662 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
10663 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
10664 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
10665 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10666 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
10667 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
10668 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
10669 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
10670 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10671 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10672
10673 @kindex ptype
10674 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
10675 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
10676 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
10677 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10678
10679 For example, for this variable declaration:
10680
10681 @smallexample
10682 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10683 @end smallexample
10684
10685 @noindent
10686 the two commands give this output:
10687
10688 @smallexample
10689 @group
10690 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10691 type = struct complex
10692 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10693 type = struct complex @{
10694 double real;
10695 double imag;
10696 @}
10697 @end group
10698 @end smallexample
10699
10700 @noindent
10701 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
10702 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10703
10704 @cindex incomplete type
10705 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
10706 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
10707 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
10708 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
10709 given these declarations:
10710
10711 @smallexample
10712 struct foo;
10713 struct foo *fooptr;
10714 @end smallexample
10715
10716 @noindent
10717 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
10718
10719 @smallexample
10720 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
10721 $1 = <incomplete type>
10722 @end smallexample
10723
10724 @noindent
10725 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
10726 completely specified.
10727
10728 @kindex info types
10729 @item info types @var{regexp}
10730 @itemx info types
10731 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
10732 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
10733 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
10734 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
10735 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
10736 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
10737 name is @code{value}.
10738
10739 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
10740 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
10741 lists all source files where a type is defined.
10742
10743 @kindex info scope
10744 @cindex local variables
10745 @item info scope @var{location}
10746 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
10747 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
10748 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
10749 to the scope defined by that location. For example:
10750
10751 @smallexample
10752 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
10753 Scope for command_line_handler:
10754 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
10755 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
10756 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
10757 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
10758 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
10759 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
10760 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
10761 @end smallexample
10762
10763 @noindent
10764 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
10765 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
10766 collect}.
10767
10768 @kindex info source
10769 @item info source
10770 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
10771 the function containing the current point of execution:
10772 @itemize @bullet
10773 @item
10774 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
10775 @item
10776 the directory it was compiled in,
10777 @item
10778 its length, in lines,
10779 @item
10780 which programming language it is written in,
10781 @item
10782 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
10783 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
10784 @item
10785 whether the debugging information includes information about
10786 preprocessor macros.
10787 @end itemize
10788
10789
10790 @kindex info sources
10791 @item info sources
10792 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
10793 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
10794 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
10795
10796 @kindex info functions
10797 @item info functions
10798 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
10799
10800 @item info functions @var{regexp}
10801 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
10802 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
10803 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
10804 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
10805 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
10806 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
10807 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
10808
10809 @kindex info variables
10810 @item info variables
10811 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
10812 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
10813
10814 @item info variables @var{regexp}
10815 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
10816 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
10817 @var{regexp}.
10818
10819 @kindex info classes
10820 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
10821 @item info classes
10822 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
10823 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
10824 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10825 expression.
10826
10827 @kindex info selectors
10828 @item info selectors
10829 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
10830 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
10831 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10832 expression.
10833
10834 @ignore
10835 This was never implemented.
10836 @kindex info methods
10837 @item info methods
10838 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
10839 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
10840 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
10841 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
10842 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
10843 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
10844 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
10845 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
10846 @end ignore
10847
10848 @cindex reloading symbols
10849 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
10850 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
10851 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
10852 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
10853 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
10854
10855 @table @code
10856 @kindex set symbol-reloading
10857 @item set symbol-reloading on
10858 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
10859 object file with a particular name is seen again.
10860
10861 @item set symbol-reloading off
10862 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
10863 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
10864 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
10865 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
10866 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
10867 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
10868 name.
10869
10870 @kindex show symbol-reloading
10871 @item show symbol-reloading
10872 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
10873 @end table
10874
10875 @cindex opaque data types
10876 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
10877 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
10878 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
10879 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
10880 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
10881 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
10882 another source file. The default is on.
10883
10884 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
10885 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
10886
10887 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
10888 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
10889 is printed as follows:
10890 @smallexample
10891 @{<no data fields>@}
10892 @end smallexample
10893
10894 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
10895 @item show opaque-type-resolution
10896 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
10897
10898 @kindex maint print symbols
10899 @cindex symbol dump
10900 @kindex maint print psymbols
10901 @cindex partial symbol dump
10902 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
10903 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
10904 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
10905 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
10906 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
10907 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
10908 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
10909 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
10910 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
10911 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
10912 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
10913 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
10914 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
10915 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
10916 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
10917 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
10918 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
10919
10920 @kindex maint info symtabs
10921 @kindex maint info psymtabs
10922 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
10923 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10924 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10925 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10926 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
10927 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
10928
10929 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
10930 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
10931 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
10932 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
10933 structure in more detail. For example:
10934
10935 @smallexample
10936 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
10937 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
10938 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
10939 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
10940 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
10941 readin no
10942 fullname (null)
10943 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
10944 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
10945 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
10946 dependencies (none)
10947 @}
10948 @}
10949 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
10950 (@value{GDBP})
10951 @end smallexample
10952 @noindent
10953 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
10954 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
10955 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
10956 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
10957 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
10958
10959 @smallexample
10960 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
10961 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
10962 line 1574.
10963 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
10964 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
10965 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
10966 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
10967 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
10968 dirname (null)
10969 fullname (null)
10970 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
10971 debugformat DWARF 2
10972 @}
10973 @}
10974 (@value{GDBP})
10975 @end smallexample
10976 @end table
10977
10978
10979 @node Altering
10980 @chapter Altering Execution
10981
10982 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
10983 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
10984 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
10985 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
10986 program.
10987
10988 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
10989 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
10990 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
10991
10992 @menu
10993 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
10994 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
10995 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
10996 * Returning:: Returning from a function
10997 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
10998 * Patching:: Patching your program
10999 @end menu
11000
11001 @node Assignment
11002 @section Assignment to variables
11003
11004 @cindex assignment
11005 @cindex setting variables
11006 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11007 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11008
11009 @smallexample
11010 print x=4
11011 @end smallexample
11012
11013 @noindent
11014 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11015 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11016 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11017 information on operators in supported languages.
11018
11019 @kindex set variable
11020 @cindex variables, setting
11021 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11022 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11023 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11024 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11025 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11026
11027 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11028 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11029 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11030 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11031 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11032 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11033 command @code{set width}:
11034
11035 @smallexample
11036 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11037 type = double
11038 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11039 $4 = 13
11040 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11041 Invalid syntax in expression.
11042 @end smallexample
11043
11044 @noindent
11045 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11046 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11047
11048 @smallexample
11049 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11050 @end smallexample
11051
11052 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11053 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11054 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11055 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11056 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11057 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11058
11059 @smallexample
11060 @group
11061 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11062 type = double
11063 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11064 $1 = 1
11065 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11066 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11067 $2 = 1
11068 (@value{GDBP}) r
11069 The program being debugged has been started already.
11070 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11071 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11072 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11073 Invalid bfd target.
11074 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11075 The current BFD target is "=4".
11076 @end group
11077 @end smallexample
11078
11079 @noindent
11080 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11081 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11082 @code{g}, use
11083
11084 @smallexample
11085 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11086 @end smallexample
11087
11088 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11089 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11090 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11091 same length or shorter.
11092 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11093 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11094
11095 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11096 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11097 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11098 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11099 and representation in memory), and
11100
11101 @smallexample
11102 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11103 @end smallexample
11104
11105 @noindent
11106 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11107
11108 @node Jumping
11109 @section Continuing at a different address
11110
11111 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11112 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11113 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11114
11115 @table @code
11116 @kindex jump
11117 @item jump @var{linespec}
11118 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
11119 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
11120 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
11121 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
11122 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
11123 breakpoints}.
11124
11125 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11126 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11127 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11128 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11129 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11130 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11131 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11132 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11133 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11134
11135 @item jump *@var{address}
11136 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
11137 @end table
11138
11139 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11140 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11141 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11142 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11143 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11144 example,
11145
11146 @smallexample
11147 set $pc = 0x485
11148 @end smallexample
11149
11150 @noindent
11151 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11152 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11153 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
11154
11155 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11156 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11157 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11158 detail.
11159
11160 @c @group
11161 @node Signaling
11162 @section Giving your program a signal
11163 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11164
11165 @table @code
11166 @kindex signal
11167 @item signal @var{signal}
11168 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11169 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11170 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11171 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11172
11173 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11174 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11175 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11176 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11177 signal.
11178
11179 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11180 after executing the command.
11181 @end table
11182 @c @end group
11183
11184 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11185 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11186 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11187 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11188 passes the signal directly to your program.
11189
11190
11191 @node Returning
11192 @section Returning from a function
11193
11194 @table @code
11195 @cindex returning from a function
11196 @kindex return
11197 @item return
11198 @itemx return @var{expression}
11199 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11200 command. If you give an
11201 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11202 value.
11203 @end table
11204
11205 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11206 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11207 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11208 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11209
11210 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11211 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11212 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11213 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11214 of functions.
11215
11216 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11217 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11218 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11219 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
11220 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11221
11222 @node Calling
11223 @section Calling program functions
11224
11225 @table @code
11226 @cindex calling functions
11227 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11228 @item print @var{expr}
11229 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resuling value.
11230 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11231 debugged.
11232
11233 @kindex call
11234 @item call @var{expr}
11235 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11236 returned values.
11237
11238 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11239 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11240 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11241 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11242 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11243 value history.
11244 @end table
11245
11246 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11247 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11248 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11249 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11250
11251 @table @code
11252 @item set unwindonsignal
11253 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11254 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11255 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11256 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11257 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11258 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11259 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11260 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11261 received.
11262
11263 @item show unwindonsignal
11264 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11265 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11266 @value{GDBN}.
11267 @end table
11268
11269 @cindex weak alias functions
11270 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11271 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11272 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11273 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11274 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11275 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11276 function instead.
11277
11278 @node Patching
11279 @section Patching programs
11280
11281 @cindex patching binaries
11282 @cindex writing into executables
11283 @cindex writing into corefiles
11284
11285 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11286 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11287 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11288 patching your program's binary.
11289
11290 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11291 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11292 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11293 repairs.
11294
11295 @table @code
11296 @kindex set write
11297 @item set write on
11298 @itemx set write off
11299 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11300 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11301 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11302
11303 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11304 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11305 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11306
11307 @item show write
11308 @kindex show write
11309 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11310 as well as reading.
11311 @end table
11312
11313 @node GDB Files
11314 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11315
11316 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11317 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11318 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11319 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11320
11321 @menu
11322 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11323 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11324 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11325 @end menu
11326
11327 @node Files
11328 @section Commands to specify files
11329
11330 @cindex symbol table
11331 @cindex core dump file
11332
11333 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11334 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11335 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11336 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11337
11338 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11339 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11340 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11341 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file}). In these situations the
11342 @value{GDBN} commands to specify new files are useful.
11343
11344 @table @code
11345 @cindex executable file
11346 @kindex file
11347 @item file @var{filename}
11348 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11349 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11350 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11351 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11352 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11353 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11354 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11355 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11356
11357 @cindex unlinked object files
11358 @cindex patching object files
11359 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11360 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11361 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11362 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11363 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11364 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11365 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11366 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11367
11368 @item file
11369 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11370 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11371
11372 @kindex exec-file
11373 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11374 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11375 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11376 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11377 discard information on the executable file.
11378
11379 @kindex symbol-file
11380 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11381 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11382 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11383 table and program to run from the same file.
11384
11385 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11386 program's symbol table.
11387
11388 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11389 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11390 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11391 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11392 @value{GDBN}.
11393
11394 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11395 executing it once.
11396
11397 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11398 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11399 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11400 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11401 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11402 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11403 optimized code.
11404
11405 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11406 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11407 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11408 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11409 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11410
11411 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11412 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11413 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11414 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11415 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11416 warnings and messages}.)
11417
11418 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11419 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11420 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11421 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11422 in stabs format.
11423
11424 @kindex readnow
11425 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11426 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11427 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11428 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11429 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11430 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11431 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11432 entire symbol table available.
11433
11434 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11435 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11436 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11437 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11438 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11439 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11440 @c files.
11441
11442 @kindex core-file
11443 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11444 @itemx core
11445 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11446 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11447 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11448 executable file itself for other parts.
11449
11450 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11451 to be used.
11452
11453 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11454 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11455 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11456 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11457 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
11458
11459 @kindex add-symbol-file
11460 @cindex dynamic linking
11461 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11462 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11463 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11464 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11465 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11466 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11467 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11468 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11469 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11470 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11471 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11472 @var{address} as an expression.
11473
11474 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11475 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11476 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11477 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11478 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11479
11480 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11481 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11482 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11483 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11484 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11485 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11486 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11487 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11488 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11489
11490 @itemize @bullet
11491 @item
11492 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11493 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11494 @item
11495 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11496 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11497 @item
11498 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11499 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11500 @end itemize
11501
11502 @noindent
11503 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11504 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11505 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11506 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11507 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11508 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11509 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11510 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11511 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11512 way.
11513
11514 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11515
11516 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11517 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11518 @cindex load symbols from memory
11519 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11520 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11521 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11522 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11523 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11524 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11525 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11526 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11527 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11528
11529 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11530 @kindex assf
11531 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11532 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
11533 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11534 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11535 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11536 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11537 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11538 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11539 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11540 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11541
11542 @kindex section
11543 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11544 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11545 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11546 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11547 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11548 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11549 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11550 their addresses.
11551
11552 @kindex info files
11553 @kindex info target
11554 @item info files
11555 @itemx info target
11556 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11557 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11558 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11559 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11560 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11561 current ones.
11562
11563 @kindex maint info sections
11564 @item maint info sections
11565 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11566 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11567 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11568 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11569 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11570 may be arbitrarily combined):
11571
11572 @table @code
11573 @item ALLOBJ
11574 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11575 @item @var{sections}
11576 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11577 @item @var{section-flags}
11578 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11579 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11580 @table @code
11581 @item ALLOC
11582 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11583 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11584 @item LOAD
11585 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11586 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11587 @item RELOC
11588 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11589 @item READONLY
11590 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11591 @item CODE
11592 Section contains executable code only.
11593 @item DATA
11594 Section contains data only (no executable code).
11595 @item ROM
11596 Section will reside in ROM.
11597 @item CONSTRUCTOR
11598 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11599 @item HAS_CONTENTS
11600 Section is not empty.
11601 @item NEVER_LOAD
11602 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11603 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11604 A notification to the linker that the section contains
11605 COFF shared library information.
11606 @item IS_COMMON
11607 Section contains common symbols.
11608 @end table
11609 @end table
11610 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11611 @cindex read-only sections
11612 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
11613 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11614 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11615 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11616 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11617 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11618 enhancement to debugging performance.
11619
11620 The default is off.
11621
11622 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
11623 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11624 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11625 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11626
11627 @item show trust-readonly-sections
11628 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11629 @end table
11630
11631 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11632 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11633 name and remembers it that way.
11634
11635 @cindex shared libraries
11636 @value{GDBN} supports GNU/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11637 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11638
11639 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11640 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11641 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11642 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11643 debugging a core file).
11644
11645 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11646 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11647
11648 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11649 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11650 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11651
11652 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11653 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11654 particularly large or there are many of them.
11655
11656 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11657 commands:
11658
11659 @table @code
11660 @kindex set auto-solib-add
11661 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11662 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11663 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11664 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11665 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11666 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11667 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11668
11669 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
11670 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11671 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11672 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11673 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11674 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11675 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11676 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expresion that matches
11677 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11678
11679 @kindex show auto-solib-add
11680 @item show auto-solib-add
11681 Display the current autoloading mode.
11682 @end table
11683
11684 @cindex load shared library
11685 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11686 command:
11687
11688 @table @code
11689 @kindex info sharedlibrary
11690 @kindex info share
11691 @item info share
11692 @itemx info sharedlibrary
11693 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
11694
11695 @kindex sharedlibrary
11696 @kindex share
11697 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
11698 @itemx share @var{regex}
11699 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
11700 Unix regular expression.
11701 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
11702 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
11703 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
11704 loaded.
11705
11706 @item nosharedlibrary
11707 @kindex nosharedlibrary
11708 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
11709 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
11710 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
11711 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
11712 discarded.
11713 @end table
11714
11715 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
11716 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
11717 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
11718
11719 @table @code
11720 @item set stop-on-solib-events
11721 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
11722 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
11723 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
11724 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
11725 shared library.
11726
11727 @item show stop-on-solib-events
11728 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
11729 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
11730 library events happen.
11731 @end table
11732
11733 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
11734 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
11735 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
11736 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
11737 not.
11738
11739 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
11740 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
11741 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
11742 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
11743 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
11744
11745 @table @code
11746 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
11747 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
11748 @item set solib-absolute-prefix @var{path}
11749 If this variable is set, @var{path} will be used as a prefix for any
11750 absolute shared library paths; many runtime loaders store the absolute
11751 paths to the shared library in the target program's memory. If you use
11752 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to find shared libraries, they need to be laid
11753 out in the same way that they are on the target, with e.g.@: a
11754 @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under @var{path}.
11755
11756 @cindex default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
11757 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
11758 You can set the default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} by using the
11759 configure-time @samp{--with-sysroot} option.
11760
11761 @kindex show solib-absolute-prefix
11762 @item show solib-absolute-prefix
11763 Display the current shared library prefix.
11764
11765 @kindex set solib-search-path
11766 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
11767 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of directories
11768 to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} is used after
11769 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} fails to locate the library, or if the path to
11770 the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to use
11771 @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}, be sure to
11772 set @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to a nonexistant directory to prevent
11773 @value{GDBN} from finding your host's libraries.
11774
11775 @kindex show solib-search-path
11776 @item show solib-search-path
11777 Display the current shared library search path.
11778 @end table
11779
11780
11781 @node Separate Debug Files
11782 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
11783 @cindex separate debugging information files
11784 @cindex debugging information in separate files
11785 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
11786 @cindex debugging information directory, global
11787 @cindex global debugging information directory
11788
11789 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
11790 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
11791 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
11792 Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
11793 than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
11794 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
11795 install only when they need to debug a problem.
11796
11797 If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
11798 separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
11799 the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
11800 components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
11801 debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
11802 containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
11803 debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
11804 will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
11805 places:
11806
11807 @itemize @bullet
11808 @item
11809 the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
11810 for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
11811 @item
11812 a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
11813 file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
11814 @item
11815 a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
11816 executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
11817 @file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
11818 @var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
11819 @var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
11820 @end itemize
11821 @noindent
11822 @value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
11823 information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
11824 reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
11825
11826 So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
11827 which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
11828 debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
11829 for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
11830 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
11831 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
11832
11833 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
11834 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
11835
11836 @table @code
11837
11838 @kindex set debug-file-directory
11839 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
11840 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11841 information files to @var{directory}.
11842
11843 @kindex show debug-file-directory
11844 @item show debug-file-directory
11845 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11846 information files.
11847
11848 @end table
11849
11850 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
11851 @cindex debug links
11852 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
11853 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
11854
11855 @itemize
11856 @item
11857 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
11858 a zero byte,
11859 @item
11860 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
11861 boundary within the section, and
11862 @item
11863 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
11864 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
11865 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
11866 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
11867 @end itemize
11868
11869 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
11870 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
11871 described above.
11872
11873 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
11874 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
11875 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
11876 should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
11877 but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
11878 in an ordinary executable.
11879
11880 As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
11881 separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
11882 Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
11883 contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
11884 @kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
11885 the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
11886 @file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
11887
11888 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
11889 polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
11890 describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
11891 complete code for a function that computes it:
11892
11893 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
11894 @smallexample
11895 unsigned long
11896 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
11897 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
11898 @{
11899 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
11900 @{
11901 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
11902 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
11903 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
11904 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
11905 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
11906 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
11907 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
11908 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
11909 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
11910 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
11911 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
11912 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
11913 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
11914 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
11915 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
11916 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
11917 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
11918 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
11919 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
11920 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
11921 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
11922 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
11923 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
11924 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
11925 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
11926 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
11927 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
11928 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
11929 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
11930 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
11931 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
11932 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
11933 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
11934 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
11935 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
11936 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
11937 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
11938 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
11939 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
11940 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
11941 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
11942 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
11943 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
11944 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
11945 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
11946 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
11947 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
11948 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
11949 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
11950 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
11951 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
11952 0x2d02ef8d
11953 @};
11954 unsigned char *end;
11955
11956 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
11957 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
11958 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
11959 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
11960 @}
11961 @end smallexample
11962
11963
11964 @node Symbol Errors
11965 @section Errors reading symbol files
11966
11967 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
11968 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
11969 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
11970 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
11971 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
11972 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
11973 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
11974 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
11975 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
11976 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
11977 messages}).
11978
11979 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
11980
11981 @table @code
11982 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
11983
11984 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
11985 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
11986 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
11987 in its outer scope blocks.
11988
11989 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
11990 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
11991 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
11992 function.
11993
11994 @item block at @var{address} out of order
11995
11996 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
11997 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
11998 do so.
11999
12000 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12001 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12002 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12003 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
12004 messages}.)
12005
12006 @item bad block start address patched
12007
12008 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12009 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12010 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12011
12012 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12013 starting on the previous source line.
12014
12015 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12016
12017 @cindex foo
12018 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12019 larger than the size of the string table.
12020
12021 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12022 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12023 with this name.
12024
12025 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12026
12027 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12028 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12029 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12030
12031 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12032 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12033 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12034 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12035 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12036 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12037
12038 @item stub type has NULL name
12039
12040 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12041
12042 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12043 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12044 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12045 it.
12046
12047 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12048
12049 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12050
12051 @end table
12052
12053 @node Targets
12054 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12055
12056 @cindex debugging target
12057 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12058
12059 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12060 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12061 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12062 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12063 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12064 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12065 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12066 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
12067
12068 @cindex target architecture
12069 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12070 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12071 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12072 command.
12073
12074 @table @code
12075 @kindex set architecture
12076 @kindex show architecture
12077 @item set architecture @var{arch}
12078 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12079 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12080 supported architectures.
12081
12082 @item show architecture
12083 Show the current target architecture.
12084
12085 @item set processor
12086 @itemx processor
12087 @kindex set processor
12088 @kindex show processor
12089 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12090 and @code{show architecture}.
12091 @end table
12092
12093 @menu
12094 * Active Targets:: Active targets
12095 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12096 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12097 * Remote:: Remote debugging
12098
12099 @end menu
12100
12101 @node Active Targets
12102 @section Active targets
12103
12104 @cindex stacking targets
12105 @cindex active targets
12106 @cindex multiple targets
12107
12108 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12109 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12110 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12111 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12112 a core file.
12113
12114 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12115 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12116 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12117 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12118 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12119 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12120 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12121 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12122 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12123
12124 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12125 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12126 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12127 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12128 process target is active.
12129
12130 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12131 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
12132 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12133 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
12134 process}).
12135
12136 @node Target Commands
12137 @section Commands for managing targets
12138
12139 @table @code
12140 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12141 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12142 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12143 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12144 protocol of the target machine.
12145
12146 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12147 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12148 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12149
12150 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12151 after executing the command.
12152
12153 @kindex help target
12154 @item help target
12155 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12156 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12157 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
12158
12159 @item help target @var{name}
12160 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12161 select it.
12162
12163 @kindex set gnutarget
12164 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12165 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12166 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12167 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12168 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12169 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12170
12171 @quotation
12172 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12173 you must know the actual BFD name.
12174 @end quotation
12175
12176 @noindent
12177 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
12178
12179 @kindex show gnutarget
12180 @item show gnutarget
12181 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12182 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12183 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12184 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12185 @end table
12186
12187 @cindex common targets
12188 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12189 configuration):
12190
12191 @table @code
12192 @kindex target
12193 @item target exec @var{program}
12194 @cindex executable file target
12195 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12196 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12197
12198 @item target core @var{filename}
12199 @cindex core dump file target
12200 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12201 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12202
12203 @item target remote @var{medium}
12204 @cindex remote target
12205 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12206 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12207 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12208
12209 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12210 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12211
12212 @smallexample
12213 target remote /dev/ttya
12214 @end smallexample
12215
12216 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12217 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12218 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12219 clobbered by the download.
12220
12221 @item target sim
12222 @cindex built-in simulator target
12223 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12224 In general,
12225 @smallexample
12226 target sim
12227 load
12228 run
12229 @end smallexample
12230 @noindent
12231 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12232 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12233 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12234 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12235 Processors}.
12236
12237 @end table
12238
12239 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12240
12241 @table @code
12242
12243 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12244 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12245 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12246
12247 @end table
12248
12249 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12250 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12251
12252 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12253 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12254 various aspects of this process.
12255
12256 @table @code
12257
12258 @item set hash
12259 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12260 @cindex hash mark while downloading
12261 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12262 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12263 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12264 monitor.
12265
12266 @item show hash
12267 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12268 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12269
12270 @item set debug monitor
12271 @kindex set debug monitor
12272 @cindex display remote monitor communications
12273 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12274 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12275
12276 @item show debug monitor
12277 @kindex show debug monitor
12278 Show the current status of displaying communications between
12279 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12280 @end table
12281
12282 @table @code
12283
12284 @kindex load @var{filename}
12285 @item load @var{filename}
12286 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12287 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12288 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12289 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12290 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12291 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12292
12293 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12294 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12295 target is @dots{}}''
12296
12297 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12298 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12299 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12300 specifies a fixed address.
12301 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12302
12303 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12304 load programs into flash memory.
12305
12306 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12307 @end table
12308
12309 @node Byte Order
12310 @section Choosing target byte order
12311
12312 @cindex choosing target byte order
12313 @cindex target byte order
12314
12315 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12316 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12317 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12318 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12319 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12320 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12321
12322 @table @code
12323 @kindex set endian
12324 @item set endian big
12325 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12326
12327 @item set endian little
12328 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12329
12330 @item set endian auto
12331 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12332 executable.
12333
12334 @item show endian
12335 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12336
12337 @end table
12338
12339 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12340 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12341 target system.
12342
12343 @node Remote
12344 @section Remote debugging
12345 @cindex remote debugging
12346
12347 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12348 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12349 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12350 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12351 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12352
12353 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12354 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12355 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12356 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12357 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12358 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12359
12360 Other remote targets may be available in your
12361 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12362
12363 Once you've connected to the remote target, @value{GDBN} allows you to
12364 send arbitrary commands to the remote monitor:
12365
12366 @table @code
12367 @item remote @var{command}
12368 @kindex remote@r{, a command}
12369 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12370 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the remote monitor.
12371 @end table
12372
12373
12374 @node Remote Debugging
12375 @chapter Debugging remote programs
12376
12377 @menu
12378 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12379 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12380 * Remote configuration:: Remote configuration
12381 * remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12382 @end menu
12383
12384 @node Connecting
12385 @section Connecting to a remote target
12386
12387 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12388 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symobl and debugging information.
12389 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12390 program as the first argument.
12391
12392 @cindex @code{target remote}
12393 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12394 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12395 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12396 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12397 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12398 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12399
12400 @table @code
12401
12402 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
12403 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12404 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12405 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12406
12407 @smallexample
12408 target remote /dev/ttyb
12409 @end smallexample
12410
12411 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12412 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12413 (@pxref{Remote configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12414 @code{target} command.
12415
12416 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12417 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12418 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12419 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12420 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12421 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12422 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12423 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12424 target.
12425
12426 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12427 @code{manyfarms}:
12428
12429 @smallexample
12430 target remote manyfarms:2828
12431 @end smallexample
12432
12433 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12434 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12435 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12436 port 1234 on your local machine:
12437
12438 @smallexample
12439 target remote :1234
12440 @end smallexample
12441 @noindent
12442
12443 Note that the colon is still required here.
12444
12445 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12446 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12447 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12448 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12449
12450 @smallexample
12451 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12452 @end smallexample
12453
12454 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12455 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12456 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12457 cause havoc with your debugging session.
12458
12459 @item target remote | @var{command}
12460 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12461 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12462 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12463 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12464 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12465 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12466 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12467 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12468
12469 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12470 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12471 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12472
12473 @end table
12474
12475 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12476 commands to examine and change data and to step and continue the
12477 remote program.
12478
12479 @cindex interrupting remote programs
12480 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
12481 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12482 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12483 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12484 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12485 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12486
12487 @smallexample
12488 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12489 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12490 @end smallexample
12491
12492 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12493 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12494 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12495 goes back to waiting.
12496
12497 @table @code
12498 @kindex detach (remote)
12499 @item detach
12500 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12501 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12502 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12503 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12504 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12505
12506 @kindex disconnect
12507 @item disconnect
12508 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12509 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12510 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12511 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12512 another target.
12513
12514 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12515 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12516 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
12517 @kindex monitor
12518 @item monitor @var{cmd}
12519 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12520 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12521 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12522 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12523 and implement.
12524 @end table
12525
12526 @node Server
12527 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
12528
12529 @kindex gdbserver
12530 @cindex remote connection without stubs
12531 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
12532 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12533 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
12534
12535 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
12536 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
12537 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
12538 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
12539 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
12540 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
12541 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
12542 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
12543 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
12544 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
12545 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
12546 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
12547 choice for debugging.
12548
12549 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
12550 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
12551 protocol.
12552
12553 @table @emph
12554 @item On the target machine,
12555 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
12556 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
12557 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
12558 system does all the symbol handling.
12559
12560 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
12561 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
12562 syntax is:
12563
12564 @smallexample
12565 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12566 @end smallexample
12567
12568 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
12569 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
12570 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
12571 @file{/dev/com1}:
12572
12573 @smallexample
12574 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
12575 @end smallexample
12576
12577 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
12578 with it.
12579
12580 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
12581
12582 @smallexample
12583 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
12584 @end smallexample
12585
12586 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
12587 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
12588 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
12589 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
12590 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
12591 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
12592 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
12593 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
12594 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
12595 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
12596 @code{target remote} command.
12597
12598 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
12599 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
12600
12601 @smallexample
12602 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
12603 @end smallexample
12604
12605 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
12606 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
12607
12608 @pindex pidof
12609 @cindex attach to a program by name
12610 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
12611 @code{pidof} utility:
12612
12613 @smallexample
12614 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{PROGRAM}`
12615 @end smallexample
12616
12617 In case more than one copy of @var{PROGRAM} is running, or @var{PROGRAM}
12618 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
12619 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
12620
12621 @item On the host machine,
12622 connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
12623 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
12624 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
12625 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
12626 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
12627 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
12628 already on the target. However, if you want to load the symbols (as
12629 you normally would), do that with the @code{file} command, and issue
12630 it @emph{before} connecting to the server; otherwise, you will get an
12631 error message saying @code{"Program is already running"}, since the
12632 program is considered running after the connection.
12633
12634 @end table
12635
12636 @node Remote configuration
12637 @section Remote configuration
12638
12639 @kindex set remote
12640 @kindex show remote
12641 This section documents the configuration options available when
12642 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
12643 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
12644 system-call-allowed}.
12645
12646 @table @code
12647 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
12648 @cindex adress size for remote targets
12649 @cindex bits in remote address
12650 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
12651 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
12652 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
12653 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
12654
12655 @item show remoteaddresssize
12656 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
12657
12658 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
12659 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
12660 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
12661 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
12662 remote targets.
12663
12664 @item show remotebaud
12665 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
12666
12667 @item set remotebreak
12668 @cindex interrupt remote programs
12669 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
12670 @anchor{set remotebreak}
12671 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
12672 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
12673 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
12674 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
12675 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
12676
12677 @item show remotebreak
12678 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
12679 interrupt the remote program.
12680
12681 @item set remotedevice @var{device}
12682 @cindex serial port name
12683 Set the name of the serial port through which to communicate to the
12684 remote target to @var{device}. This is the device used by
12685 @value{GDBN} to open the serial communications line to the remote
12686 target. There's no default, so you must set a valid port name for the
12687 remote serial communications to work. (Some varieties of the
12688 @code{target} command accept the port name as part of their
12689 arguments.)
12690
12691 @item show remotedevice
12692 Show the current name of the serial port.
12693
12694 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
12695 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
12696 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
12697 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
12698 @code{ascii}.
12699
12700 @item show remotelogbase
12701 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
12702 protocol.
12703
12704 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
12705 @cindex record serial communications on file
12706 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
12707 default is not to record at all.
12708
12709 @item show remotelogfile.
12710 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
12711 serial communications.
12712
12713 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
12714 @cindex timeout for serial communications
12715 @cindex remote timeout
12716 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
12717 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
12718
12719 @item show remotetimeout
12720 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
12721 responses.
12722
12723 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12724 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
12725 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
12726 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
12727 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
12728 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
12729 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
12730 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
12731
12732 @item set remote fetch-register-packet
12733 @itemx set remote set-register-packet
12734 @itemx set remote P-packet
12735 @itemx set remote p-packet
12736 @cindex P-packet
12737 @cindex fetch registers from remote targets
12738 @cindex set registers in remote targets
12739 Determine whether @value{GDBN} can set and fetch registers from the
12740 remote target using the @samp{P} packets. The default depends on the
12741 remote stub's support of the @samp{P} packets (@value{GDBN} queries
12742 the stub when this packet is first required).
12743
12744 @item show remote fetch-register-packet
12745 @itemx show remote set-register-packet
12746 @itemx show remote P-packet
12747 @itemx show remote p-packet
12748 Show the current setting of using the @samp{P} packets for setting and
12749 fetching registers from the remote target.
12750
12751 @cindex binary downloads
12752 @cindex X-packet
12753 @item set remote binary-download-packet
12754 @itemx set remote X-packet
12755 Determine whether @value{GDBN} sends downloads in binary mode using
12756 the @samp{X} packets. The default is on.
12757
12758 @item show remote binary-download-packet
12759 @itemx show remote X-packet
12760 Show the current setting of using the @samp{X} packets for binary
12761 downloads.
12762
12763 @item set remote read-aux-vector-packet
12764 @cindex auxiliary vector of remote target
12765 @cindex @code{auxv}, and remote targets
12766 Set the use of the remote protocol's @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} (target
12767 auxiliary vector) request. This request is used to fetch the
12768 remote target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}, see @ref{OS Information,
12769 Auxiliary Vector}. The default setting depends on the remote stub's
12770 support of this request (@value{GDBN} queries the stub when this
12771 request is first required). @xref{General Query Packets, qXfer}, for
12772 more information about this request.
12773
12774 @item show remote read-aux-vector-packet
12775 Show the current setting of use of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} request.
12776
12777 @item set remote symbol-lookup-packet
12778 @cindex remote symbol lookup request
12779 Set the use of the remote protocol's @samp{qSymbol} (target symbol
12780 lookup) request. This request is used to communicate symbol
12781 information to the remote target, e.g., whenever a new shared library
12782 is loaded by the remote (@pxref{Files, shared libraries}). The
12783 default setting depends on the remote stub's support of this request
12784 (@value{GDBN} queries the stub when this request is first required).
12785 @xref{General Query Packets, qSymbol}, for more information about this
12786 request.
12787
12788 @item show remote symbol-lookup-packet
12789 Show the current setting of use of the @samp{qSymbol} request.
12790
12791 @item set remote verbose-resume-packet
12792 @cindex resume remote target
12793 @cindex signal thread, and remote targets
12794 @cindex single-step thread, and remote targets
12795 @cindex thread-specific operations on remote targets
12796 Set the use of the remote protocol's @samp{vCont} (descriptive resume)
12797 request. This request is used to resume specific threads in the
12798 remote target, and to single-step or signal them. The default setting
12799 depends on the remote stub's support of this request (@value{GDBN}
12800 queries the stub when this request is first required). This setting
12801 affects debugging of multithreaded programs: if @samp{vCont} cannot be
12802 used, @value{GDBN} might be unable to single-step a specific thread,
12803 especially under @code{set scheduler-locking off}; it is also
12804 impossible to pause a specific thread. @xref{Packets, vCont}, for
12805 more details.
12806
12807 @item show remote verbose-resume-packet
12808 Show the current setting of use of the @samp{vCont} request
12809
12810 @item set remote software-breakpoint-packet
12811 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-packet
12812 @itemx set remote write-watchpoint-packet
12813 @itemx set remote read-watchpoint-packet
12814 @itemx set remote access-watchpoint-packet
12815 @itemx set remote Z-packet
12816 @cindex Z-packet
12817 @cindex remote hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12818 These commands enable or disable the use of @samp{Z} packets for
12819 setting breakpoints and watchpoints in the remote target. The default
12820 depends on the remote stub's support of the @samp{Z} packets
12821 (@value{GDBN} queries the stub when each packet is first required).
12822 The command @code{set remote Z-packet}, kept for back-compatibility,
12823 turns on or off all the features that require the use of @samp{Z}
12824 packets.
12825
12826 @item show remote software-breakpoint-packet
12827 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-packet
12828 @itemx show remote write-watchpoint-packet
12829 @itemx show remote read-watchpoint-packet
12830 @itemx show remote access-watchpoint-packet
12831 @itemx show remote Z-packet
12832 Show the current setting of @samp{Z} packets usage.
12833
12834 @item set remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12835 @kindex set remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12836 @cindex thread local storage of remote targets
12837 This command enables or disables the use of the @samp{qGetTLSAddr}
12838 (Get Thread Local Storage Address) request packet. The default
12839 depends on whether the remote stub supports this request.
12840 @xref{General Query Packets, qGetTLSAddr}, for more details about this
12841 packet.
12842
12843 @item show remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12844 @kindex show remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12845 Show the current setting of @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet usage.
12846
12847 @item set remote supported-packets
12848 @kindex set remote supported-packets
12849 @cindex query supported packets of remote targets
12850 This command enables or disables the use of the @samp{qSupported}
12851 request packet. @xref{General Query Packets, qSupported}, for more
12852 details about this packet. The default is to use @samp{qSupported}.
12853
12854 @item show remote supported-packets
12855 @kindex show remote supported-packets
12856 Show the current setting of @samp{qSupported} packet usage.
12857 @end table
12858
12859 @node remote stub
12860 @section Implementing a remote stub
12861
12862 @cindex debugging stub, example
12863 @cindex remote stub, example
12864 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
12865 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
12866 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
12867 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
12868 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
12869 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
12870 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
12871 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
12872
12873 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
12874 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
12875 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
12876 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
12877 program, you need:
12878
12879 @enumerate
12880 @item
12881 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
12882 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
12883 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
12884
12885 @item
12886 A C subroutine library to support your program's
12887 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
12888
12889 @item
12890 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
12891 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
12892 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
12893 documentation.
12894 @end enumerate
12895
12896 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
12897 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
12898 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
12899
12900 @table @emph
12901 @item On the host,
12902 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
12903 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
12904 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
12905
12906 @item On the target,
12907 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
12908 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
12909 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
12910
12911 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
12912 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
12913 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
12914 @end table
12915
12916 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
12917 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
12918 @sc{sparc} boards.
12919
12920 @cindex remote serial stub list
12921 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
12922
12923 @table @code
12924
12925 @item i386-stub.c
12926 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
12927 @cindex Intel
12928 @cindex i386
12929 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
12930
12931 @item m68k-stub.c
12932 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
12933 @cindex Motorola 680x0
12934 @cindex m680x0
12935 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
12936
12937 @item sh-stub.c
12938 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
12939 @cindex Renesas
12940 @cindex SH
12941 For Renesas SH architectures.
12942
12943 @item sparc-stub.c
12944 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
12945 @cindex Sparc
12946 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
12947
12948 @item sparcl-stub.c
12949 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
12950 @cindex Fujitsu
12951 @cindex SparcLite
12952 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
12953
12954 @end table
12955
12956 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
12957 recently added stubs.
12958
12959 @menu
12960 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
12961 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
12962 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
12963 @end menu
12964
12965 @node Stub Contents
12966 @subsection What the stub can do for you
12967
12968 @cindex remote serial stub
12969 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
12970 subroutines:
12971
12972 @table @code
12973 @item set_debug_traps
12974 @findex set_debug_traps
12975 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
12976 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
12977 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
12978 beginning of your program.
12979
12980 @item handle_exception
12981 @findex handle_exception
12982 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
12983 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
12984 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
12985 run when a trap is triggered.
12986
12987 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
12988 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
12989 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
12990 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
12991 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
12992 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
12993 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
12994 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
12995 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
12996 machine.
12997
12998 @item breakpoint
12999 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13000 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13001 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13002 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13003 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13004 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13005 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13006 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13007 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13008 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13009 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
13010
13011 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13012 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13013 start of your debugging session.
13014 @end table
13015
13016 @node Bootstrapping
13017 @subsection What you must do for the stub
13018
13019 @cindex remote stub, support routines
13020 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13021 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13022 debugging target machine.
13023
13024 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13025 serial port.
13026
13027 @table @code
13028 @item int getDebugChar()
13029 @findex getDebugChar
13030 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13031 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13032 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13033
13034 @item void putDebugChar(int)
13035 @findex putDebugChar
13036 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13037 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13038 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13039 @end table
13040
13041 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
13042 @cindex interrupting remote targets
13043 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13044 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13045 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13046 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13047 remote system to stop.
13048
13049 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13050 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13051 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13052 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13053
13054 Other routines you need to supply are:
13055
13056 @table @code
13057 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13058 @findex exceptionHandler
13059 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13060 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13061 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13062 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13063 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13064 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13065 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13066 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13067 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13068 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13069 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13070 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13071 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13072
13073 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13074 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13075 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13076 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13077 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13078
13079 @item void flush_i_cache()
13080 @findex flush_i_cache
13081 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13082 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13083 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13084
13085 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13086 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13087 @end table
13088
13089 @noindent
13090 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13091
13092 @table @code
13093 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13094 @findex memset
13095 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13096 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13097 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13098 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13099 @end table
13100
13101 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13102 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13103 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13104 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
13105
13106
13107 @node Debug Session
13108 @subsection Putting it all together
13109
13110 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
13111 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13112 steps.
13113
13114 @enumerate
13115 @item
13116 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13117 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
13118 @display
13119 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13120 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13121 @end display
13122
13123 @item
13124 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13125
13126 @smallexample
13127 set_debug_traps();
13128 breakpoint();
13129 @end smallexample
13130
13131 @item
13132 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13133 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13134
13135 @smallexample
13136 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13137 @end smallexample
13138
13139 @noindent
13140 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13141 function in your program, that function is called when
13142 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13143 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13144 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13145
13146 @item
13147 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13148 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13149
13150 @item
13151 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13152 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13153
13154 @item
13155 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13156 @c document that. FIXME.
13157 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13158 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13159
13160 @item
13161 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13162 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
13163
13164 @end enumerate
13165
13166 @node Configurations
13167 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13168
13169 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13170 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13171 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13172
13173 There are three major categories of configurations: native
13174 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13175 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13176 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13177 are quite different from each other.
13178
13179 @menu
13180 * Native::
13181 * Embedded OS::
13182 * Embedded Processors::
13183 * Architectures::
13184 @end menu
13185
13186 @node Native
13187 @section Native
13188
13189 This section describes details specific to particular native
13190 configurations.
13191
13192 @menu
13193 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
13194 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13195 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13196 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13197 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13198 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13199 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13200 @end menu
13201
13202 @node HP-UX
13203 @subsection HP-UX
13204
13205 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13206 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13207 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13208
13209
13210 @node BSD libkvm Interface
13211 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13212
13213 @cindex libkvm
13214 @cindex kernel memory image
13215 @cindex kernel crash dump
13216
13217 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13218 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13219 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13220 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13221 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13222 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13223 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13224 @code{kvm} target:
13225
13226 @smallexample
13227 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13228 @end smallexample
13229
13230 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13231 argument:
13232
13233 @smallexample
13234 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13235 @end smallexample
13236
13237 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13238 available:
13239
13240 @table @code
13241 @kindex kvm
13242 @item kvm pcb
13243 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13244
13245 @item kvm proc
13246 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13247 modern FreeBSD systems.
13248 @end table
13249
13250 @node SVR4 Process Information
13251 @subsection SVR4 process information
13252 @cindex /proc
13253 @cindex examine process image
13254 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13255
13256 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13257 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13258 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13259 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13260 proc} is available to report information about the process running
13261 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13262 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13263 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13264 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13265
13266 @table @code
13267 @kindex info proc
13268 @cindex process ID
13269 @item info proc
13270 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13271 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13272 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13273 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13274 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13275 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13276 executable file's absolute file name.
13277
13278 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13279 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13280 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13281 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13282 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13283 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13284
13285 @item info proc mappings
13286 @cindex memory address space mappings
13287 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13288 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13289 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13290 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13291 memory access rights to that range.
13292
13293 @item info proc stat
13294 @itemx info proc status
13295 @cindex process detailed status information
13296 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13297 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13298 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13299 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13300 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13301 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13302 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13303
13304 @item info proc all
13305 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13306 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13307
13308 @ignore
13309 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13310 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13311 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13312 @kindex info proc times
13313 @item info proc times
13314 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13315 its children.
13316
13317 @kindex info proc id
13318 @item info proc id
13319 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13320 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13321 @end ignore
13322
13323 @item set procfs-trace
13324 @kindex set procfs-trace
13325 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13326 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13327
13328 @item show procfs-trace
13329 @kindex show procfs-trace
13330 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13331
13332 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
13333 @kindex set procfs-file
13334 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13335 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13336 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13337 standard output.
13338
13339 @item show procfs-file
13340 @kindex show procfs-file
13341 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13342
13343 @item proc-trace-entry
13344 @itemx proc-trace-exit
13345 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
13346 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
13347 @kindex proc-trace-entry
13348 @kindex proc-trace-exit
13349 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
13350 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
13351 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13352 from the @code{syscall} interface.
13353
13354 @item info pidlist
13355 @kindex info pidlist
13356 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13357 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13358 processes and all the threads within each process.
13359
13360 @item info meminfo
13361 @kindex info meminfo
13362 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13363 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13364 @end table
13365
13366 @node DJGPP Native
13367 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13368 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13369 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13370 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13371
13372 @cindex DPMI
13373 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13374 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13375 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13376 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13377
13378 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13379 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13380 subsection describes those commands.
13381
13382 @table @code
13383 @kindex info dos
13384 @item info dos
13385 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
13386 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13387
13388 @kindex sysinfo
13389 @cindex MS-DOS system info
13390 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
13391 @item info dos sysinfo
13392 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
13393 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
13394 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
13395
13396 @cindex GDT
13397 @cindex LDT
13398 @cindex IDT
13399 @cindex segment descriptor tables
13400 @cindex descriptor tables display
13401 @item info dos gdt
13402 @itemx info dos ldt
13403 @itemx info dos idt
13404 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
13405 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
13406 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
13407 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
13408 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
13409 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
13410 rights.
13411
13412 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
13413 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
13414 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
13415 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
13416 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
13417
13418 @cindex garbled pointers
13419 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
13420 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
13421 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
13422 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
13423 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
13424 debugged program's data segment:
13425
13426 @smallexample
13427 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
13428 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
13429 @end smallexample
13430
13431 @noindent
13432 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
13433 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
13434
13435 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
13436 @item info dos pde
13437 @itemx info dos pte
13438 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
13439 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
13440 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
13441 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
13442 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
13443 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
13444 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
13445 that is currently in use.
13446
13447 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
13448 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
13449 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
13450 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
13451 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
13452 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
13453 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
13454
13455 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
13456 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
13457 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
13458 controller.
13459
13460 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
13461
13462 @cindex physical address from linear address
13463 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
13464 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
13465 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
13466 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
13467 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
13468 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
13469 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
13470
13471 @smallexample
13472 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
13473 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
13474 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
13475 @end smallexample
13476
13477 @noindent
13478 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
13479 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
13480 attributes of that page.
13481
13482 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
13483 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
13484 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
13485 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
13486 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
13487 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
13488
13489 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
13490 transfer buffer:
13491
13492 @smallexample
13493 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
13494 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
13495 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
13496 @end smallexample
13497
13498 @noindent
13499 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
13500 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
13501 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
13502 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
13503 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
13504
13505 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
13506 @end table
13507
13508 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
13509 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
13510 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
13511 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
13512
13513 @table @code
13514 @kindex set com1base
13515 @kindex set com1irq
13516 @kindex set com2base
13517 @kindex set com2irq
13518 @kindex set com3base
13519 @kindex set com3irq
13520 @kindex set com4base
13521 @kindex set com4irq
13522 @item set com1base @var{addr}
13523 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
13524 port.
13525
13526 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
13527 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
13528 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
13529
13530 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
13531 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
13532 other 3 COM ports.
13533
13534 @kindex show com1base
13535 @kindex show com1irq
13536 @kindex show com2base
13537 @kindex show com2irq
13538 @kindex show com3base
13539 @kindex show com3irq
13540 @kindex show com4base
13541 @kindex show com4irq
13542 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
13543 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
13544 lines used by the COM ports.
13545
13546 @item info serial
13547 @kindex info serial
13548 @cindex DOS serial port status
13549 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
13550 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
13551 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
13552 counts of various errors encountered so far.
13553 @end table
13554
13555
13556 @node Cygwin Native
13557 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
13558 @cindex MS Windows debugging
13559 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
13560 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
13561
13562 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
13563 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
13564 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this subsection. The
13565 subsubsection @pxref{Non-debug DLL symbols} describes working with DLLs
13566 that have no debugging symbols.
13567
13568
13569 @table @code
13570 @kindex info w32
13571 @item info w32
13572 This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
13573 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13574
13575 @item info w32 selector
13576 This command displays information returned by
13577 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
13578 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
13579 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
13580 Without argument, this command displays information
13581 about the the six segment registers.
13582
13583 @kindex info dll
13584 @item info dll
13585 This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
13586
13587 @kindex dll-symbols
13588 @item dll-symbols
13589 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
13590 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
13591
13592 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
13593 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
13594 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
13595 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
13596 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
13597 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
13598 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
13599 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
13600 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
13601 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
13602 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
13603
13604 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
13605 @item show cygwin-exceptions
13606 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
13607 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
13608
13609 @kindex set new-console
13610 @item set new-console @var{mode}
13611 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
13612 be started in a new console on next start.
13613 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
13614 be started in the same console as the debugger.
13615
13616 @kindex show new-console
13617 @item show new-console
13618 Displays whether a new console is used
13619 when the debuggee is started.
13620
13621 @kindex set new-group
13622 @item set new-group @var{mode}
13623 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
13624 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
13625 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
13626 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
13627
13628 @kindex show new-group
13629 @item show new-group
13630 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
13631
13632 @kindex set debugevents
13633 @item set debugevents
13634 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
13635 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
13636 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
13637 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
13638 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
13639
13640 @kindex set debugexec
13641 @item set debugexec
13642 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
13643 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
13644
13645 @kindex set debugexceptions
13646 @item set debugexceptions
13647 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
13648 debuggee seen by the debugger.
13649
13650 @kindex set debugmemory
13651 @item set debugmemory
13652 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
13653 and writes by the debugger.
13654
13655 @kindex set shell
13656 @item set shell
13657 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
13658 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
13659
13660 @kindex show shell
13661 @item show shell
13662 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
13663
13664 @end table
13665
13666 @menu
13667 * Non-debug DLL symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13668 @end menu
13669
13670 @node Non-debug DLL symbols
13671 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13672 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
13673 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
13674
13675 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
13676 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
13677 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
13678 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
13679 information contained in the DLL's export table. This subsubsection
13680 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
13681 ``minimal symbols''.
13682
13683 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
13684 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
13685 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
13686 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
13687 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
13688 see the shared library information in @pxref{Files} or the
13689 @code{dll-symbols} command in @pxref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
13690 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
13691 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
13692 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
13693
13694 @subsubsection DLL name prefixes
13695
13696 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
13697 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
13698 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
13699 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
13700 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
13701 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
13702 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
13703 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
13704 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
13705
13706 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
13707 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
13708 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
13709 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
13710 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols} (see
13711 @pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
13712
13713 @smallexample
13714 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
13715 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
13716
13717 Non-debugging symbols:
13718 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
13719 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
13720 @end smallexample
13721
13722 @smallexample
13723 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
13724 All functions matching regular expression "!":
13725
13726 Non-debugging symbols:
13727 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
13728 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
13729 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
13730 [etc...]
13731 @end smallexample
13732
13733 @subsubsection Working with minimal symbols
13734
13735 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
13736 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
13737 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
13738 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
13739 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
13740 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
13741 a function within a DLL without a running program.
13742
13743 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
13744 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
13745 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
13746 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
13747 problem:
13748
13749 @smallexample
13750 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
13751 $1 = 268572168
13752 @end smallexample
13753
13754 @smallexample
13755 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
13756 0x10021610: "\230y\""
13757 @end smallexample
13758
13759 And two possible solutions:
13760
13761 @smallexample
13762 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
13763 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13764 @end smallexample
13765
13766 @smallexample
13767 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
13768 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
13769 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
13770 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
13771 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
13772 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13773 @end smallexample
13774
13775 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
13776 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
13777 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
13778 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
13779 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
13780
13781 @smallexample
13782 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
13783 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
13784 @end smallexample
13785
13786 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
13787 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
13788 safe.
13789
13790 @node Hurd Native
13791 @subsection Commands specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd systems
13792 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
13793
13794 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
13795 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
13796
13797 @table @code
13798 @item set signals
13799 @itemx set sigs
13800 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
13801 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13802 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
13803 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
13804 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
13805 @code{signals}.
13806
13807 @item show signals
13808 @itemx show sigs
13809 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
13810 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13811 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
13812
13813 @item set signal-thread
13814 @itemx set sigthread
13815 @kindex set signal-thread
13816 @kindex set sigthread
13817 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
13818 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
13819 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
13820 signal-thread}.
13821
13822 @item show signal-thread
13823 @itemx show sigthread
13824 @kindex show signal-thread
13825 @kindex show sigthread
13826 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
13827 delivered a signal.
13828
13829 @item set stopped
13830 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13831 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
13832 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
13833 continued by delivering a signal to it.
13834
13835 @item show stopped
13836 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13837 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
13838 stopped.
13839
13840 @item set exceptions
13841 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13842 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
13843 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
13844 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
13845 trapping on.
13846
13847 @item show exceptions
13848 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13849 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
13850
13851 @item set task pause
13852 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
13853 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13854 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13855 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
13856 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
13857 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
13858 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
13859 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
13860 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
13861
13862 @item show task pause
13863 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
13864 Show the current state of task suspension.
13865
13866 @item set task detach-suspend-count
13867 @cindex task suspend count
13868 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13869 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
13870 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
13871
13872 @item show task detach-suspend-count
13873 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
13874
13875 @item set task exception-port
13876 @itemx set task excp
13877 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13878 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
13879 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
13880 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
13881
13882 @item set noninvasive
13883 @cindex noninvasive task options
13884 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
13885 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
13886 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
13887 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
13888
13889 @item info send-rights
13890 @itemx info receive-rights
13891 @itemx info port-rights
13892 @itemx info port-sets
13893 @itemx info dead-names
13894 @itemx info ports
13895 @itemx info psets
13896 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13897 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13898 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13899 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13900 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13901 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
13902 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
13903 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
13904 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
13905
13906 @item set thread pause
13907 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
13908 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13909 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13910 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
13911 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
13912 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
13913 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
13914 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
13915 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
13916 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
13917 only the current thread.
13918
13919 @item show thread pause
13920 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
13921 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
13922
13923 @item set thread run
13924 This comamnd sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13925
13926 @item show thread run
13927 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13928
13929 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
13930 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13931 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13932 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
13933 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
13934 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
13935 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
13936
13937 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
13938 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
13939 detaching.
13940
13941 @item set thread exception-port
13942 @itemx set thread excp
13943 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
13944 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
13945 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
13946
13947 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
13948 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
13949 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
13950 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
13951
13952 @item set thread default
13953 @itemx show thread default
13954 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13955 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
13956 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
13957 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
13958 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
13959 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
13960 the non-default commands.
13961 @end table
13962
13963
13964 @node Neutrino
13965 @subsection QNX Neutrino
13966 @cindex QNX Neutrino
13967
13968 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
13969 Neutrino target:
13970
13971 @table @code
13972 @item set debug nto-debug
13973 @kindex set debug nto-debug
13974 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
13975 Neutrino support.
13976
13977 @item show debug nto-debug
13978 @kindex show debug nto-debug
13979 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
13980 @end table
13981
13982
13983 @node Embedded OS
13984 @section Embedded Operating Systems
13985
13986 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
13987 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
13988 architectures.
13989
13990 @menu
13991 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
13992 @end menu
13993
13994 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
13995 various real-time operating systems.
13996
13997 @node VxWorks
13998 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
13999
14000 @cindex VxWorks
14001
14002 @table @code
14003
14004 @kindex target vxworks
14005 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14006 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14007 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14008
14009 @end table
14010
14011 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14012 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14013
14014 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14015 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14016 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14017 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14018 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14019 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14020 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14021
14022 @table @code
14023 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14024 @kindex vxworks-timeout
14025 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14026 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14027 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14028 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14029 of a thin network line.
14030 @end table
14031
14032 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14033 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14034 procedures.
14035
14036 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
14037 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14038 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14039 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14040 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14041 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14042 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14043 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14044 manual.
14045 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14046
14047 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14048 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14049 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14050 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14051
14052 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14053
14054 @smallexample
14055 (vxgdb)
14056 @end smallexample
14057
14058 @menu
14059 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14060 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14061 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14062 @end menu
14063
14064 @node VxWorks Connection
14065 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14066
14067 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14068 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14069
14070 @smallexample
14071 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14072 @end smallexample
14073
14074 @need 750
14075 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14076
14077 @smallexample
14078 Attaching remote machine across net...
14079 Connected to tt.
14080 @end smallexample
14081
14082 @need 1000
14083 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14084 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14085 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14086 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
14087 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14088
14089 @smallexample
14090 prog.o: No such file or directory.
14091 @end smallexample
14092
14093 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14094 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14095 command again.
14096
14097 @node VxWorks Download
14098 @subsubsection VxWorks download
14099
14100 @cindex download to VxWorks
14101 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14102 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14103 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14104 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14105 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14106 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14107 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14108 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14109 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14110 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14111 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14112 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14113 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14114 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14115 program, type this on VxWorks:
14116
14117 @smallexample
14118 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14119 @end smallexample
14120
14121 @noindent
14122 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14123
14124 @smallexample
14125 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14126 (vxgdb) load prog.o
14127 @end smallexample
14128
14129 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14130
14131 @smallexample
14132 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14133 @end smallexample
14134
14135 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14136 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14137 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14138 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14139 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14140 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14141 table.)
14142
14143 @node VxWorks Attach
14144 @subsubsection Running tasks
14145
14146 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
14147 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14148 follows:
14149
14150 @smallexample
14151 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14152 @end smallexample
14153
14154 @noindent
14155 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14156 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14157 the time of attachment.
14158
14159 @node Embedded Processors
14160 @section Embedded Processors
14161
14162 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14163 configurations.
14164
14165 @cindex send command to simulator
14166 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14167 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14168
14169 @table @code
14170 @item sim @var{command}
14171 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
14172 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14173 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14174 acceptable commands.
14175 @end table
14176
14177
14178 @menu
14179 * ARM:: ARM RDI
14180 * H8/300:: Renesas H8/300
14181 * H8/500:: Renesas H8/500
14182 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14183 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
14184 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14185 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14186 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
14187 * PowerPC: PowerPC
14188 * SH:: Renesas SH
14189 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14190 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14191 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
14192 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14193 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
14194 * CRIS:: CRIS
14195 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14196 * WinCE:: Windows CE child processes
14197 @end menu
14198
14199 @node ARM
14200 @subsection ARM
14201 @cindex ARM RDI
14202
14203 @table @code
14204 @kindex target rdi
14205 @item target rdi @var{dev}
14206 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14207 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14208 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14209
14210 @kindex target rdp
14211 @item target rdp @var{dev}
14212 ARM Demon monitor.
14213
14214 @end table
14215
14216 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14217
14218 @table @code
14219 @item set arm disassembler
14220 @kindex set arm
14221 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14222 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14223
14224 @item show arm disassembler
14225 @kindex show arm
14226 Show the current disassembly style.
14227
14228 @item set arm apcs32
14229 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14230 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14231
14232 @item show arm apcs32
14233 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14234
14235 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14236 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14237 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14238
14239 @table @code
14240 @item auto
14241 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14242 @item softfpa
14243 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14244 processors.
14245 @item fpa
14246 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14247 @item softvfp
14248 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14249 @item vfp
14250 VFP co-processor.
14251 @end table
14252
14253 @item show arm fpu
14254 Show the current type of the FPU.
14255
14256 @item set arm abi
14257 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14258
14259 @item show arm abi
14260 Show the currently used ABI.
14261
14262 @item set debug arm
14263 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14264 target support subsystem.
14265
14266 @item show debug arm
14267 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14268 @end table
14269
14270 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14271 using the RDI interface:
14272
14273 @table @code
14274 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14275 @kindex rdilogfile
14276 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14277 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14278 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14279 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14280 @file{rdi.log}.
14281
14282 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14283 @kindex rdilogenable
14284 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14285 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14286 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14287 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14288 are logged to a file.
14289
14290 @item set rdiromatzero
14291 @kindex set rdiromatzero
14292 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14293 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14294 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14295 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14296 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14297
14298 @item show rdiromatzero
14299 @kindex show rdiromatzero
14300 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14301
14302 @item set rdiheartbeat
14303 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
14304 @cindex RDI heartbeat
14305 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14306 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14307 well as the Angel monitor.
14308
14309 @item show rdiheartbeat
14310 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
14311 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14312 @end table
14313
14314
14315 @node H8/300
14316 @subsection Renesas H8/300
14317
14318 @table @code
14319
14320 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
14321 @item target hms @var{dev}
14322 A Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
14323 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
14324 line and the communications speed used.
14325
14326 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
14327 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
14328 E7000 emulator for Renesas H8 and SH.
14329
14330 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
14331 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
14332 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
14333 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
14334 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
14335
14336 @end table
14337
14338 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
14339 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
14340 @cindex download to Renesas SH
14341 @cindex Renesas SH download
14342 When you select remote debugging to a Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500
14343 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Renesas
14344 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
14345 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
14346
14347 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
14348 Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
14349
14350 @enumerate
14351 @item
14352 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
14353 for Renesas microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
14354 emulator for the Renesas SH and the Renesas 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
14355 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Renesas SH,
14356 H8/300, or H8/500.)
14357
14358 @item
14359 what serial device connects your host to your Renesas board (the first
14360 serial device available on your host is the default).
14361
14362 @item
14363 what speed to use over the serial device.
14364 @end enumerate
14365
14366 @menu
14367 * Renesas Boards:: Connecting to Renesas boards.
14368 * Renesas ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
14369 * Renesas Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros.
14370 @end menu
14371
14372 @node Renesas Boards
14373 @subsubsection Connecting to Renesas boards
14374
14375 @c only for Unix hosts
14376 @kindex device
14377 @cindex serial device, Renesas micros
14378 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
14379 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
14380 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
14381 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
14382
14383 @kindex speed
14384 @cindex serial line speed, Renesas micros
14385 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
14386 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
14387 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
14388 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
14389 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
14390
14391 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
14392 use a Unix host to debug your Renesas microprocessor programs. If you
14393 use a DOS host,
14394 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
14395 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
14396 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
14397 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
14398
14399 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
14400 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
14401 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
14402 the Renesas SH and the H8/500.
14403
14404 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
14405 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
14406 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
14407 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
14408 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
14409 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
14410 @code{COM2}.
14411
14412 @smallexample
14413 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
14414 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
14415
14416 Resident portion of MODE loaded
14417
14418 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
14419
14420 @end smallexample
14421
14422 @quotation
14423 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
14424 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
14425 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
14426 your development board.
14427 @end quotation
14428
14429 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
14430 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
14431 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBN}} with
14432 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
14433 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
14434 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
14435 cross-debugging to the Renesas board, and the @code{load} command to
14436 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
14437 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
14438 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
14439 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
14440 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
14441 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
14442
14443 @smallexample
14444 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
14445 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
14446 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
14447 the conditions.
14448 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
14449 for details.
14450 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
14451 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
14452 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
14453 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
14454 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
14455 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
14456 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
14457 @end smallexample
14458
14459 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
14460 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
14461 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
14462 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
14463 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
14464 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
14465
14466 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
14467 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
14468 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
14469
14470 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
14471 @itemize @bullet
14472 @item
14473 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{Ctrl-c} on the DOS host---it has
14474 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
14475
14476 @item
14477 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
14478 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
14479 to detect program completion.
14480 @end itemize
14481
14482 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
14483 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
14484
14485 @node Renesas ICE
14486 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
14487
14488 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas ICE}
14489 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
14490 Renesas SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
14491 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
14492
14493 @table @code
14494 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
14495 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
14496 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
14497 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
14498 (for example, @samp{9600}).
14499
14500 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
14501 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
14502 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
14503 @end table
14504
14505 The following special commands are available when debugging with the
14506 Renesas E7000 ICE:
14507
14508 @table @code
14509 @item e7000 @var{command}
14510 @kindex e7000
14511 @cindex send command to E7000 monitor
14512 This sends the specified @var{command} to the E7000 monitor.
14513
14514 @item ftplogin @var{machine} @var{username} @var{password} @var{dir}
14515 @kindex ftplogin@r{, E7000}
14516 This command records information for subsequent interface with the
14517 E7000 monitor via the FTP protocol: @value{GDBN} will log into the
14518 named @var{machine} using specified @var{username} and @var{password},
14519 and then chdir to the named directory @var{dir}.
14520
14521 @item ftpload @var{file}
14522 @kindex ftpload@r{, E7000}
14523 This command uses credentials recorded by @code{ftplogin} to fetch and
14524 load the named @var{file} from the E7000 monitor.
14525
14526 @item drain
14527 @kindex drain@r{, E7000}
14528 This command drains any pending text buffers stored on the E7000.
14529
14530 @item set usehardbreakpoints
14531 @itemx show usehardbreakpoints
14532 @kindex set usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
14533 @kindex show usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
14534 @cindex hardware breakpoints, and E7000
14535 These commands set and show the use of hardware breakpoints for all
14536 breakpoints. @xref{Set Breaks, hardware-assisted breakpoint}, for
14537 more information about using hardware breakpoints selectively.
14538 @end table
14539
14540 @node Renesas Special
14541 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros
14542
14543 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
14544
14545 @table @code
14546
14547 @kindex set machine
14548 @kindex show machine
14549 @item set machine h8300
14550 @itemx set machine h8300h
14551 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
14552 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
14553 to check which variant is currently in effect.
14554
14555 @end table
14556
14557 @node H8/500
14558 @subsection H8/500
14559
14560 @table @code
14561
14562 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
14563 @cindex memory models, H8/500
14564 @item set memory @var{mod}
14565 @itemx show memory
14566 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
14567 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
14568 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
14569 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
14570
14571 @end table
14572
14573 @node M32R/D
14574 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14575
14576 @table @code
14577 @kindex target m32r
14578 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14579 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14580
14581 @kindex target m32rsdi
14582 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14583 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14584 @end table
14585
14586 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14587
14588 @table @code
14589 @item set download-path @var{path}
14590 @kindex set download-path
14591 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14592 Set the default path for finding donwloadable @sc{srec} files.
14593
14594 @item show download-path
14595 @kindex show download-path
14596 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14597
14598 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14599 @kindex set board-address
14600 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14601 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14602
14603 @item show board-address
14604 @kindex show board-address
14605 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14606
14607 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14608 @kindex set server-address
14609 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14610 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14611 host machine.
14612
14613 @item show server-address
14614 @kindex show server-address
14615 Display the IP address of the download server.
14616
14617 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14618 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14619 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14620 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14621 executable file is uploaded.
14622
14623 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14624 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14625 Test the @code{upload} command.
14626 @end table
14627
14628 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14629
14630 @table @code
14631 @item sdireset
14632 @kindex sdireset
14633 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14634 This command resets the SDI connection.
14635
14636 @item sdistatus
14637 @kindex sdistatus
14638 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14639
14640 @item debug_chaos
14641 @kindex debug_chaos
14642 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14643 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14644
14645 @item use_debug_dma
14646 @kindex use_debug_dma
14647 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14648
14649 @item use_mon_code
14650 @kindex use_mon_code
14651 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14652
14653 @item use_ib_break
14654 @kindex use_ib_break
14655 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14656
14657 @item use_dbt_break
14658 @kindex use_dbt_break
14659 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14660 @end table
14661
14662 @node M68K
14663 @subsection M68k
14664
14665 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
14666 target command for the following ROM monitors.
14667
14668 @table @code
14669
14670 @kindex target abug
14671 @item target abug @var{dev}
14672 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
14673
14674 @kindex target cpu32bug
14675 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
14676 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14677
14678 @kindex target dbug
14679 @item target dbug @var{dev}
14680 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14681
14682 @kindex target est
14683 @item target est @var{dev}
14684 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14685
14686 @kindex target rom68k
14687 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
14688 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
14689
14690 @end table
14691
14692 @table @code
14693
14694 @kindex target rombug
14695 @item target rombug @var{dev}
14696 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
14697
14698 @end table
14699
14700 @node MIPS Embedded
14701 @subsection MIPS Embedded
14702
14703 @cindex MIPS boards
14704 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14705 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14706 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14707
14708 @need 1000
14709 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14710
14711 @table @code
14712 @item target mips @var{port}
14713 @kindex target mips @var{port}
14714 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14715 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14716 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14717 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14718 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14719 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14720
14721 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14722 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14723 debugger:
14724
14725 @smallexample
14726 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14727 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14728 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14729 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14730 (@value{GDBP}) run
14731 @end smallexample
14732
14733 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14734 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14735 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14736 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14737 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14738
14739 @item target pmon @var{port}
14740 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
14741 PMON ROM monitor.
14742
14743 @item target ddb @var{port}
14744 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
14745 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14746
14747 @item target lsi @var{port}
14748 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
14749 LSI variant of PMON.
14750
14751 @kindex target r3900
14752 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
14753 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14754
14755 @kindex target array
14756 @item target array @var{dev}
14757 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14758
14759 @end table
14760
14761
14762 @noindent
14763 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14764
14765 @table @code
14766 @item set mipsfpu double
14767 @itemx set mipsfpu single
14768 @itemx set mipsfpu none
14769 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
14770 @itemx show mipsfpu
14771 @kindex set mipsfpu
14772 @kindex show mipsfpu
14773 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
14774 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
14775 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
14776 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
14777 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
14778 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
14779 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
14780 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
14781 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
14782 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
14783 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
14784 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
14785 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
14786
14787 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
14788 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
14789 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
14790
14791 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
14792 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
14793
14794 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
14795 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
14796 @itemx show timeout
14797 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
14798 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
14799 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
14800 @kindex set timeout
14801 @kindex show timeout
14802 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
14803 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
14804 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
14805 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
14806 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
14807 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
14808 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
14809 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
14810 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
14811 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
14812
14813 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
14814 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
14815 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
14816 to run before stopping.
14817
14818 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
14819 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14820 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
14821 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
14822 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
14823 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
14824
14825 @item show syn-garbage-limit
14826 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14827 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
14828 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
14829
14830 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
14831 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14832 @cindex remote monitor prompt
14833 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
14834 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
14835 @table @asis
14836 @item pmon target
14837 @samp{PMON}
14838 @item ddb target
14839 @samp{NEC010}
14840 @item lsi target
14841 @samp{PMON>}
14842 @end table
14843
14844 @item show monitor-prompt
14845 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14846 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
14847 remote monitor.
14848
14849 @item set monitor-warnings
14850 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14851 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
14852 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
14853 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
14854 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
14855
14856 @item show monitor-warnings
14857 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14858 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
14859
14860 @item pmon @var{command}
14861 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
14862 @cindex send PMON command
14863 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
14864 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
14865 @end table
14866
14867 @node OpenRISC 1000
14868 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
14869 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
14870
14871 @cindex or1k boards
14872 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
14873 about platform and commands.
14874
14875 @table @code
14876
14877 @kindex target jtag
14878 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
14879
14880 Connects to remote JTAG server.
14881 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
14882 connected via parallel port to the board.
14883
14884 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
14885
14886 @kindex or1ksim
14887 @item or1ksim @var{command}
14888 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
14889 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
14890
14891 @kindex info or1k spr
14892 @item info or1k spr
14893 Displays spr groups.
14894
14895 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
14896 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
14897 Displays register names in selected group.
14898
14899 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
14900 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
14901 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
14902 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
14903 Shows information about specified spr register.
14904
14905 @kindex spr
14906 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
14907 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
14908 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
14909 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
14910 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
14911 @end table
14912
14913 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
14914 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
14915 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
14916 triggers can be set using:
14917 @table @code
14918 @item $LEA/$LDATA
14919 Load effective address/data
14920 @item $SEA/$SDATA
14921 Store effective address/data
14922 @item $AEA/$ADATA
14923 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
14924 @item $FETCH
14925 Fetch data
14926 @end table
14927
14928 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
14929 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
14930
14931 @code{htrace} commands:
14932 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
14933 @table @code
14934 @kindex hwatch
14935 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
14936 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
14937 or Data. For example:
14938
14939 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14940
14941 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14942
14943 @kindex htrace
14944 @item htrace info
14945 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
14946
14947 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
14948 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
14949
14950 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
14951 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
14952
14953 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
14954 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
14955
14956 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
14957 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
14958 triggered.
14959
14960 @item htrace enable
14961 @itemx htrace disable
14962 Enables/disables the HW trace.
14963
14964 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
14965 Clears currently recorded trace data.
14966
14967 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
14968 will be written there.
14969
14970 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
14971 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
14972
14973 @item htrace mode continuous
14974 Set continuous trace mode.
14975
14976 @item htrace mode suspend
14977 Set suspend trace mode.
14978
14979 @end table
14980
14981 @node PowerPC
14982 @subsection PowerPC
14983
14984 @table @code
14985 @kindex target dink32
14986 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
14987 DINK32 ROM monitor.
14988
14989 @kindex target ppcbug
14990 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
14991 @kindex target ppcbug1
14992 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
14993 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
14994
14995 @kindex target sds
14996 @item target sds @var{dev}
14997 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
14998 @end table
14999
15000 @cindex SDS protocol
15001 The following commands specifi to the SDS protocol are supported
15002 by@value{GDBN}:
15003
15004 @table @code
15005 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
15006 @kindex set sdstimeout
15007 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
15008 default is 2 seconds.
15009
15010 @item show sdstimeout
15011 @kindex show sdstimeout
15012 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15013
15014 @item sds @var{command}
15015 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
15016 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15017 @end table
15018
15019
15020 @node PA
15021 @subsection HP PA Embedded
15022
15023 @table @code
15024
15025 @kindex target op50n
15026 @item target op50n @var{dev}
15027 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15028
15029 @kindex target w89k
15030 @item target w89k @var{dev}
15031 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15032
15033 @end table
15034
15035 @node SH
15036 @subsection Renesas SH
15037
15038 @table @code
15039
15040 @kindex target hms@r{, with Renesas SH}
15041 @item target hms @var{dev}
15042 A Renesas SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
15043 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
15044 the communications speed used.
15045
15046 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas SH}
15047 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
15048 E7000 emulator for Renesas SH.
15049
15050 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
15051 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
15052 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
15053 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
15054 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
15055
15056 @end table
15057
15058 @node Sparclet
15059 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15060
15061 @cindex Sparclet
15062
15063 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15064 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15065 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15066 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15067 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15068
15069 @table @code
15070 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
15071 @kindex remotetimeout
15072 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15073 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15074 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15075 @end table
15076
15077 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15078 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15079 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15080 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15081 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15082
15083 @smallexample
15084 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15085 @end smallexample
15086
15087 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15088
15089 @smallexample
15090 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15091 @end smallexample
15092
15093 @cindex running, on Sparclet
15094 Once you have set
15095 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15096 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15097 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15098
15099 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15100
15101 @smallexample
15102 (gdbslet)
15103 @end smallexample
15104
15105 @menu
15106 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15107 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15108 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15109 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15110 @end menu
15111
15112 @node Sparclet File
15113 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
15114
15115 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15116
15117 @smallexample
15118 (gdbslet) file prog
15119 @end smallexample
15120
15121 @need 1000
15122 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15123 @value{GDBN} locates
15124 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15125 path.
15126 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
15127 files will be searched as well.
15128 @value{GDBN} locates
15129 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15130 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
15131 If it fails
15132 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15133
15134 @smallexample
15135 prog: No such file or directory.
15136 @end smallexample
15137
15138 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15139 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15140 @code{target} command again.
15141
15142 @node Sparclet Connection
15143 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15144
15145 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15146 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15147
15148 @smallexample
15149 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15150 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15151 main () at ../prog.c:3
15152 @end smallexample
15153
15154 @need 750
15155 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15156
15157 @smallexample
15158 Connected to ttya.
15159 @end smallexample
15160
15161 @node Sparclet Download
15162 @subsubsection Sparclet download
15163
15164 @cindex download to Sparclet
15165 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15166 you can use the @value{GDBN}
15167 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15168 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15169 command.
15170 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15171 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
15172 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
15173 of each of the file's sections.
15174 For instance, if the program
15175 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
15176 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15177
15178 @smallexample
15179 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
15180 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
15181 @end smallexample
15182
15183 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
15184 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
15185 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
15186
15187 @node Sparclet Execution
15188 @subsubsection Running and debugging
15189
15190 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
15191 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
15192 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
15193 manual for the list of commands.
15194
15195 @smallexample
15196 (gdbslet) b main
15197 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
15198 (gdbslet) run
15199 Starting program: prog
15200 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
15201 3 char *symarg = 0;
15202 (gdbslet) step
15203 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
15204 (gdbslet)
15205 @end smallexample
15206
15207 @node Sparclite
15208 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
15209
15210 @table @code
15211
15212 @kindex target sparclite
15213 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
15214 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15215 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15216 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15217 remote protocol.
15218
15219 @end table
15220
15221 @node ST2000
15222 @subsection Tandem ST2000
15223
15224 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
15225 STDBUG protocol.
15226
15227 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
15228 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
15229
15230 @smallexample
15231 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
15232 @end smallexample
15233
15234 @noindent
15235 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
15236 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
15237 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
15238 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
15239 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
15240
15241 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
15242 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
15243 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
15244 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
15245 available on your host computer.
15246 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
15247 @c basically hearsay.
15248
15249 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
15250 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
15251 environment:
15252
15253 @table @code
15254 @item st2000 @var{command}
15255 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
15256 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
15257 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
15258 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
15259 manual for available commands.
15260
15261 @item connect
15262 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
15263 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
15264 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
15265 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
15266 @kbd{@key{RET} ~ .} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
15267 @kbd{@key{RET} ~ C-d} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
15268 @end table
15269
15270 @node Z8000
15271 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15272
15273 @cindex Z8000
15274 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15275 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15276
15277 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15278 a Z8000 simulator.
15279
15280 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15281 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15282 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15283 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15284
15285 @table @code
15286 @item target sim @var{args}
15287 @kindex sim
15288 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15289 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15290 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15291 @end table
15292
15293 @noindent
15294 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15295 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15296 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15297 to run your program, and so on.
15298
15299 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15300 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15301 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15302
15303 @table @code
15304
15305 @item cycles
15306 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15307
15308 @item insts
15309 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15310
15311 @item time
15312 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15313
15314 @end table
15315
15316 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15317 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15318 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15319 simulated clock ticks.
15320
15321 @node AVR
15322 @subsection Atmel AVR
15323 @cindex AVR
15324
15325 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15326 following AVR-specific commands:
15327
15328 @table @code
15329 @item info io_registers
15330 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15331 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15332 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15333 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15334 @end table
15335
15336 @node CRIS
15337 @subsection CRIS
15338 @cindex CRIS
15339
15340 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15341 following CRIS-specific commands:
15342
15343 @table @code
15344 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15345 @cindex CRIS version
15346 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15347 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15348 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15349
15350 @item show cris-version
15351 Show the current CRIS version.
15352
15353 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15354 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15355 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15356 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15357 @code{R59}.
15358
15359 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15360 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15361
15362 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15363 @cindex CRIS mode
15364 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15365 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15366 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15367
15368 @item show cris-mode
15369 Show the current CRIS mode.
15370 @end table
15371
15372 @node Super-H
15373 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15374 @cindex Super-H
15375
15376 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15377 commands:
15378
15379 @table @code
15380 @item regs
15381 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15382 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15383 @end table
15384
15385 @node WinCE
15386 @subsection Windows CE
15387 @cindex Windows CE
15388
15389 The following commands are available for Windows CE:
15390
15391 @table @code
15392 @item set remotedirectory @var{dir}
15393 @kindex set remotedirectory
15394 Tell @value{GDBN} to upload files from the named directory @var{dir}.
15395 The default is @file{/gdb}, i.e.@: the root directory on the current
15396 drive.
15397
15398 @item show remotedirectory
15399 @kindex show remotedirectory
15400 Show the current value of the upload directory.
15401
15402 @item set remoteupload @var{method}
15403 @kindex set remoteupload
15404 Set the method used to upload files to remote device. Valid values
15405 for @var{method} are @samp{always}, @samp{newer}, and @samp{never}.
15406 The default is @samp{newer}.
15407
15408 @item show remoteupload
15409 @kindex show remoteupload
15410 Show the current setting of the upload method.
15411
15412 @item set remoteaddhost
15413 @kindex set remoteaddhost
15414 Tell @value{GDBN} whether to add this host to the remote stub's
15415 arguments when you debug over a network.
15416
15417 @item show remoteaddhost
15418 @kindex show remoteaddhost
15419 Show whether to add this host to remote stub's arguments when
15420 debugging over a network.
15421 @end table
15422
15423
15424 @node Architectures
15425 @section Architectures
15426
15427 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15428 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15429
15430 @menu
15431 * i386::
15432 * A29K::
15433 * Alpha::
15434 * MIPS::
15435 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15436 @end menu
15437
15438 @node i386
15439 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific issues.
15440
15441 @table @code
15442 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15443 @kindex set struct-convention
15444 @cindex struct return convention
15445 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15446 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15447 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15448 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15449 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15450 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15451 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15452 be returned in a register.
15453
15454 @item show struct-convention
15455 @kindex show struct-convention
15456 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15457 from functions.
15458 @end table
15459
15460 @node A29K
15461 @subsection A29K
15462
15463 @table @code
15464
15465 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15466 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15467 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15468 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15469 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15470 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15471 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15472 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15473 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15474 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15475 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15476 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15477 hexadecimal.
15478
15479 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15480 @item show rstack_high_address
15481 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15482 processors.
15483
15484 @end table
15485
15486 @node Alpha
15487 @subsection Alpha
15488
15489 See the following section.
15490
15491 @node MIPS
15492 @subsection MIPS
15493
15494 @cindex stack on Alpha
15495 @cindex stack on MIPS
15496 @cindex Alpha stack
15497 @cindex MIPS stack
15498 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15499 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15500 find the beginning of a function.
15501
15502 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15503 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15504 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15505 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15506 commands:
15507
15508 @table @code
15509 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15510 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15511 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15512 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15513 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15514 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15515 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15516 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15517
15518 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15519 Display the current limit.
15520 @end table
15521
15522 @noindent
15523 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15524 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15525
15526 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15527 programs:
15528
15529 @table @code
15530 @item set mips saved-gpreg-size @var{size}
15531 @kindex set mips saved-gpreg-size
15532 @cindex MIPS GP register size on stack
15533 Set the size of MIPS general-purpose registers saved on the stack.
15534 The argument @var{size} can be one of the following:
15535
15536 @table @samp
15537 @item 32
15538 32-bit GP registers
15539 @item 64
15540 64-bit GP registers
15541 @item auto
15542 Use the target's default setting or autodetect the saved size from the
15543 information contained in the executable. This is the default
15544 @end table
15545
15546 @item show mips saved-gpreg-size
15547 @kindex show mips saved-gpreg-size
15548 Show the current size of MIPS GP registers on the stack.
15549
15550 @item set mips stack-arg-size @var{size}
15551 @kindex set mips stack-arg-size
15552 @cindex MIPS stack space for arguments
15553 Set the amount of stack space reserved for arguments to functions.
15554 The argument can be one of @code{"32"}, @code{"64"} or @code{"auto"}
15555 (the default).
15556
15557 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15558 @kindex set mips abi
15559 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15560 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15561 values of @var{arg} are:
15562
15563 @table @samp
15564 @item auto
15565 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15566 default).
15567 @item o32
15568 @item o64
15569 @item n32
15570 @item n64
15571 @item eabi32
15572 @item eabi64
15573 @item auto
15574 @end table
15575
15576 @item show mips abi
15577 @kindex show mips abi
15578 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15579
15580 @item set mipsfpu
15581 @itemx show mipsfpu
15582 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15583
15584 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15585 @kindex set mips mask-address
15586 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15587 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15588 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15589 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15590 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15591
15592 @item show mips mask-address
15593 @kindex show mips mask-address
15594 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15595 not.
15596
15597 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15598 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15599 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15600 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15601 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15602 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15603
15604 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15605 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15606 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15607
15608 @item set debug mips
15609 @kindex set debug mips
15610 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15611 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15612
15613 @item show debug mips
15614 @kindex show debug mips
15615 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15616 @end table
15617
15618
15619 @node HPPA
15620 @subsection HPPA
15621 @cindex HPPA support
15622
15623 When @value{GDBN} is debugging te HP PA architecture, it provides the
15624 following special commands:
15625
15626 @table @code
15627 @item set debug hppa
15628 @kindex set debug hppa
15629 THis command determines whether HPPA architecture specific debugging
15630 messages are to be displayed.
15631
15632 @item show debug hppa
15633 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15634
15635 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15636 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15637 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15638 given @var{address}.
15639
15640 @end table
15641
15642
15643 @node Controlling GDB
15644 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15645
15646 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15647 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15648 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
15649 described here.
15650
15651 @menu
15652 * Prompt:: Prompt
15653 * Editing:: Command editing
15654 * Command History:: Command history
15655 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15656 * Numbers:: Numbers
15657 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15658 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15659 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15660 @end menu
15661
15662 @node Prompt
15663 @section Prompt
15664
15665 @cindex prompt
15666
15667 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15668 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15669 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15670 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15671 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15672 which one you are talking to.
15673
15674 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15675 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15676 or a prompt that does not.
15677
15678 @table @code
15679 @kindex set prompt
15680 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15681 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15682
15683 @kindex show prompt
15684 @item show prompt
15685 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15686 @end table
15687
15688 @node Editing
15689 @section Command editing
15690 @cindex readline
15691 @cindex command line editing
15692
15693 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15694 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15695 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15696 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15697 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15698 debugging sessions.
15699
15700 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15701 command @code{set}.
15702
15703 @table @code
15704 @kindex set editing
15705 @cindex editing
15706 @item set editing
15707 @itemx set editing on
15708 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15709
15710 @item set editing off
15711 Disable command line editing.
15712
15713 @kindex show editing
15714 @item show editing
15715 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15716 @end table
15717
15718 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15719 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15720 encouraged to read that chapter.
15721
15722 @node Command History
15723 @section Command history
15724 @cindex command history
15725
15726 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15727 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15728 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15729 history facility.
15730
15731 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15732 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15733 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15734
15735 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15736 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }. This
15737 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15738 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15739 pressed on a line by itself.
15740
15741 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15742 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15743 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15744 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15745
15746 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15747 history.
15748
15749 @table @code
15750 @cindex history substitution
15751 @cindex history file
15752 @kindex set history filename
15753 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15754 @item set history filename @var{fname}
15755 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15756 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15757 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15758 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15759 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15760 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15761 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15762 is not set.
15763
15764 @cindex save command history
15765 @kindex set history save
15766 @item set history save
15767 @itemx set history save on
15768 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15769 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15770
15771 @item set history save off
15772 Stop recording command history in a file.
15773
15774 @cindex history size
15775 @kindex set history size
15776 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15777 @item set history size @var{size}
15778 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15779 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15780 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15781 @end table
15782
15783 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15784 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15785
15786 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15787 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15788 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15789 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15790 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15791 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15792 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15793 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15794
15795 The commands to control history expansion are:
15796
15797 @table @code
15798 @item set history expansion on
15799 @itemx set history expansion
15800 @kindex set history expansion
15801 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15802
15803 @item set history expansion off
15804 Disable history expansion.
15805
15806 @c @group
15807 @kindex show history
15808 @item show history
15809 @itemx show history filename
15810 @itemx show history save
15811 @itemx show history size
15812 @itemx show history expansion
15813 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15814 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15815 @c @end group
15816 @end table
15817
15818 @table @code
15819 @kindex show commands
15820 @cindex show last commands
15821 @cindex display command history
15822 @item show commands
15823 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15824
15825 @item show commands @var{n}
15826 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15827
15828 @item show commands +
15829 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15830 @end table
15831
15832 @node Screen Size
15833 @section Screen size
15834 @cindex size of screen
15835 @cindex pauses in output
15836
15837 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15838 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
15839 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
15840 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
15841 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
15842 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
15843 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
15844 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
15845
15846 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
15847 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
15848 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
15849 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
15850 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
15851 width} commands:
15852
15853 @table @code
15854 @kindex set height
15855 @kindex set width
15856 @kindex show width
15857 @kindex show height
15858 @item set height @var{lpp}
15859 @itemx show height
15860 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
15861 @itemx show width
15862 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
15863 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
15864 commands display the current settings.
15865
15866 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
15867 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
15868 file or to an editor buffer.
15869
15870 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
15871 from wrapping its output.
15872
15873 @item set pagination on
15874 @itemx set pagination off
15875 @kindex set pagination
15876 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
15877 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
15878
15879 @item show pagination
15880 @kindex show pagination
15881 Show the current pagination mode.
15882 @end table
15883
15884 @node Numbers
15885 @section Numbers
15886 @cindex number representation
15887 @cindex entering numbers
15888
15889 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
15890 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
15891 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
15892 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
15893 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
15894 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
15895 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
15896 both input and output with the commands described below.
15897
15898 @table @code
15899 @kindex set input-radix
15900 @item set input-radix @var{base}
15901 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
15902 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15903 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
15904 example, any of
15905
15906 @smallexample
15907 set input-radix 012
15908 set input-radix 10.
15909 set input-radix 0xa
15910 @end smallexample
15911
15912 @noindent
15913 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
15914 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
15915 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
15916 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
15917 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
15918 change the radix.
15919
15920 @kindex set output-radix
15921 @item set output-radix @var{base}
15922 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
15923 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15924 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
15925
15926 @kindex show input-radix
15927 @item show input-radix
15928 Display the current default base for numeric input.
15929
15930 @kindex show output-radix
15931 @item show output-radix
15932 Display the current default base for numeric display.
15933
15934 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
15935 @itemx show radix
15936 @kindex set radix
15937 @kindex show radix
15938 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
15939 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
15940 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
15941 default value of 10.
15942
15943 @end table
15944
15945 @node ABI
15946 @section Configuring the current ABI
15947
15948 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
15949 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
15950 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
15951 current ABI.
15952
15953 @cindex OS ABI
15954 @kindex set osabi
15955 @kindex show osabi
15956
15957 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
15958 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
15959 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
15960 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
15961 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
15962 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
15963 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
15964 platform provides.
15965
15966 @table @code
15967 @item show osabi
15968 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
15969
15970 @item set osabi
15971 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
15972
15973 @item set osabi @var{abi}
15974 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
15975 @end table
15976
15977 @cindex float promotion
15978
15979 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
15980 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
15981 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
15982 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
15983 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
15984 @code{double} and then passed.
15985
15986 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
15987 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
15988 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
15989
15990 @table @code
15991 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
15992 @item set coerce-float-to-double
15993 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
15994 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
15995 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
15996
15997 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
15998 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
15999 functions.
16000
16001 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
16002 @item show coerce-float-to-double
16003 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
16004 @end table
16005
16006 @kindex set cp-abi
16007 @kindex show cp-abi
16008 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
16009 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
16010 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
16011 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
16012 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
16013 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
16014 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
16015 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
16016 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
16017 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
16018 ``auto''.
16019
16020 @table @code
16021 @item show cp-abi
16022 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
16023
16024 @item set cp-abi
16025 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
16026
16027 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
16028 @itemx set cp-abi auto
16029 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
16030 @end table
16031
16032 @node Messages/Warnings
16033 @section Optional warnings and messages
16034
16035 @cindex verbose operation
16036 @cindex optional warnings
16037 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
16038 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
16039 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
16040 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
16041
16042 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
16043 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
16044 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
16045
16046 @table @code
16047 @kindex set verbose
16048 @item set verbose on
16049 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16050
16051 @item set verbose off
16052 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16053
16054 @kindex show verbose
16055 @item show verbose
16056 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
16057 @end table
16058
16059 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
16060 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
16061 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
16062 symbol files}).
16063
16064 @table @code
16065
16066 @kindex set complaints
16067 @item set complaints @var{limit}
16068 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16069 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16070 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16071 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16072
16073 @kindex show complaints
16074 @item show complaints
16075 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16076
16077 @end table
16078
16079 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16080 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16081 you try to run a program which is already running:
16082
16083 @smallexample
16084 (@value{GDBP}) run
16085 The program being debugged has been started already.
16086 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16087 @end smallexample
16088
16089 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16090 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16091
16092 @table @code
16093
16094 @kindex set confirm
16095 @cindex flinching
16096 @cindex confirmation
16097 @cindex stupid questions
16098 @item set confirm off
16099 Disables confirmation requests.
16100
16101 @item set confirm on
16102 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16103
16104 @kindex show confirm
16105 @item show confirm
16106 Displays state of confirmation requests.
16107
16108 @end table
16109
16110 @cindex command tracing
16111 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16112 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16113 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16114 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16115
16116 @table @code
16117 @kindex set trace-commands
16118 @cindex command scripts, debugging
16119 @item set trace-commands on
16120 Enable command tracing.
16121 @item set trace-commands off
16122 Disable command tracing.
16123 @item show trace-commands
16124 Display the current state of command tracing.
16125 @end table
16126
16127 @node Debugging Output
16128 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
16129 @cindex optional debugging messages
16130
16131 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16132 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16133 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16134 section documents those commands.
16135
16136 @table @code
16137 @kindex set exec-done-display
16138 @item set exec-done-display
16139 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16140 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16141 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16142 @kindex show exec-done-display
16143 @item show exec-done-display
16144 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16145 notification.
16146 @kindex set debug
16147 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
16148 @cindex architecture debugging info
16149 @item set debug arch
16150 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16151 @kindex show debug
16152 @item show debug arch
16153 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16154 @item set debug aix-thread
16155 @cindex AIX threads
16156 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16157 module.
16158 @item show debug aix-thread
16159 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16160 @item set debug event
16161 @cindex event debugging info
16162 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16163 default is off.
16164 @item show debug event
16165 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16166 info.
16167 @item set debug expression
16168 @cindex expression debugging info
16169 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16170 expression parsing. The default is off.
16171 @item show debug expression
16172 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16173 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16174 @item set debug frame
16175 @cindex frame debugging info
16176 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16177 default is off.
16178 @item show debug frame
16179 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16180 info.
16181 @item set debug infrun
16182 @cindex inferior debugging info
16183 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16184 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16185 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16186 @item show debug infrun
16187 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16188 @item set debug lin-lwp
16189 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16190 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16191 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16192 @item show debug lin-lwp
16193 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16194 @item set debug observer
16195 @cindex observer debugging info
16196 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16197 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
16198 @item show debug observer
16199 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
16200 @item set debug overload
16201 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
16202 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
16203 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
16204 is off.
16205 @item show debug overload
16206 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
16207 debugging info.
16208 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
16209 @cindex serial connections, debugging
16210 @cindex debug remote protocol
16211 @cindex remote protocol debugging
16212 @cindex display remote packets
16213 @item set debug remote
16214 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
16215 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
16216 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
16217 @item show debug remote
16218 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
16219 @item set debug serial
16220 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
16221 default is off.
16222 @item show debug serial
16223 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
16224 info.
16225 @item set debug solib-frv
16226 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
16227 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
16228 @item show debug solib-frv
16229 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
16230 messages.
16231 @item set debug target
16232 @cindex target debugging info
16233 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
16234 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
16235 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
16236 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
16237 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
16238 @item show debug target
16239 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
16240 info.
16241 @item set debugvarobj
16242 @cindex variable object debugging info
16243 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
16244 info. The default is off.
16245 @item show debugvarobj
16246 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
16247 debugging info.
16248 @end table
16249
16250 @node Sequences
16251 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
16252
16253 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
16254 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
16255 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
16256 files.
16257
16258 @menu
16259 * Define:: How to define your own commands
16260 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
16261 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
16262 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
16263 @end menu
16264
16265 @node Define
16266 @section User-defined commands
16267
16268 @cindex user-defined command
16269 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
16270 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
16271 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16272 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16273 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16274 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16275
16276 @smallexample
16277 define adder
16278 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16279 end
16280 @end smallexample
16281
16282 @noindent
16283 To execute the command use:
16284
16285 @smallexample
16286 adder 1 2 3
16287 @end smallexample
16288
16289 @noindent
16290 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16291 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16292 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16293 functions calls.
16294
16295 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16296 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16297 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16298 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16299
16300 @smallexample
16301 define adder
16302 if $argc == 2
16303 print $arg0 + $arg1
16304 end
16305 if $argc == 3
16306 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16307 end
16308 end
16309 @end smallexample
16310
16311 @table @code
16312
16313 @kindex define
16314 @item define @var{commandname}
16315 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16316 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16317
16318 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16319 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16320 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16321
16322 @kindex document
16323 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16324 @item document @var{commandname}
16325 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16326 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16327 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16328 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16329 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16330 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16331
16332 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16333 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16334 does not change the documentation.
16335
16336 @kindex dont-repeat
16337 @cindex don't repeat command
16338 @item dont-repeat
16339 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16340 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16341 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16342
16343 @kindex help user-defined
16344 @item help user-defined
16345 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16346 (if any) for each.
16347
16348 @kindex show user
16349 @item show user
16350 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16351 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16352 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16353 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16354
16355 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16356 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16357 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16358 @item show max-user-call-depth
16359 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16360 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16361 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
16362 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16363 @end table
16364
16365 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16366 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16367
16368 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16369 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16370 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16371
16372 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16373 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16374 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16375 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16376
16377 @node Hooks
16378 @section User-defined command hooks
16379 @cindex command hooks
16380 @cindex hooks, for commands
16381 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16382
16383 @kindex hook
16384 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16385 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16386 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16387 before that command.
16388
16389 @cindex hooks, post-command
16390 @kindex hookpost
16391 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16392 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16393 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16394 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16395 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16396
16397 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16398 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16399
16400 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16401 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16402
16403 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16404 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16405 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16406 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16407 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16408
16409 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16410 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16411 you could define:
16412
16413 @smallexample
16414 define hook-stop
16415 handle SIGALRM nopass
16416 end
16417
16418 define hook-run
16419 handle SIGALRM pass
16420 end
16421
16422 define hook-continue
16423 handle SIGLARM pass
16424 end
16425 @end smallexample
16426
16427 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
16428 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16429 you could define:
16430
16431 @smallexample
16432 define hook-echo
16433 echo <<<---
16434 end
16435
16436 define hookpost-echo
16437 echo --->>>\n
16438 end
16439
16440 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16441 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16442 (@value{GDBP})
16443
16444 @end smallexample
16445
16446 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16447 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16448 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16449 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16450 @c or not?
16451 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16452 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16453 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16454
16455 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16456 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16457
16458 @node Command Files
16459 @section Command files
16460
16461 @cindex command files
16462 @cindex scripting commands
16463 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16464 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16465 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16466 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16467 terminal.
16468
16469 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16470 command:
16471
16472 @table @code
16473 @kindex source
16474 @cindex execute commands from a file
16475 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16476 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16477 @end table
16478
16479 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16480 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16481 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16482 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16483 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16484
16485 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16486 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16487
16488 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16489 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16490 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16491
16492 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16493 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16494 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16495 when called from command files.
16496
16497 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16498 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16499 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16500 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16501 the next command.
16502
16503 @smallexample
16504 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16505 @end smallexample
16506
16507 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16508 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16509 would be directed to @file{log}.
16510
16511 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16512 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16513 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16514 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16515 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16516 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16517 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16518 conditionally, etc.
16519
16520 @table @code
16521 @kindex if
16522 @kindex else
16523 @item if
16524 @itemx else
16525 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16526 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16527 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16528 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16529 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16530 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16531 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16532
16533 @kindex while
16534 @item while
16535 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16536 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16537 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16538 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16539 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16540 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16541
16542 @kindex loop_break
16543 @item loop_break
16544 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16545 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16546 line.
16547
16548 @kindex loop_continue
16549 @item loop_continue
16550 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16551 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16552 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16553 the controlling expression.
16554
16555 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16556 @item end
16557 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16558 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16559 @end table
16560
16561
16562 @node Output
16563 @section Commands for controlled output
16564
16565 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16566 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16567 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16568 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16569 want.
16570
16571 @table @code
16572 @kindex echo
16573 @item echo @var{text}
16574 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16575 @c because it is not in ANSI.
16576 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16577 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16578 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16579 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16580 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16581 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16582 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16583 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16584 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16585
16586 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16587 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16588
16589 @smallexample
16590 echo This is some text\n\
16591 which is continued\n\
16592 onto several lines.\n
16593 @end smallexample
16594
16595 produces the same output as
16596
16597 @smallexample
16598 echo This is some text\n
16599 echo which is continued\n
16600 echo onto several lines.\n
16601 @end smallexample
16602
16603 @kindex output
16604 @item output @var{expression}
16605 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16606 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16607 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16608 on expressions.
16609
16610 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16611 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16612 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16613 formats}, for more information.
16614
16615 @kindex printf
16616 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16617 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
16618 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
16619 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
16620 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
16621 subroutine
16622 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
16623 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
16624 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
16625 @c supported.
16626
16627 @smallexample
16628 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16629 @end smallexample
16630
16631 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16632
16633 @smallexample
16634 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16635 @end smallexample
16636
16637 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
16638 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
16639 letter.
16640 @end table
16641
16642 @node Interpreters
16643 @chapter Command Interpreters
16644 @cindex command interpreters
16645
16646 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16647 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16648 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16649
16650 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16651 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16652 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16653 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16654
16655 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16656 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16657 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16658 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16659
16660 @table @code
16661 @item console
16662 @cindex console interpreter
16663 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16664 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16665 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16666
16667 @item mi
16668 @cindex mi interpreter
16669 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16670 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16671 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16672 Interface}.
16673
16674 @item mi2
16675 @cindex mi2 interpreter
16676 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16677
16678 @item mi1
16679 @cindex mi1 interpreter
16680 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16681
16682 @end table
16683
16684 @cindex invoke another interpreter
16685 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16686 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16687 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16688 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16689 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16690 the IDE inoperable!
16691
16692 @kindex interpreter-exec
16693 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16694 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16695 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16696 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
16697
16698 @smallexample
16699 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16700 @end smallexample
16701
16702 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16703 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16704
16705 @node TUI
16706 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16707 @cindex TUI
16708 @cindex Text User Interface
16709
16710 @menu
16711 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16712 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16713 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16714 * TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
16715 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16716 @end menu
16717
16718 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short, is a terminal
16719 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16720 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16721 commands in separate text windows.
16722
16723 The TUI is enabled by invoking @value{GDBN} using either
16724 @pindex gdbtui
16725 @samp{gdbtui} or @samp{gdb -tui}.
16726
16727 @node TUI Overview
16728 @section TUI overview
16729
16730 The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
16731 @value{GDBN} runs:
16732
16733 @itemize @bullet
16734 @item
16735 A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
16736 windows on the terminal.
16737
16738 @item
16739 A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
16740 the TUI.
16741 @end itemize
16742
16743 In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
16744 on the terminal:
16745
16746 @table @emph
16747 @item command
16748 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16749 prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16750 managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
16751 window is always visible.
16752
16753 @item source
16754 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16755 line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16756
16757 @item assembly
16758 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16759
16760 @item register
16761 This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
16762 a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
16763 changed are highlighted.
16764
16765 @end table
16766
16767 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16768 by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
16769 Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
16770 indicates the breakpoint type:
16771
16772 @table @code
16773 @item B
16774 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16775
16776 @item b
16777 Breakpoint which was never hit.
16778
16779 @item H
16780 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16781
16782 @item h
16783 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
16784
16785 @end table
16786
16787 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
16788
16789 @table @code
16790 @item +
16791 Breakpoint is enabled.
16792
16793 @item -
16794 Breakpoint is disabled.
16795
16796 @end table
16797
16798 The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
16799 and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
16800 changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
16801 These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
16802 layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
16803 The following layouts are available:
16804
16805 @itemize @bullet
16806 @item
16807 source
16808
16809 @item
16810 assembly
16811
16812 @item
16813 source and assembly
16814
16815 @item
16816 source and registers
16817
16818 @item
16819 assembly and registers
16820
16821 @end itemize
16822
16823 On top of the command window a status line gives various information
16824 concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
16825 updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
16826 are displayed:
16827
16828 @table @emph
16829 @item target
16830 Indicates the current gdb target
16831 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16832
16833 @item process
16834 Gives information about the current process or thread number.
16835 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
16836
16837 @item function
16838 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
16839 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
16840 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
16841 the string @code{??} is displayed.
16842
16843 @item line
16844 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
16845 When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
16846
16847 @item pc
16848 Indicates the current program counter address.
16849
16850 @end table
16851
16852 @node TUI Keys
16853 @section TUI Key Bindings
16854 @cindex TUI key bindings
16855
16856 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
16857 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
16858 They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
16859 directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
16860 a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
16861 @value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
16862 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
16863
16864 @table @kbd
16865 @kindex C-x C-a
16866 @item C-x C-a
16867 @kindex C-x a
16868 @itemx C-x a
16869 @kindex C-x A
16870 @itemx C-x A
16871 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
16872 the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
16873 its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
16874 mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
16875 The screen is then refreshed.
16876
16877 @kindex C-x 1
16878 @item C-x 1
16879 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
16880 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
16881 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
16882
16883 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
16884
16885 @kindex C-x 2
16886 @item C-x 2
16887 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
16888 layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
16889 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
16890 previous layout and the new one.
16891
16892 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
16893
16894 @kindex C-x o
16895 @item C-x o
16896 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
16897 (like scrolling and arrow keys) to the active window. This command
16898 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
16899
16900 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
16901
16902 @kindex C-x s
16903 @item C-x s
16904 Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
16905 (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
16906
16907 @end table
16908
16909 The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
16910
16911 @table @key
16912 @kindex PgUp
16913 @item PgUp
16914 Scroll the active window one page up.
16915
16916 @kindex PgDn
16917 @item PgDn
16918 Scroll the active window one page down.
16919
16920 @kindex Up
16921 @item Up
16922 Scroll the active window one line up.
16923
16924 @kindex Down
16925 @item Down
16926 Scroll the active window one line down.
16927
16928 @kindex Left
16929 @item Left
16930 Scroll the active window one column left.
16931
16932 @kindex Right
16933 @item Right
16934 Scroll the active window one column right.
16935
16936 @kindex C-L
16937 @item C-L
16938 Refresh the screen.
16939
16940 @end table
16941
16942 In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
16943 for scrolling. This means they are available for readline when the
16944 active window is the command window. When the command window
16945 does not have the focus, it is necessary to use other readline
16946 key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b} and @kbd{C-f}.
16947
16948 @node TUI Single Key Mode
16949 @section TUI Single Key Mode
16950 @cindex TUI single key mode
16951
16952 The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
16953 key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
16954 some gdb commands.
16955
16956 @table @kbd
16957 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16958 @item c
16959 continue
16960
16961 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16962 @item d
16963 down
16964
16965 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16966 @item f
16967 finish
16968
16969 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16970 @item n
16971 next
16972
16973 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16974 @item q
16975 exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
16976
16977 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16978 @item r
16979 run
16980
16981 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16982 @item s
16983 step
16984
16985 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16986 @item u
16987 up
16988
16989 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16990 @item v
16991 info locals
16992
16993 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16994 @item w
16995 where
16996
16997 @end table
16998
16999 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
17000 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
17001 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
17002 with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
17003 @emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
17004 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
17005
17006
17007 @node TUI Commands
17008 @section TUI specific commands
17009 @cindex TUI commands
17010
17011 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
17012 These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
17013 the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
17014 is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
17015 in the TUI mode.
17016
17017 @table @code
17018 @item info win
17019 @kindex info win
17020 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
17021
17022 @item layout next
17023 @kindex layout
17024 Display the next layout.
17025
17026 @item layout prev
17027 Display the previous layout.
17028
17029 @item layout src
17030 Display the source window only.
17031
17032 @item layout asm
17033 Display the assembly window only.
17034
17035 @item layout split
17036 Display the source and assembly window.
17037
17038 @item layout regs
17039 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
17040
17041 @item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
17042 @kindex focus
17043 Set the focus to the named window.
17044 This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
17045 can be affected to another window.
17046
17047 @item refresh
17048 @kindex refresh
17049 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
17050
17051 @item tui reg float
17052 @kindex tui reg
17053 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
17054
17055 @item tui reg general
17056 Show the general registers in the register window.
17057
17058 @item tui reg next
17059 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
17060 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
17061 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
17062 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
17063
17064 @item tui reg system
17065 Show the system registers in the register window.
17066
17067 @item update
17068 @kindex update
17069 Update the source window and the current execution point.
17070
17071 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
17072 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
17073 @kindex winheight
17074 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
17075 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
17076 decrease it.
17077
17078 @item tabset
17079 @kindex tabset @var{nchars}
17080 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
17081
17082 @end table
17083
17084 @node TUI Configuration
17085 @section TUI configuration variables
17086 @cindex TUI configuration variables
17087
17088 The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
17089 appearance of windows on the terminal.
17090
17091 @table @code
17092 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
17093 @kindex set tui border-kind
17094 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
17095 The possible values are the following:
17096 @table @code
17097 @item space
17098 Use a space character to draw the border.
17099
17100 @item ascii
17101 Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
17102
17103 @item acs
17104 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
17105 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
17106
17107 @end table
17108
17109 @item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
17110 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
17111 Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
17112 The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
17113 @code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
17114
17115 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
17116 @kindex set tui border-mode
17117 Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
17118 The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
17119 @table @code
17120 @item normal
17121 Use normal attributes to display the border.
17122
17123 @item standout
17124 Use standout mode.
17125
17126 @item reverse
17127 Use reverse video mode.
17128
17129 @item half
17130 Use half bright mode.
17131
17132 @item half-standout
17133 Use half bright and standout mode.
17134
17135 @item bold
17136 Use extra bright or bold mode.
17137
17138 @item bold-standout
17139 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
17140
17141 @end table
17142
17143 @end table
17144
17145 @node Emacs
17146 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
17147
17148 @cindex Emacs
17149 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
17150 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
17151 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
17152 @value{GDBN}.
17153
17154 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
17155 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
17156 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
17157 created Emacs buffer.
17158 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
17159
17160 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
17161 things:
17162
17163 @itemize @bullet
17164 @item
17165 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
17166 @end itemize
17167
17168 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
17169 and output done by the program you are debugging.
17170
17171 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
17172 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
17173 in this way.
17174
17175 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
17176 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
17177 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
17178 stop.
17179
17180 @itemize @bullet
17181 @item
17182 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
17183 @end itemize
17184
17185 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
17186 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
17187 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
17188 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
17189 and the source.
17190
17191 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
17192 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
17193
17194 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
17195 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
17196 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
17197 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
17198 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
17199 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
17200 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
17201 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
17202 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
17203
17204 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
17205 line of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer and this serves as a default for
17206 the commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate
17207 on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
17208
17209 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
17210 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
17211 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
17212 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
17213 one you want.
17214
17215 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
17216 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
17217
17218 @table @kbd
17219 @item C-h m
17220 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
17221
17222 @item C-c C-s
17223 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
17224 update the display window to show the current file and location.
17225
17226 @item C-c C-n
17227 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
17228 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
17229 to show the current file and location.
17230
17231 @item C-c C-i
17232 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
17233 display window accordingly.
17234
17235 @item C-c C-f
17236 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
17237 @code{finish} command.
17238
17239 @item C-c C-r
17240 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
17241 command.
17242
17243 @item C-c <
17244 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
17245 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
17246 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
17247
17248 @item C-c >
17249 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
17250 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
17251 @end table
17252
17253 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
17254 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
17255
17256 If you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, then Emacs displays a separate frame which
17257 shows a backtrace when the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer is current. Move
17258 point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it become the
17259 current frame and display the associated source in the source buffer.
17260 Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the selected frame become the
17261 current one.
17262
17263 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
17264 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
17265 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
17266 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
17267 frame.
17268
17269 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
17270 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
17271 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
17272 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
17273 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
17274 to correspond properly with the code.
17275
17276 The description given here is for GNU Emacs version 21.3 and a more
17277 detailed description of its interaction with @value{GDBN} is given in
17278 the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}).
17279
17280 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17281 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17282 @ignore
17283 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17284 @kindex Epoch
17285 @kindex inspect
17286
17287 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17288 called the @code{epoch}
17289 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17290 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17291 each value is printed in its own window.
17292 @end ignore
17293
17294
17295 @node GDB/MI
17296 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17297
17298 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17299
17300 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17301 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17302 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17303 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17304 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17305 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17306
17307 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17308 in the form of a reference manual.
17309
17310 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17311 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17312 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17313
17314 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17315
17316 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17317 This chapter uses the following notation:
17318
17319 @itemize @bullet
17320 @item
17321 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17322
17323 @item
17324 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17325 it may or may not be given.
17326
17327 @item
17328 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17329 may repeat zero or more times.
17330
17331 @item
17332 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17333 may repeat one or more times.
17334
17335 @item
17336 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17337 @end itemize
17338
17339 @ignore
17340 @heading Dependencies
17341 @end ignore
17342
17343 @menu
17344 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17345 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17346 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17347 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17348 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17349 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17350 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17351 * GDB/MI Program Context::
17352 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17353 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
17354 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17355 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17356 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17357 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17358 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17359 * GDB/MI File Commands::
17360 @ignore
17361 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17362 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17363 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17364 @end ignore
17365 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17366 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17367 @end menu
17368
17369 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17370 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17371 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17372
17373 @menu
17374 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17375 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17376 @end menu
17377
17378 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17379 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17380
17381 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17382 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17383 @table @code
17384 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17385 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17386
17387 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17388 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17389 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17390
17391 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17392 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17393 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17394
17395 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17396 "any sequence of digits"
17397
17398 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17399 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17400
17401 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17402 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17403
17404 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17405 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17406
17407 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17408 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17409 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17410
17411 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17412 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17413
17414 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17415 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17416 @end table
17417
17418 @noindent
17419 Notes:
17420
17421 @itemize @bullet
17422 @item
17423 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17424 output is described below.
17425
17426 @item
17427 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17428 finishes.
17429
17430 @item
17431 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17432 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17433 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17434 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17435 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17436 @end itemize
17437
17438 Pragmatics:
17439
17440 @itemize @bullet
17441 @item
17442 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17443
17444 @item
17445 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17446 @end itemize
17447
17448 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17449 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17450
17451 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17452 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17453 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17454 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17455 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17456 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17457
17458 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17459 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17460 @var{token}.
17461
17462 @table @code
17463 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
17464 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17465
17466 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17467 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17468
17469 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17470 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17471
17472 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17473 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17474
17475 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17476 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17477
17478 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17479 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17480
17481 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17482 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17483
17484 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17485 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17486
17487 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17488 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17489
17490 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17491 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17492 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17493
17494 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
17495 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17496
17497 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17498 @code{ @var{string} }
17499
17500 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
17501 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17502
17503 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
17504 @code{@var{c-string}}
17505
17506 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17507 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17508
17509 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
17510 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17511 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17512
17513 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17514 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17515
17516 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17517 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17518
17519 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17520 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17521
17522 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17523 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17524
17525 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17526 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17527
17528 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17529 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
17530 @end table
17531
17532 @noindent
17533 Notes:
17534
17535 @itemize @bullet
17536 @item
17537 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17538
17539 @item
17540 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17541 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17542 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17543 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17544
17545 @item
17546 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17547 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17548 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17549 prefixed by @samp{+}.
17550
17551 @item
17552 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17553 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17554 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17555 @samp{*}.
17556
17557 @item
17558 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17559 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17560 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17561 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17562
17563 @item
17564 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17565 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17566 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17567 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17568
17569 @item
17570 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17571 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17572 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17573
17574 @item
17575 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17576 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17577 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17578 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17579
17580 @item
17581 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17582 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17583 @var{values}.
17584
17585
17586 @end itemize
17587
17588 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17589 details about the various output records.
17590
17591 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17592 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17593 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17594
17595 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17596 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17597
17598 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
17599 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
17600 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
17601 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
17602 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
17603 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
17604
17605 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
17606 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
17607 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
17608
17609 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17610 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
17611 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
17612 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
17613
17614 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
17615 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
17616
17617 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
17618 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
17619 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
17620 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
17621 might change.
17622
17623 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
17624 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
17625 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
17626 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
17627
17628 @itemize @bullet
17629 @item
17630 New MI commands may be added.
17631
17632 @item
17633 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
17634
17635 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
17636 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
17637
17638 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
17639 @c resolve inconsistencies.
17640 @end itemize
17641
17642 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
17643 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
17644 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
17645 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
17646 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
17647
17648 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
17649 @c version?
17650
17651 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
17652 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
17653 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
17654 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. There is also the mailing list
17655 @email{dmi-discuss@@lists.freestandards.org}, hosted by the Free Standards
17656 Group, which has the aim of creating a a more general MI protocol
17657 called Debugger Machine Interface (DMI) that will become a standard
17658 for all debuggers, not just @value{GDBN}.
17659 @cindex mailing lists
17660
17661 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17662 @node GDB/MI Output Records
17663 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17664
17665 @menu
17666 * GDB/MI Result Records::
17667 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
17668 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17669 @end menu
17670
17671 @node GDB/MI Result Records
17672 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17673
17674 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17675 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17676 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17677 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17678
17679 @table @code
17680 @findex ^done
17681 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17682 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17683 values.
17684
17685 @item "^running"
17686 @findex ^running
17687 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17688 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17689 running.
17690
17691 @item "^connected"
17692 @findex ^connected
17693 GDB has connected to a remote target.
17694
17695 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17696 @findex ^error
17697 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17698 error message.
17699
17700 @item "^exit"
17701 @findex ^exit
17702 GDB has terminated.
17703
17704 @end table
17705
17706 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
17707 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17708
17709 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17710 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17711 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17712 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17713 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17714
17715 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17716 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17717 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17718 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17719 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17720
17721 @table @code
17722 @item "~" @var{string-output}
17723 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17724 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17725
17726 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
17727 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17728 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
17729 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
17730
17731 @item "&" @var{string-output}
17732 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17733 internals.
17734 @end table
17735
17736 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17737 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17738
17739 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17740 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17741 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17742 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17743 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17744 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17745
17746 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17747 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17748
17749 @table @code
17750 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17751 @end table
17752
17753 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
17754
17755 @table @code
17756 @item breakpoint-hit
17757 A breakpoint was reached.
17758 @item watchpoint-trigger
17759 A watchpoint was triggered.
17760 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
17761 A read watchpoint was triggered.
17762 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
17763 An access watchpoint was triggered.
17764 @item function-finished
17765 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17766 @item location-reached
17767 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17768 @item watchpoint-scope
17769 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
17770 @item end-stepping-range
17771 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
17772 similar CLI command was accomplished.
17773 @item exited-signalled
17774 The inferior exited because of a signal.
17775 @item exited
17776 The inferior exited.
17777 @item exited-normally
17778 The inferior exited normally.
17779 @item signal-received
17780 A signal was received by the inferior.
17781 @end table
17782
17783
17784 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17785 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
17786 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
17787 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
17788
17789 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
17790 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
17791 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
17792 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
17793
17794 Note the the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
17795 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
17796
17797 @subheading Setting a breakpoint
17798
17799 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
17800 information of the breakpoint.
17801
17802 @smallexample
17803 -> -break-insert main
17804 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
17805 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
17806 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
17807 <- (gdb)
17808 @end smallexample
17809
17810 @subheading Program Execution
17811
17812 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
17813 reason that execution stopped.
17814
17815 @smallexample
17816 -> -exec-run
17817 <- ^running
17818 <- (gdb)
17819 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
17820 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
17821 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
17822 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
17823 <- (gdb)
17824 -> -exec-continue
17825 <- ^running
17826 <- (gdb)
17827 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
17828 <- (gdb)
17829 @end smallexample
17830
17831 @subheading Quitting GDB
17832
17833 Quitting GDB just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
17834
17835 @smallexample
17836 -> (gdb)
17837 <- -gdb-exit
17838 <- ^exit
17839 @end smallexample
17840
17841 @subheading A Bad Command
17842
17843 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
17844
17845 @smallexample
17846 -> -rubbish
17847 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
17848 <- (gdb)
17849 @end smallexample
17850
17851
17852 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17853 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
17854 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
17855
17856 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
17857 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
17858
17859 @subheading Motivation
17860
17861 The motivation for this collection of commands.
17862
17863 @subheading Introduction
17864
17865 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
17866
17867 @subheading Commands
17868
17869 For each command in the block, the following is described:
17870
17871 @subsubheading Synopsis
17872
17873 @smallexample
17874 -command @var{args}@dots{}
17875 @end smallexample
17876
17877 @subsubheading Result
17878
17879 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17880
17881 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
17882
17883 @subsubheading Example
17884
17885 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
17886 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
17887
17888
17889 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17890 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
17891 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
17892
17893 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
17894 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
17895 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
17896 breakpoints.
17897
17898 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
17899 @findex -break-after
17900
17901 @subsubheading Synopsis
17902
17903 @smallexample
17904 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
17905 @end smallexample
17906
17907 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
17908 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
17909 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
17910 @samp{-break-list} command below.
17911
17912 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17913
17914 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
17915
17916 @subsubheading Example
17917
17918 @smallexample
17919 (gdb)
17920 -break-insert main
17921 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",
17922 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
17923 (gdb)
17924 -break-after 1 3
17925 ~
17926 ^done
17927 (gdb)
17928 -break-list
17929 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17930 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17931 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17932 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17933 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17934 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17935 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17936 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17937 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17938 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17939 (gdb)
17940 @end smallexample
17941
17942 @ignore
17943 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
17944 @findex -break-catch
17945
17946 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
17947 @findex -break-commands
17948 @end ignore
17949
17950
17951 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
17952 @findex -break-condition
17953
17954 @subsubheading Synopsis
17955
17956 @smallexample
17957 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
17958 @end smallexample
17959
17960 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
17961 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
17962 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
17963 command below).
17964
17965 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17966
17967 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
17968
17969 @subsubheading Example
17970
17971 @smallexample
17972 (gdb)
17973 -break-condition 1 1
17974 ^done
17975 (gdb)
17976 -break-list
17977 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17978 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17979 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17980 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17981 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17982 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17983 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17984 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17985 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17986 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17987 (gdb)
17988 @end smallexample
17989
17990 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
17991 @findex -break-delete
17992
17993 @subsubheading Synopsis
17994
17995 @smallexample
17996 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17997 @end smallexample
17998
17999 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
18000 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
18001
18002 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18003
18004 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
18005
18006 @subsubheading Example
18007
18008 @smallexample
18009 (gdb)
18010 -break-delete 1
18011 ^done
18012 (gdb)
18013 -break-list
18014 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18015 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18016 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18017 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18018 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18019 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18020 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18021 body=[]@}
18022 (gdb)
18023 @end smallexample
18024
18025 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
18026 @findex -break-disable
18027
18028 @subsubheading Synopsis
18029
18030 @smallexample
18031 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18032 @end smallexample
18033
18034 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
18035 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
18036
18037 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18038
18039 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
18040
18041 @subsubheading Example
18042
18043 @smallexample
18044 (gdb)
18045 -break-disable 2
18046 ^done
18047 (gdb)
18048 -break-list
18049 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18050 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18051 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18052 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18053 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18054 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18055 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18056 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
18057 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18058 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18059 (gdb)
18060 @end smallexample
18061
18062 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
18063 @findex -break-enable
18064
18065 @subsubheading Synopsis
18066
18067 @smallexample
18068 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18069 @end smallexample
18070
18071 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
18072
18073 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18074
18075 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
18076
18077 @subsubheading Example
18078
18079 @smallexample
18080 (gdb)
18081 -break-enable 2
18082 ^done
18083 (gdb)
18084 -break-list
18085 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18086 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18087 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18088 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18089 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18090 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18091 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18092 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18093 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18094 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18095 (gdb)
18096 @end smallexample
18097
18098 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
18099 @findex -break-info
18100
18101 @subsubheading Synopsis
18102
18103 @smallexample
18104 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
18105 @end smallexample
18106
18107 @c REDUNDANT???
18108 Get information about a single breakpoint.
18109
18110 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18111
18112 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
18113
18114 @subsubheading Example
18115 N.A.
18116
18117 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
18118 @findex -break-insert
18119
18120 @subsubheading Synopsis
18121
18122 @smallexample
18123 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
18124 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
18125 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
18126 @end smallexample
18127
18128 @noindent
18129 If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
18130
18131 @itemize @bullet
18132 @item function
18133 @c @item +offset
18134 @c @item -offset
18135 @c @item linenum
18136 @item filename:linenum
18137 @item filename:function
18138 @item *address
18139 @end itemize
18140
18141 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
18142
18143 @table @samp
18144 @item -t
18145 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
18146 @item -h
18147 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
18148 @item -c @var{condition}
18149 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
18150 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
18151 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
18152 @item -r
18153 Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
18154 given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
18155 expresson.
18156 @end table
18157
18158 @subsubheading Result
18159
18160 The result is in the form:
18161
18162 @smallexample
18163 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
18164 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
18165 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
18166 times="@var{times}"@}
18167 @end smallexample
18168
18169 @noindent
18170 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
18171 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
18172 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
18173 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
18174 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
18175 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
18176 which use the same output).
18177
18178 Note: this format is open to change.
18179 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
18180
18181 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18182
18183 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
18184 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
18185
18186 @subsubheading Example
18187
18188 @smallexample
18189 (gdb)
18190 -break-insert main
18191 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
18192 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
18193 (gdb)
18194 -break-insert -t foo
18195 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
18196 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
18197 (gdb)
18198 -break-list
18199 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18200 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18201 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18202 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18203 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18204 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18205 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18206 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18207 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
18208 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
18209 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
18210 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
18211 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
18212 (gdb)
18213 -break-insert -r foo.*
18214 ~int foo(int, int);
18215 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
18216 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
18217 (gdb)
18218 @end smallexample
18219
18220 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
18221 @findex -break-list
18222
18223 @subsubheading Synopsis
18224
18225 @smallexample
18226 -break-list
18227 @end smallexample
18228
18229 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
18230
18231 @table @samp
18232 @item Number
18233 number of the breakpoint
18234 @item Type
18235 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
18236 @item Disposition
18237 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
18238 or @samp{nokeep}
18239 @item Enabled
18240 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
18241 @item Address
18242 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
18243 @item What
18244 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
18245 name, line number
18246 @item Times
18247 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
18248 @end table
18249
18250 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
18251 @code{body} field is an empty list.
18252
18253 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18254
18255 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
18256
18257 @subsubheading Example
18258
18259 @smallexample
18260 (gdb)
18261 -break-list
18262 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18263 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18264 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18265 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18266 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18267 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18268 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18269 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18270 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
18271 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18272 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18273 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
18274 (gdb)
18275 @end smallexample
18276
18277 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
18278
18279 @smallexample
18280 (gdb)
18281 -break-list
18282 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18283 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18284 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18285 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18286 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18287 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18288 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18289 body=[]@}
18290 (gdb)
18291 @end smallexample
18292
18293 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
18294 @findex -break-watch
18295
18296 @subsubheading Synopsis
18297
18298 @smallexample
18299 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18300 @end smallexample
18301
18302 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18303 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e. a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18304 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18305 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e. it will
18306 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18307 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18308 i.e. it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18309 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting watchpoints}.
18310
18311 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18312 breakpoints inserted.
18313
18314 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18315
18316 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18317 @samp{rwatch}.
18318
18319 @subsubheading Example
18320
18321 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18322
18323 @smallexample
18324 (gdb)
18325 -break-watch x
18326 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18327 (gdb)
18328 -exec-continue
18329 ^running
18330 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18331 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18332 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18333 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18334 (gdb)
18335 @end smallexample
18336
18337 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18338 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18339 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18340
18341 @smallexample
18342 (gdb)
18343 -break-watch C
18344 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18345 (gdb)
18346 -exec-continue
18347 ^running
18348 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18349 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18350 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18351 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18352 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18353 (gdb)
18354 -exec-continue
18355 ^running
18356 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18357 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18358 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18359 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18360 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18361 (gdb)
18362 @end smallexample
18363
18364 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18365 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18366 deleted.
18367
18368 @smallexample
18369 (gdb)
18370 -break-watch C
18371 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18372 (gdb)
18373 -break-list
18374 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18375 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18376 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18377 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18378 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18379 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18380 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18381 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18382 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18383 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18384 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18385 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18386 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18387 (gdb)
18388 -exec-continue
18389 ^running
18390 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18391 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18392 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18393 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18394 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18395 (gdb)
18396 -break-list
18397 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18398 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18399 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18400 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18401 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18402 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18403 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18404 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18405 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18406 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18407 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18408 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18409 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18410 (gdb)
18411 -exec-continue
18412 ^running
18413 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18414 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18415 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18416 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18417 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18418 (gdb)
18419 -break-list
18420 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18421 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18422 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18423 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18424 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18425 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18426 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18427 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18428 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18429 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18430 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18431 times="1"@}]@}
18432 (gdb)
18433 @end smallexample
18434
18435 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18436 @node GDB/MI Program Context
18437 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18438
18439 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18440 @findex -exec-arguments
18441
18442
18443 @subsubheading Synopsis
18444
18445 @smallexample
18446 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18447 @end smallexample
18448
18449 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18450 @samp{-exec-run}.
18451
18452 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18453
18454 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18455
18456 @subsubheading Example
18457
18458 @c FIXME!
18459 Don't have one around.
18460
18461
18462 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18463 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18464
18465 @subsubheading Synopsis
18466
18467 @smallexample
18468 -exec-show-arguments
18469 @end smallexample
18470
18471 Print the arguments of the program.
18472
18473 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18474
18475 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18476
18477 @subsubheading Example
18478 N.A.
18479
18480
18481 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18482 @findex -environment-cd
18483
18484 @subsubheading Synopsis
18485
18486 @smallexample
18487 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18488 @end smallexample
18489
18490 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18491
18492 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18493
18494 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18495
18496 @subsubheading Example
18497
18498 @smallexample
18499 (gdb)
18500 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18501 ^done
18502 (gdb)
18503 @end smallexample
18504
18505
18506 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18507 @findex -environment-directory
18508
18509 @subsubheading Synopsis
18510
18511 @smallexample
18512 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18513 @end smallexample
18514
18515 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18516 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18517 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18518 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18519 occurs as normal.
18520 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18521 multiple directories in a single command
18522 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18523 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18524 If blanks are needed as
18525 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18526 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18527 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
18528 character must not be used
18529 in any directory name.
18530 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18531
18532 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18533
18534 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18535
18536 @subsubheading Example
18537
18538 @smallexample
18539 (gdb)
18540 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18541 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18542 (gdb)
18543 -environment-directory ""
18544 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18545 (gdb)
18546 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18547 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18548 (gdb)
18549 -environment-directory -r
18550 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18551 (gdb)
18552 @end smallexample
18553
18554
18555 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18556 @findex -environment-path
18557
18558 @subsubheading Synopsis
18559
18560 @smallexample
18561 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18562 @end smallexample
18563
18564 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18565 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18566 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18567 supplied in addition to the
18568 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18569 occurs as normal.
18570 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18571 multiple directories in a single command
18572 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18573 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18574 If blanks are needed as
18575 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18576 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18577 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
18578 character must not be used
18579 in any directory name.
18580 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18581
18582
18583 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18584
18585 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18586
18587 @subsubheading Example
18588
18589 @smallexample
18590 (gdb)
18591 -environment-path
18592 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18593 (gdb)
18594 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18595 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18596 (gdb)
18597 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18598 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18599 (gdb)
18600 @end smallexample
18601
18602
18603 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18604 @findex -environment-pwd
18605
18606 @subsubheading Synopsis
18607
18608 @smallexample
18609 -environment-pwd
18610 @end smallexample
18611
18612 Show the current working directory.
18613
18614 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18615
18616 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18617
18618 @subsubheading Example
18619
18620 @smallexample
18621 (gdb)
18622 -environment-pwd
18623 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18624 (gdb)
18625 @end smallexample
18626
18627 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18628 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
18629 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
18630
18631
18632 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
18633 @findex -thread-info
18634
18635 @subsubheading Synopsis
18636
18637 @smallexample
18638 -thread-info
18639 @end smallexample
18640
18641 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18642
18643 No equivalent.
18644
18645 @subsubheading Example
18646 N.A.
18647
18648
18649 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
18650 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
18651
18652 @subsubheading Synopsis
18653
18654 @smallexample
18655 -thread-list-all-threads
18656 @end smallexample
18657
18658 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18659
18660 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
18661
18662 @subsubheading Example
18663 N.A.
18664
18665
18666 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
18667 @findex -thread-list-ids
18668
18669 @subsubheading Synopsis
18670
18671 @smallexample
18672 -thread-list-ids
18673 @end smallexample
18674
18675 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
18676 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
18677
18678 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18679
18680 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
18681
18682 @subsubheading Example
18683
18684 No threads present, besides the main process:
18685
18686 @smallexample
18687 (gdb)
18688 -thread-list-ids
18689 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
18690 (gdb)
18691 @end smallexample
18692
18693
18694 Several threads:
18695
18696 @smallexample
18697 (gdb)
18698 -thread-list-ids
18699 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18700 number-of-threads="3"
18701 (gdb)
18702 @end smallexample
18703
18704
18705 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
18706 @findex -thread-select
18707
18708 @subsubheading Synopsis
18709
18710 @smallexample
18711 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
18712 @end smallexample
18713
18714 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
18715 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
18716
18717 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18718
18719 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
18720
18721 @subsubheading Example
18722
18723 @smallexample
18724 (gdb)
18725 -exec-next
18726 ^running
18727 (gdb)
18728 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
18729 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
18730 (gdb)
18731 -thread-list-ids
18732 ^done,
18733 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18734 number-of-threads="3"
18735 (gdb)
18736 -thread-select 3
18737 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
18738 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
18739 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
18740 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
18741 (gdb)
18742 @end smallexample
18743
18744 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18745 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
18746 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
18747
18748 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
18749 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently GDB only really executes
18750 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
18751 other cases.
18752
18753 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18754 @findex -exec-continue
18755
18756 @subsubheading Synopsis
18757
18758 @smallexample
18759 -exec-continue
18760 @end smallexample
18761
18762 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
18763 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
18764
18765 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18766
18767 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
18768
18769 @subsubheading Example
18770
18771 @smallexample
18772 -exec-continue
18773 ^running
18774 (gdb)
18775 @@Hello world
18776 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
18777 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="13"@}
18778 (gdb)
18779 @end smallexample
18780
18781
18782 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
18783 @findex -exec-finish
18784
18785 @subsubheading Synopsis
18786
18787 @smallexample
18788 -exec-finish
18789 @end smallexample
18790
18791 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
18792 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
18793
18794 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18795
18796 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
18797
18798 @subsubheading Example
18799
18800 Function returning @code{void}.
18801
18802 @smallexample
18803 -exec-finish
18804 ^running
18805 (gdb)
18806 @@hello from foo
18807 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18808 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
18809 (gdb)
18810 @end smallexample
18811
18812 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
18813 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
18814 value itself.
18815
18816 @smallexample
18817 -exec-finish
18818 ^running
18819 (gdb)
18820 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
18821 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
18822 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
18823 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
18824 (gdb)
18825 @end smallexample
18826
18827
18828 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
18829 @findex -exec-interrupt
18830
18831 @subsubheading Synopsis
18832
18833 @smallexample
18834 -exec-interrupt
18835 @end smallexample
18836
18837 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
18838 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
18839 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
18840 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
18841 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
18842
18843 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18844
18845 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
18846
18847 @subsubheading Example
18848
18849 @smallexample
18850 (gdb)
18851 111-exec-continue
18852 111^running
18853
18854 (gdb)
18855 222-exec-interrupt
18856 222^done
18857 (gdb)
18858 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
18859 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18860 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
18861 (gdb)
18862
18863 (gdb)
18864 -exec-interrupt
18865 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
18866 (gdb)
18867 @end smallexample
18868
18869
18870 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
18871 @findex -exec-next
18872
18873 @subsubheading Synopsis
18874
18875 @smallexample
18876 -exec-next
18877 @end smallexample
18878
18879 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18880 of the next source line is reached.
18881
18882 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18883
18884 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
18885
18886 @subsubheading Example
18887
18888 @smallexample
18889 -exec-next
18890 ^running
18891 (gdb)
18892 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
18893 (gdb)
18894 @end smallexample
18895
18896
18897 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
18898 @findex -exec-next-instruction
18899
18900 @subsubheading Synopsis
18901
18902 @smallexample
18903 -exec-next-instruction
18904 @end smallexample
18905
18906 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
18907 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
18908 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
18909 printed as well.
18910
18911 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18912
18913 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
18914
18915 @subsubheading Example
18916
18917 @smallexample
18918 (gdb)
18919 -exec-next-instruction
18920 ^running
18921
18922 (gdb)
18923 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18924 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
18925 (gdb)
18926 @end smallexample
18927
18928
18929 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
18930 @findex -exec-return
18931
18932 @subsubheading Synopsis
18933
18934 @smallexample
18935 -exec-return
18936 @end smallexample
18937
18938 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
18939 Displays the new current frame.
18940
18941 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18942
18943 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
18944
18945 @subsubheading Example
18946
18947 @smallexample
18948 (gdb)
18949 200-break-insert callee4
18950 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
18951 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18952 (gdb)
18953 000-exec-run
18954 000^running
18955 (gdb)
18956 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18957 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18958 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18959 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18960 (gdb)
18961 205-break-delete
18962 205^done
18963 (gdb)
18964 111-exec-return
18965 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
18966 args=[@{name="strarg",
18967 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18968 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18969 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18970 (gdb)
18971 @end smallexample
18972
18973
18974 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
18975 @findex -exec-run
18976
18977 @subsubheading Synopsis
18978
18979 @smallexample
18980 -exec-run
18981 @end smallexample
18982
18983 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
18984 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
18985 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
18986 the program has exited exceptionally.
18987
18988 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18989
18990 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
18991
18992 @subsubheading Examples
18993
18994 @smallexample
18995 (gdb)
18996 -break-insert main
18997 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18998 (gdb)
18999 -exec-run
19000 ^running
19001 (gdb)
19002 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19003 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
19004 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19005 (gdb)
19006 @end smallexample
19007
19008 @noindent
19009 Program exited normally:
19010
19011 @smallexample
19012 (gdb)
19013 -exec-run
19014 ^running
19015 (gdb)
19016 x = 55
19017 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19018 (gdb)
19019 @end smallexample
19020
19021 @noindent
19022 Program exited exceptionally:
19023
19024 @smallexample
19025 (gdb)
19026 -exec-run
19027 ^running
19028 (gdb)
19029 x = 55
19030 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
19031 (gdb)
19032 @end smallexample
19033
19034 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
19035 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
19036
19037 @smallexample
19038 (gdb)
19039 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
19040 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
19041 @end smallexample
19042
19043
19044 @c @subheading -exec-signal
19045
19046
19047 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
19048 @findex -exec-step
19049
19050 @subsubheading Synopsis
19051
19052 @smallexample
19053 -exec-step
19054 @end smallexample
19055
19056 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19057 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
19058 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
19059 function.
19060
19061 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19062
19063 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
19064
19065 @subsubheading Example
19066
19067 Stepping into a function:
19068
19069 @smallexample
19070 -exec-step
19071 ^running
19072 (gdb)
19073 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19074 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
19075 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
19076 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
19077 (gdb)
19078 @end smallexample
19079
19080 Regular stepping:
19081
19082 @smallexample
19083 -exec-step
19084 ^running
19085 (gdb)
19086 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
19087 (gdb)
19088 @end smallexample
19089
19090
19091 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
19092 @findex -exec-step-instruction
19093
19094 @subsubheading Synopsis
19095
19096 @smallexample
19097 -exec-step-instruction
19098 @end smallexample
19099
19100 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
19101 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
19102 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
19103 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
19104 well.
19105
19106 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19107
19108 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
19109
19110 @subsubheading Example
19111
19112 @smallexample
19113 (gdb)
19114 -exec-step-instruction
19115 ^running
19116
19117 (gdb)
19118 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19119 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19120 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19121 (gdb)
19122 -exec-step-instruction
19123 ^running
19124
19125 (gdb)
19126 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19127 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19128 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19129 (gdb)
19130 @end smallexample
19131
19132
19133 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19134 @findex -exec-until
19135
19136 @subsubheading Synopsis
19137
19138 @smallexample
19139 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19140 @end smallexample
19141
19142 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
19143 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
19144 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
19145 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19146
19147 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19148
19149 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19150
19151 @subsubheading Example
19152
19153 @smallexample
19154 (gdb)
19155 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
19156 ^running
19157 (gdb)
19158 x = 55
19159 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19160 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19161 (gdb)
19162 @end smallexample
19163
19164 @ignore
19165 @subheading -file-clear
19166 Is this going away????
19167 @end ignore
19168
19169 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19170 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19171 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19172
19173
19174 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19175 @findex -stack-info-frame
19176
19177 @subsubheading Synopsis
19178
19179 @smallexample
19180 -stack-info-frame
19181 @end smallexample
19182
19183 Get info on the selected frame.
19184
19185 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19186
19187 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19188 (without arguments).
19189
19190 @subsubheading Example
19191
19192 @smallexample
19193 (gdb)
19194 -stack-info-frame
19195 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19196 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19197 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19198 (gdb)
19199 @end smallexample
19200
19201 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19202 @findex -stack-info-depth
19203
19204 @subsubheading Synopsis
19205
19206 @smallexample
19207 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19208 @end smallexample
19209
19210 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19211 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19212
19213 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19214
19215 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19216
19217 @subsubheading Example
19218
19219 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19220
19221 @smallexample
19222 (gdb)
19223 -stack-info-depth
19224 ^done,depth="12"
19225 (gdb)
19226 -stack-info-depth 4
19227 ^done,depth="4"
19228 (gdb)
19229 -stack-info-depth 12
19230 ^done,depth="12"
19231 (gdb)
19232 -stack-info-depth 11
19233 ^done,depth="11"
19234 (gdb)
19235 -stack-info-depth 13
19236 ^done,depth="12"
19237 (gdb)
19238 @end smallexample
19239
19240 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19241 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19242
19243 @subsubheading Synopsis
19244
19245 @smallexample
19246 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19247 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19248 @end smallexample
19249
19250 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19251 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19252 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
19253 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
19254 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
19255 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
19256 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
19257 which case only existing frames will be returned.
19258
19259 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19260 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19261 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19262
19263 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19264
19265 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19266 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19267 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19268
19269 @subsubheading Example
19270
19271 @smallexample
19272 (gdb)
19273 -stack-list-frames
19274 ^done,
19275 stack=[
19276 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19277 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19278 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19279 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19280 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19281 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19282 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19283 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19284 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19285 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19286 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19287 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19288 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19289 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19290 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19291 (gdb)
19292 -stack-list-arguments 0
19293 ^done,
19294 stack-args=[
19295 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19296 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19297 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19298 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19299 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19300 (gdb)
19301 -stack-list-arguments 1
19302 ^done,
19303 stack-args=[
19304 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19305 frame=@{level="1",
19306 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19307 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19308 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19309 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19310 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19311 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19312 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19313 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19314 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19315 (gdb)
19316 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19317 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19318 (gdb)
19319 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19320 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19321 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19322 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19323 (gdb)
19324 @end smallexample
19325
19326 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19327
19328
19329 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19330 @findex -stack-list-frames
19331
19332 @subsubheading Synopsis
19333
19334 @smallexample
19335 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19336 @end smallexample
19337
19338 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19339 following info:
19340
19341 @table @samp
19342 @item @var{level}
19343 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e. the innermost function.
19344 @item @var{addr}
19345 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19346 @item @var{func}
19347 Function name.
19348 @item @var{file}
19349 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19350 @item @var{line}
19351 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19352 @end table
19353
19354 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19355 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19356 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19357 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19358 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19359 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19360 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19361
19362 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19363
19364 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19365
19366 @subsubheading Example
19367
19368 Full stack backtrace:
19369
19370 @smallexample
19371 (gdb)
19372 -stack-list-frames
19373 ^done,stack=
19374 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19375 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19376 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19377 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19378 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19379 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19380 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19381 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19382 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19383 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19384 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19385 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19386 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19387 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19388 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19389 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19390 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19391 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19392 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19393 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19394 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19395 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19396 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19397 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19398 (gdb)
19399 @end smallexample
19400
19401 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19402
19403 @smallexample
19404 (gdb)
19405 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19406 ^done,stack=
19407 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19408 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19409 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19410 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19411 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19412 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19413 (gdb)
19414 @end smallexample
19415
19416 Show a single frame:
19417
19418 @smallexample
19419 (gdb)
19420 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19421 ^done,stack=
19422 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19423 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19424 (gdb)
19425 @end smallexample
19426
19427
19428 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19429 @findex -stack-list-locals
19430
19431 @subsubheading Synopsis
19432
19433 @smallexample
19434 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19435 @end smallexample
19436
19437 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19438 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19439 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19440 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19441 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19442 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19443 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19444 other data types when the the user wishes to explore their values in
19445 more detail.
19446
19447 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19448
19449 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19450
19451 @subsubheading Example
19452
19453 @smallexample
19454 (gdb)
19455 -stack-list-locals 0
19456 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19457 (gdb)
19458 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19459 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19460 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19461 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19462 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19463 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19464 (gdb)
19465 @end smallexample
19466
19467
19468 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19469 @findex -stack-select-frame
19470
19471 @subsubheading Synopsis
19472
19473 @smallexample
19474 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19475 @end smallexample
19476
19477 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19478 the stack.
19479
19480 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19481
19482 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19483 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19484
19485 @subsubheading Example
19486
19487 @smallexample
19488 (gdb)
19489 -stack-select-frame 2
19490 ^done
19491 (gdb)
19492 @end smallexample
19493
19494 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19495 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19496 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19497
19498
19499 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19500
19501 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19502 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19503 used by @code{Insight}.
19504
19505 The two main reasons for that are:
19506
19507 @enumerate 1
19508 @item
19509 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19510
19511 @item
19512 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19513 now).
19514 @end enumerate
19515
19516 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19517 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19518 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19519 hints about their use.
19520
19521 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19522 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19523 least, the following operations:
19524
19525 @itemize @bullet
19526 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19527 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19528 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19529 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19530 @end itemize
19531
19532 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19533
19534 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19535 The basic idea behind variable objects is the creation of a named object
19536 to represent a variable, an expression, a memory location or even a CPU
19537 register. For each object created, a set of operations is available for
19538 examining or changing its properties.
19539
19540 Furthermore, complex data types, such as C structures, are represented
19541 in a tree format. For instance, the @code{struct} type variable is the
19542 root and the children will represent the struct members. If a child
19543 is itself of a complex type, it will also have children of its own.
19544 Appropriate language differences are handled for C, C@t{++} and Java.
19545
19546 When returning the actual values of the objects, this facility allows
19547 for the individual selection of the display format used in the result
19548 creation. It can be chosen among: binary, decimal, hexadecimal, octal
19549 and natural. Natural refers to a default format automatically
19550 chosen based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
19551 for pointers, etc.).
19552
19553 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
19554 access this functionality:
19555
19556 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
19557 @item @strong{Operation}
19558 @tab @strong{Description}
19559
19560 @item @code{-var-create}
19561 @tab create a variable object
19562 @item @code{-var-delete}
19563 @tab delete the variable object and its children
19564 @item @code{-var-set-format}
19565 @tab set the display format of this variable
19566 @item @code{-var-show-format}
19567 @tab show the display format of this variable
19568 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
19569 @tab tells how many children this object has
19570 @item @code{-var-list-children}
19571 @tab return a list of the object's children
19572 @item @code{-var-info-type}
19573 @tab show the type of this variable object
19574 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
19575 @tab print what this variable object represents
19576 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
19577 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
19578 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
19579 @tab get the value of this variable
19580 @item @code{-var-assign}
19581 @tab set the value of this variable
19582 @item @code{-var-update}
19583 @tab update the variable and its children
19584 @end multitable
19585
19586 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
19587 how it can be used.
19588
19589 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
19590
19591 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
19592 @findex -var-create
19593
19594 @subsubheading Synopsis
19595
19596 @smallexample
19597 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
19598 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
19599 @end smallexample
19600
19601 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
19602 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
19603 register.
19604
19605 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
19606 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
19607 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
19608 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
19609 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
19610
19611 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
19612 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
19613 frame should be used.
19614
19615 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
19616 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
19617
19618 @itemize @bullet
19619 @item
19620 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
19621
19622 @item
19623 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
19624
19625 @item
19626 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
19627 @end itemize
19628
19629 @subsubheading Result
19630
19631 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
19632 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
19633 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
19634
19635 @smallexample
19636 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
19637 @end smallexample
19638
19639
19640 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
19641 @findex -var-delete
19642
19643 @subsubheading Synopsis
19644
19645 @smallexample
19646 -var-delete @var{name}
19647 @end smallexample
19648
19649 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
19650
19651 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
19652
19653
19654 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
19655 @findex -var-set-format
19656
19657 @subsubheading Synopsis
19658
19659 @smallexample
19660 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
19661 @end smallexample
19662
19663 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
19664 @var{format-spec}.
19665
19666 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
19667
19668 @smallexample
19669 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
19670 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
19671 @end smallexample
19672
19673
19674 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
19675 @findex -var-show-format
19676
19677 @subsubheading Synopsis
19678
19679 @smallexample
19680 -var-show-format @var{name}
19681 @end smallexample
19682
19683 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
19684
19685 @smallexample
19686 @var{format} @expansion{}
19687 @var{format-spec}
19688 @end smallexample
19689
19690
19691 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
19692 @findex -var-info-num-children
19693
19694 @subsubheading Synopsis
19695
19696 @smallexample
19697 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
19698 @end smallexample
19699
19700 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
19701
19702 @smallexample
19703 numchild=@var{n}
19704 @end smallexample
19705
19706
19707 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
19708 @findex -var-list-children
19709
19710 @subsubheading Synopsis
19711
19712 @smallexample
19713 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
19714 @end smallexample
19715 @anchor{-var-list-children}
19716
19717 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
19718 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
19719 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
19720 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
19721 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
19722 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
19723 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
19724 and unions.
19725
19726 @subsubheading Example
19727
19728 @smallexample
19729 (gdb)
19730 -var-list-children n
19731 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19732 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19733 (gdb)
19734 -var-list-children --all-values n
19735 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19736 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19737 @end smallexample
19738
19739
19740 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
19741 @findex -var-info-type
19742
19743 @subsubheading Synopsis
19744
19745 @smallexample
19746 -var-info-type @var{name}
19747 @end smallexample
19748
19749 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
19750 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
19751 @value{GDBN} CLI:
19752
19753 @smallexample
19754 type=@var{typename}
19755 @end smallexample
19756
19757
19758 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
19759 @findex -var-info-expression
19760
19761 @subsubheading Synopsis
19762
19763 @smallexample
19764 -var-info-expression @var{name}
19765 @end smallexample
19766
19767 Returns what is represented by the variable object @var{name}:
19768
19769 @smallexample
19770 lang=@var{lang-spec},exp=@var{expression}
19771 @end smallexample
19772
19773 @noindent
19774 where @var{lang-spec} is @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
19775
19776 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
19777 @findex -var-show-attributes
19778
19779 @subsubheading Synopsis
19780
19781 @smallexample
19782 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
19783 @end smallexample
19784
19785 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
19786
19787 @smallexample
19788 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
19789 @end smallexample
19790
19791 @noindent
19792 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
19793
19794 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
19795 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
19796
19797 @subsubheading Synopsis
19798
19799 @smallexample
19800 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
19801 @end smallexample
19802
19803 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
19804 object and returns its value as a string in the current format specified
19805 for the object:
19806
19807 @smallexample
19808 value=@var{value}
19809 @end smallexample
19810
19811 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
19812 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
19813
19814 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
19815 @findex -var-assign
19816
19817 @subsubheading Synopsis
19818
19819 @smallexample
19820 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
19821 @end smallexample
19822
19823 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
19824 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
19825 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
19826 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
19827
19828 @subsubheading Example
19829
19830 @smallexample
19831 (gdb)
19832 -var-assign var1 3
19833 ^done,value="3"
19834 (gdb)
19835 -var-update *
19836 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
19837 (gdb)
19838 @end smallexample
19839
19840 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
19841 @findex -var-update
19842
19843 @subsubheading Synopsis
19844
19845 @smallexample
19846 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
19847 @end smallexample
19848
19849 Update the value of the variable object @var{name} by evaluating its
19850 expression after fetching all the new values from memory or registers.
19851 A @samp{*} causes all existing variable objects to be updated. The
19852 option @var{print-values} determines whether names both and values, or
19853 just names are printed in the manner described for
19854 @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}).
19855
19856 @subsubheading Example
19857
19858 @smallexample
19859 (gdb)
19860 -var-assign var1 3
19861 ^done,value="3"
19862 (gdb)
19863 -var-update --all-values var1
19864 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
19865 type_changed="false"@}]
19866 (gdb)
19867 @end smallexample
19868
19869 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19870 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
19871 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
19872
19873 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
19874 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
19875 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
19876 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
19877
19878 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
19879 @c @subheading -data-assign
19880 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
19881 @c @subsubheading GDB command
19882 @c set variable
19883 @c @subsubheading Example
19884 @c N.A.
19885
19886 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
19887 @findex -data-disassemble
19888
19889 @subsubheading Synopsis
19890
19891 @smallexample
19892 -data-disassemble
19893 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
19894 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
19895 -- @var{mode}
19896 @end smallexample
19897
19898 @noindent
19899 Where:
19900
19901 @table @samp
19902 @item @var{start-addr}
19903 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
19904 @item @var{end-addr}
19905 is the end address
19906 @item @var{filename}
19907 is the name of the file to disassemble
19908 @item @var{linenum}
19909 is the line number to disassemble around
19910 @item @var{lines}
19911 is the the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
19912 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
19913 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
19914 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
19915 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
19916 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
19917 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
19918 are displayed.
19919 @item @var{mode}
19920 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
19921 disassembly).
19922 @end table
19923
19924 @subsubheading Result
19925
19926 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
19927
19928 @itemize @bullet
19929 @item Address
19930 @item Func-name
19931 @item Offset
19932 @item Instruction
19933 @end itemize
19934
19935 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
19936 directely by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e. it is not possible to adjust its format.
19937
19938 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19939
19940 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
19941
19942 @subsubheading Example
19943
19944 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
19945
19946 @smallexample
19947 (gdb)
19948 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
19949 ^done,
19950 asm_insns=[
19951 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19952 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19953 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19954 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19955 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
19956 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
19957 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
19958 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19959 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
19960 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
19961 (gdb)
19962 @end smallexample
19963
19964 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
19965 @code{main}.
19966
19967 @smallexample
19968 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
19969 ^done,asm_insns=[
19970 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19971 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
19972 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19973 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19974 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19975 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19976 [@dots{}]
19977 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
19978 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
19979 (gdb)
19980 @end smallexample
19981
19982 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
19983
19984 @smallexample
19985 (gdb)
19986 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
19987 ^done,asm_insns=[
19988 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19989 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
19990 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19991 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19992 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19993 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
19994 (gdb)
19995 @end smallexample
19996
19997 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
19998
19999 @smallexample
20000 (gdb)
20001 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
20002 ^done,asm_insns=[
20003 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
20004 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20005 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20006 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20007 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
20008 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
20009 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20010 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20011 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20012 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20013 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20014 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
20015 (gdb)
20016 @end smallexample
20017
20018
20019 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
20020 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
20021
20022 @subsubheading Synopsis
20023
20024 @smallexample
20025 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
20026 @end smallexample
20027
20028 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
20029 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
20030 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
20031
20032 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20033
20034 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
20035 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
20036 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
20037
20038 @subsubheading Example
20039
20040 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
20041 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
20042 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
20043 output.
20044
20045 @smallexample
20046 211-data-evaluate-expression A
20047 211^done,value="1"
20048 (gdb)
20049 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
20050 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
20051 (gdb)
20052 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
20053 411^done,value="4"
20054 (gdb)
20055 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
20056 511^done,value="4"
20057 (gdb)
20058 @end smallexample
20059
20060
20061 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
20062 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
20063
20064 @subsubheading Synopsis
20065
20066 @smallexample
20067 -data-list-changed-registers
20068 @end smallexample
20069
20070 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
20071
20072 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20073
20074 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
20075 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
20076
20077 @subsubheading Example
20078
20079 On a PPC MBX board:
20080
20081 @smallexample
20082 (gdb)
20083 -exec-continue
20084 ^running
20085
20086 (gdb)
20087 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
20088 args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="5"@}
20089 (gdb)
20090 -data-list-changed-registers
20091 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
20092 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
20093 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
20094 (gdb)
20095 @end smallexample
20096
20097
20098 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
20099 @findex -data-list-register-names
20100
20101 @subsubheading Synopsis
20102
20103 @smallexample
20104 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
20105 @end smallexample
20106
20107 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
20108 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
20109 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
20110 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
20111 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
20112 include empty register names.
20113
20114 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20115
20116 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
20117 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
20118 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
20119
20120 @subsubheading Example
20121
20122 For the PPC MBX board:
20123 @smallexample
20124 (gdb)
20125 -data-list-register-names
20126 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
20127 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
20128 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
20129 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
20130 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
20131 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
20132 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
20133 (gdb)
20134 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
20135 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
20136 (gdb)
20137 @end smallexample
20138
20139 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
20140 @findex -data-list-register-values
20141
20142 @subsubheading Synopsis
20143
20144 @smallexample
20145 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
20146 @end smallexample
20147
20148 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
20149 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20150 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20151 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20152
20153 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20154
20155 @table @code
20156 @item x
20157 Hexadecimal
20158 @item o
20159 Octal
20160 @item t
20161 Binary
20162 @item d
20163 Decimal
20164 @item r
20165 Raw
20166 @item N
20167 Natural
20168 @end table
20169
20170 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20171
20172 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
20173 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
20174
20175 @subsubheading Example
20176
20177 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
20178 don't appear in the actual output):
20179
20180 @smallexample
20181 (gdb)
20182 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
20183 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20184 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
20185 (gdb)
20186 -data-list-register-values x
20187 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
20188 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20189 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
20190 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
20191 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
20192 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
20193 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
20194 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
20195 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
20196 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20197 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20198 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20199 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20200 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20201 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20202 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20203 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20204 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20205 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20206 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20207 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20208 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20209 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20210 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20211 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20212 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20213 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20214 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20215 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20216 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20217 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20218 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20219 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20220 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20221 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20222 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20223 (gdb)
20224 @end smallexample
20225
20226
20227 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20228 @findex -data-read-memory
20229
20230 @subsubheading Synopsis
20231
20232 @smallexample
20233 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20234 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20235 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20236 @end smallexample
20237
20238 @noindent
20239 where:
20240
20241 @table @samp
20242 @item @var{address}
20243 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20244 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20245 quoted using the C convention.
20246
20247 @item @var{word-format}
20248 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20249 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20250 ,Output formats}).
20251
20252 @item @var{word-size}
20253 The size of each memory word in bytes.
20254
20255 @item @var{nr-rows}
20256 The number of rows in the output table.
20257
20258 @item @var{nr-cols}
20259 The number of columns in the output table.
20260
20261 @item @var{aschar}
20262 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20263 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20264 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20265 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20266
20267 @item @var{byte-offset}
20268 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20269 @end table
20270
20271 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20272 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20273 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20274 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20275 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20276 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20277 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20278 @samp{addr}.
20279
20280 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20281 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20282 @samp{prev-page}.
20283
20284 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20285
20286 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20287 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20288
20289 @subsubheading Example
20290
20291 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20292 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20293 word. Display each word in hex.
20294
20295 @smallexample
20296 (gdb)
20297 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
20298 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20299 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20300 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20301 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20302 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20303 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20304 (gdb)
20305 @end smallexample
20306
20307 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20308 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20309
20310 @smallexample
20311 (gdb)
20312 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
20313 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20314 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20315 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20316 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20317 (gdb)
20318 @end smallexample
20319
20320 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20321 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20322 used as the non-printable character.
20323
20324 @smallexample
20325 (gdb)
20326 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
20327 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20328 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20329 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20330 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20331 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20332 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20333 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20334 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20335 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20336 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20337 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20338 (gdb)
20339 @end smallexample
20340
20341 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20342 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20343 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20344
20345 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20346
20347 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20348
20349 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20350
20351 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20352
20353 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20354
20355 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20356
20357 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20358
20359 @c @subheading -trace-find
20360
20361 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20362
20363 @c @subheading -trace-info
20364
20365 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20366
20367 @c @subheading -trace-list
20368
20369 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20370
20371 @c @subheading -trace-save
20372
20373 @c @subheading -trace-start
20374
20375 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20376
20377
20378 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20379 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20380 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20381
20382
20383 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20384 @findex -symbol-info-address
20385
20386 @subsubheading Synopsis
20387
20388 @smallexample
20389 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20390 @end smallexample
20391
20392 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20393
20394 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20395
20396 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20397
20398 @subsubheading Example
20399 N.A.
20400
20401
20402 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20403 @findex -symbol-info-file
20404
20405 @subsubheading Synopsis
20406
20407 @smallexample
20408 -symbol-info-file
20409 @end smallexample
20410
20411 Show the file for the symbol.
20412
20413 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20414
20415 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20416 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
20417
20418 @subsubheading Example
20419 N.A.
20420
20421
20422 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20423 @findex -symbol-info-function
20424
20425 @subsubheading Synopsis
20426
20427 @smallexample
20428 -symbol-info-function
20429 @end smallexample
20430
20431 Show which function the symbol lives in.
20432
20433 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20434
20435 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20436
20437 @subsubheading Example
20438 N.A.
20439
20440
20441 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20442 @findex -symbol-info-line
20443
20444 @subsubheading Synopsis
20445
20446 @smallexample
20447 -symbol-info-line
20448 @end smallexample
20449
20450 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20451
20452 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20453
20454 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20455 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20456
20457 @subsubheading Example
20458 N.A.
20459
20460
20461 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20462 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
20463
20464 @subsubheading Synopsis
20465
20466 @smallexample
20467 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20468 @end smallexample
20469
20470 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20471
20472 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20473
20474 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20475
20476 @subsubheading Example
20477 N.A.
20478
20479
20480 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20481 @findex -symbol-list-functions
20482
20483 @subsubheading Synopsis
20484
20485 @smallexample
20486 -symbol-list-functions
20487 @end smallexample
20488
20489 List the functions in the executable.
20490
20491 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20492
20493 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20494 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20495
20496 @subsubheading Example
20497 N.A.
20498
20499
20500 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20501 @findex -symbol-list-lines
20502
20503 @subsubheading Synopsis
20504
20505 @smallexample
20506 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
20507 @end smallexample
20508
20509 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
20510 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
20511 ascending PC order.
20512
20513 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20514
20515 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
20516
20517 @subsubheading Example
20518 @smallexample
20519 (gdb)
20520 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
20521 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
20522 (gdb)
20523 @end smallexample
20524
20525
20526 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
20527 @findex -symbol-list-types
20528
20529 @subsubheading Synopsis
20530
20531 @smallexample
20532 -symbol-list-types
20533 @end smallexample
20534
20535 List all the type names.
20536
20537 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20538
20539 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
20540 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20541
20542 @subsubheading Example
20543 N.A.
20544
20545
20546 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
20547 @findex -symbol-list-variables
20548
20549 @subsubheading Synopsis
20550
20551 @smallexample
20552 -symbol-list-variables
20553 @end smallexample
20554
20555 List all the global and static variable names.
20556
20557 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20558
20559 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20560
20561 @subsubheading Example
20562 N.A.
20563
20564
20565 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
20566 @findex -symbol-locate
20567
20568 @subsubheading Synopsis
20569
20570 @smallexample
20571 -symbol-locate
20572 @end smallexample
20573
20574 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20575
20576 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
20577
20578 @subsubheading Example
20579 N.A.
20580
20581
20582 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
20583 @findex -symbol-type
20584
20585 @subsubheading Synopsis
20586
20587 @smallexample
20588 -symbol-type @var{variable}
20589 @end smallexample
20590
20591 Show type of @var{variable}.
20592
20593 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20594
20595 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
20596 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
20597
20598 @subsubheading Example
20599 N.A.
20600
20601
20602 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20603 @node GDB/MI File Commands
20604 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
20605
20606 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
20607 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
20608
20609 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
20610 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
20611
20612 @subsubheading Synopsis
20613
20614 @smallexample
20615 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
20616 @end smallexample
20617
20618 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
20619 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
20620 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
20621 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
20622 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
20623 notification.
20624
20625 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20626
20627 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
20628
20629 @subsubheading Example
20630
20631 @smallexample
20632 (gdb)
20633 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20634 ^done
20635 (gdb)
20636 @end smallexample
20637
20638
20639 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
20640 @findex -file-exec-file
20641
20642 @subsubheading Synopsis
20643
20644 @smallexample
20645 -file-exec-file @var{file}
20646 @end smallexample
20647
20648 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
20649 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
20650 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
20651 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
20652 notification.
20653
20654 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20655
20656 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
20657
20658 @subsubheading Example
20659
20660 @smallexample
20661 (gdb)
20662 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20663 ^done
20664 (gdb)
20665 @end smallexample
20666
20667
20668 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
20669 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
20670
20671 @subsubheading Synopsis
20672
20673 @smallexample
20674 -file-list-exec-sections
20675 @end smallexample
20676
20677 List the sections of the current executable file.
20678
20679 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20680
20681 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
20682 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
20683 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
20684
20685 @subsubheading Example
20686 N.A.
20687
20688
20689 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
20690 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
20691
20692 @subsubheading Synopsis
20693
20694 @smallexample
20695 -file-list-exec-source-file
20696 @end smallexample
20697
20698 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
20699 to the current source file for the current executable.
20700
20701 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20702
20703 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
20704
20705 @subsubheading Example
20706
20707 @smallexample
20708 (gdb)
20709 123-file-list-exec-source-file
20710 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
20711 (gdb)
20712 @end smallexample
20713
20714
20715 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
20716 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
20717
20718 @subsubheading Synopsis
20719
20720 @smallexample
20721 -file-list-exec-source-files
20722 @end smallexample
20723
20724 List the source files for the current executable.
20725
20726 It will always output the filename, but only when GDB can find the absolute
20727 file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
20728
20729 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20730
20731 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
20732 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
20733
20734 @subsubheading Example
20735 @smallexample
20736 (gdb)
20737 -file-list-exec-source-files
20738 ^done,files=[
20739 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
20740 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
20741 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
20742 (gdb)
20743 @end smallexample
20744
20745 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
20746 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
20747
20748 @subsubheading Synopsis
20749
20750 @smallexample
20751 -file-list-shared-libraries
20752 @end smallexample
20753
20754 List the shared libraries in the program.
20755
20756 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20757
20758 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
20759
20760 @subsubheading Example
20761 N.A.
20762
20763
20764 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
20765 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
20766
20767 @subsubheading Synopsis
20768
20769 @smallexample
20770 -file-list-symbol-files
20771 @end smallexample
20772
20773 List symbol files.
20774
20775 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20776
20777 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
20778
20779 @subsubheading Example
20780 N.A.
20781
20782
20783 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
20784 @findex -file-symbol-file
20785
20786 @subsubheading Synopsis
20787
20788 @smallexample
20789 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
20790 @end smallexample
20791
20792 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
20793 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
20794 produced, except for a completion notification.
20795
20796 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20797
20798 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
20799
20800 @subsubheading Example
20801
20802 @smallexample
20803 (gdb)
20804 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20805 ^done
20806 (gdb)
20807 @end smallexample
20808
20809 @ignore
20810 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20811 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
20812 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
20813
20814 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
20815
20816 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
20817
20818 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
20819
20820 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
20821
20822 @c @subheading -overlay-map
20823
20824 @c @subheading -overlay-off
20825
20826 @c @subheading -overlay-on
20827
20828 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
20829
20830 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20831 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
20832 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
20833
20834 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
20835
20836 @c @subheading -signal-handle
20837
20838 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
20839
20840 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
20841 @end ignore
20842
20843
20844 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20845 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
20846 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
20847
20848
20849 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
20850 @findex -target-attach
20851
20852 @subsubheading Synopsis
20853
20854 @smallexample
20855 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
20856 @end smallexample
20857
20858 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
20859
20860 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20861
20862 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
20863
20864 @subsubheading Example
20865 N.A.
20866
20867
20868 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
20869 @findex -target-compare-sections
20870
20871 @subsubheading Synopsis
20872
20873 @smallexample
20874 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
20875 @end smallexample
20876
20877 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
20878 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
20879
20880 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20881
20882 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
20883
20884 @subsubheading Example
20885 N.A.
20886
20887
20888 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
20889 @findex -target-detach
20890
20891 @subsubheading Synopsis
20892
20893 @smallexample
20894 -target-detach
20895 @end smallexample
20896
20897 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
20898 There's no output.
20899
20900 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20901
20902 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
20903
20904 @subsubheading Example
20905
20906 @smallexample
20907 (gdb)
20908 -target-detach
20909 ^done
20910 (gdb)
20911 @end smallexample
20912
20913
20914 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
20915 @findex -target-disconnect
20916
20917 @subsubheading Synopsis
20918
20919 @example
20920 -target-disconnect
20921 @end example
20922
20923 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
20924 generally not resumed.
20925
20926 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20927
20928 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
20929
20930 @subsubheading Example
20931
20932 @smallexample
20933 (gdb)
20934 -target-disconnect
20935 ^done
20936 (gdb)
20937 @end smallexample
20938
20939
20940 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
20941 @findex -target-download
20942
20943 @subsubheading Synopsis
20944
20945 @smallexample
20946 -target-download
20947 @end smallexample
20948
20949 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
20950 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
20951
20952 @table @samp
20953 @item section
20954 The name of the section.
20955 @item section-sent
20956 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
20957 @item section-size
20958 The size of the section.
20959 @item total-sent
20960 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
20961 @item total-size
20962 The size of the overall executable to download.
20963 @end table
20964
20965 @noindent
20966 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
20967 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
20968
20969 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
20970 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
20971
20972 @table @samp
20973 @item section
20974 The name of the section.
20975 @item section-size
20976 The size of the section.
20977 @item total-size
20978 The size of the overall executable to download.
20979 @end table
20980
20981 @noindent
20982 At the end, a summary is printed.
20983
20984 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20985
20986 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
20987
20988 @subsubheading Example
20989
20990 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
20991 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
20992
20993 @smallexample
20994 (gdb)
20995 -target-download
20996 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
20997 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
20998 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
20999 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
21000 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
21001 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
21002 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
21003 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
21004 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
21005 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
21006 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
21007 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
21008 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
21009 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
21010 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
21011 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
21012 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
21013 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
21014 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
21015 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
21016 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
21017 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
21018 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
21019 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
21020 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
21021 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
21022 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
21023 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21024 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21025 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
21026 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
21027 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
21028 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
21029 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
21030 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
21031 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
21032 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
21033 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
21034 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
21035 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
21036 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
21037 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
21038 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
21039 write-rate="429"
21040 (gdb)
21041 @end smallexample
21042
21043
21044 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
21045 @findex -target-exec-status
21046
21047 @subsubheading Synopsis
21048
21049 @smallexample
21050 -target-exec-status
21051 @end smallexample
21052
21053 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
21054 not, for instance).
21055
21056 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21057
21058 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21059
21060 @subsubheading Example
21061 N.A.
21062
21063
21064 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
21065 @findex -target-list-available-targets
21066
21067 @subsubheading Synopsis
21068
21069 @smallexample
21070 -target-list-available-targets
21071 @end smallexample
21072
21073 List the possible targets to connect to.
21074
21075 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21076
21077 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
21078
21079 @subsubheading Example
21080 N.A.
21081
21082
21083 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
21084 @findex -target-list-current-targets
21085
21086 @subsubheading Synopsis
21087
21088 @smallexample
21089 -target-list-current-targets
21090 @end smallexample
21091
21092 Describe the current target.
21093
21094 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21095
21096 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
21097 other things).
21098
21099 @subsubheading Example
21100 N.A.
21101
21102
21103 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
21104 @findex -target-list-parameters
21105
21106 @subsubheading Synopsis
21107
21108 @smallexample
21109 -target-list-parameters
21110 @end smallexample
21111
21112 @c ????
21113
21114 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21115
21116 No equivalent.
21117
21118 @subsubheading Example
21119 N.A.
21120
21121
21122 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
21123 @findex -target-select
21124
21125 @subsubheading Synopsis
21126
21127 @smallexample
21128 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
21129 @end smallexample
21130
21131 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
21132
21133 @table @samp
21134 @item @var{type}
21135 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
21136 @item @var{parameters}
21137 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
21138 Commands for managing targets}, for more details.
21139 @end table
21140
21141 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
21142 which the target program is, in the following form:
21143
21144 @smallexample
21145 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
21146 args=[@var{arg list}]
21147 @end smallexample
21148
21149 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21150
21151 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21152
21153 @subsubheading Example
21154
21155 @smallexample
21156 (gdb)
21157 -target-select async /dev/ttya
21158 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21159 (gdb)
21160 @end smallexample
21161
21162 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21163 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
21164 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
21165
21166 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
21167
21168 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
21169 @findex -gdb-exit
21170
21171 @subsubheading Synopsis
21172
21173 @smallexample
21174 -gdb-exit
21175 @end smallexample
21176
21177 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
21178
21179 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21180
21181 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
21182
21183 @subsubheading Example
21184
21185 @smallexample
21186 (gdb)
21187 -gdb-exit
21188 ^exit
21189 @end smallexample
21190
21191
21192 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
21193 @findex -exec-abort
21194
21195 @subsubheading Synopsis
21196
21197 @smallexample
21198 -exec-abort
21199 @end smallexample
21200
21201 Kill the inferior running program.
21202
21203 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21204
21205 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21206
21207 @subsubheading Example
21208 N.A.
21209
21210
21211 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21212 @findex -gdb-set
21213
21214 @subsubheading Synopsis
21215
21216 @smallexample
21217 -gdb-set
21218 @end smallexample
21219
21220 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
21221 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
21222
21223 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21224
21225 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
21226
21227 @subsubheading Example
21228
21229 @smallexample
21230 (gdb)
21231 -gdb-set $foo=3
21232 ^done
21233 (gdb)
21234 @end smallexample
21235
21236
21237 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
21238 @findex -gdb-show
21239
21240 @subsubheading Synopsis
21241
21242 @smallexample
21243 -gdb-show
21244 @end smallexample
21245
21246 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
21247
21248 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
21249
21250 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
21251
21252 @subsubheading Example
21253
21254 @smallexample
21255 (gdb)
21256 -gdb-show annotate
21257 ^done,value="0"
21258 (gdb)
21259 @end smallexample
21260
21261 @c @subheading -gdb-source
21262
21263
21264 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
21265 @findex -gdb-version
21266
21267 @subsubheading Synopsis
21268
21269 @smallexample
21270 -gdb-version
21271 @end smallexample
21272
21273 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
21274
21275 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21276
21277 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21278 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21279
21280 @subsubheading Example
21281
21282 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21283 @c box in TeX.
21284 @smallexample
21285 (gdb)
21286 -gdb-version
21287 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21288 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21289 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21290 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21291 ~ certain conditions.
21292 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21293 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21294 ~ details.
21295 ~This GDB was configured as
21296 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21297 ^done
21298 (gdb)
21299 @end smallexample
21300
21301 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21302 @findex -interpreter-exec
21303
21304 @subheading Synopsis
21305
21306 @smallexample
21307 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21308 @end smallexample
21309 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21310
21311 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21312
21313 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21314
21315 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21316
21317 @subheading Example
21318
21319 @smallexample
21320 (gdb)
21321 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
21322 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
21323 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
21324 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
21325 ^done
21326 (gdb)
21327 @end smallexample
21328
21329 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
21330 @findex -inferior-tty-set
21331
21332 @subheading Synopsis
21333
21334 @smallexample
21335 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21336 @end smallexample
21337
21338 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
21339
21340 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21341
21342 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
21343
21344 @subheading Example
21345
21346 @smallexample
21347 (gdb)
21348 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21349 ^done
21350 (gdb)
21351 @end smallexample
21352
21353 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
21354 @findex -inferior-tty-show
21355
21356 @subheading Synopsis
21357
21358 @smallexample
21359 -inferior-tty-show
21360 @end smallexample
21361
21362 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
21363
21364 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21365
21366 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
21367
21368 @subheading Example
21369
21370 @smallexample
21371 (gdb)
21372 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21373 ^done
21374 (gdb)
21375 -inferior-tty-show
21376 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
21377 (gdb)
21378 @end smallexample
21379
21380 @node Annotations
21381 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
21382
21383 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
21384 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
21385 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
21386 relatively high level.
21387
21388 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseeded by @sc{gdb/mi}
21389 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
21390
21391 @ignore
21392 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
21393 @end ignore
21394
21395 @menu
21396 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
21397 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
21398 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
21399 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
21400 * Annotations for Running::
21401 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
21402 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
21403 @end menu
21404
21405 @node Annotations Overview
21406 @section What is an Annotation?
21407 @cindex annotations
21408
21409 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
21410 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
21411 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
21412 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
21413 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
21414 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
21415 cannot contain newline characters.
21416
21417 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
21418 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
21419 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
21420 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
21421 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
21422 means those three characters as output.
21423
21424 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
21425 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
21426 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
21427 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
21428 is for no anntations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
21429 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
21430 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
21431 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
21432 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
21433
21434 @table @code
21435 @kindex set annotate
21436 @item set annotate @var{level}
21437 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
21438 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
21439
21440 @item show annotate
21441 @kindex show annotate
21442 Show the current annotation level.
21443 @end table
21444
21445 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
21446
21447 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
21448
21449 @smallexample
21450 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
21451 GNU gdb 6.0
21452 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21453 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
21454 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
21455 under certain conditions.
21456 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21457 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
21458 for details.
21459 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
21460
21461 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21462 (@value{GDBP})
21463 ^Z^Zprompt
21464 @kbd{quit}
21465
21466 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21467 $
21468 @end smallexample
21469
21470 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
21471 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
21472 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
21473 output from @value{GDBN}.
21474
21475 @node Prompting
21476 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
21477
21478 @cindex annotations for prompts
21479 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
21480 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
21481 over, etc.
21482
21483 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
21484 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
21485 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
21486 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
21487 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
21488 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
21489 features the following annotations:
21490
21491 @smallexample
21492 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21493 ^Z^Zprompt
21494 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21495 @end smallexample
21496
21497 The input types are
21498
21499 @table @code
21500 @findex pre-prompt
21501 @findex prompt
21502 @findex post-prompt
21503 @item prompt
21504 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
21505
21506 @findex pre-commands
21507 @findex commands
21508 @findex post-commands
21509 @item commands
21510 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
21511 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
21512
21513 @findex pre-overload-choice
21514 @findex overload-choice
21515 @findex post-overload-choice
21516 @item overload-choice
21517 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
21518
21519 @findex pre-query
21520 @findex query
21521 @findex post-query
21522 @item query
21523 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
21524
21525 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue
21526 @findex prompt-for-continue
21527 @findex post-prompt-for-continue
21528 @item prompt-for-continue
21529 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
21530 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
21531 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
21532 presence of annotations.
21533 @end table
21534
21535 @node Errors
21536 @section Errors
21537 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
21538
21539 @findex quit
21540 @smallexample
21541 ^Z^Zquit
21542 @end smallexample
21543
21544 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
21545
21546 @findex error
21547 @smallexample
21548 ^Z^Zerror
21549 @end smallexample
21550
21551 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
21552
21553 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
21554 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
21555 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
21556 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
21557 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
21558 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
21559 to the top level.
21560
21561 @findex error-begin
21562 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
21563
21564 @smallexample
21565 ^Z^Zerror-begin
21566 @end smallexample
21567
21568 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
21569 message.
21570
21571 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
21572 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
21573 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
21574
21575 @node Invalidation
21576 @section Invalidation Notices
21577
21578 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
21579 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
21580 changed.
21581
21582 @table @code
21583 @findex frames-invalid
21584 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
21585
21586 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
21587 have changed.
21588
21589 @findex breakpoints-invalid
21590 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
21591
21592 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
21593 deleted a breakpoint.
21594 @end table
21595
21596 @node Annotations for Running
21597 @section Running the Program
21598 @cindex annotations for running programs
21599
21600 @findex starting
21601 @findex stopping
21602 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
21603 @code{step} or @code{continue},
21604
21605 @smallexample
21606 ^Z^Zstarting
21607 @end smallexample
21608
21609 is output. When the program stops,
21610
21611 @smallexample
21612 ^Z^Zstopped
21613 @end smallexample
21614
21615 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
21616 annotations describe how the program stopped.
21617
21618 @table @code
21619 @findex exited
21620 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
21621 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
21622 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
21623
21624 @findex signalled
21625 @findex signal-name
21626 @findex signal-name-end
21627 @findex signal-string
21628 @findex signal-string-end
21629 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
21630 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
21631 annotation continues:
21632
21633 @smallexample
21634 @var{intro-text}
21635 ^Z^Zsignal-name
21636 @var{name}
21637 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
21638 @var{middle-text}
21639 ^Z^Zsignal-string
21640 @var{string}
21641 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
21642 @var{end-text}
21643 @end smallexample
21644
21645 @noindent
21646 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
21647 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
21648 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
21649 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
21650 user's benefit and have no particular format.
21651
21652 @findex signal
21653 @item ^Z^Zsignal
21654 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
21655 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
21656 terminated with it.
21657
21658 @findex breakpoint
21659 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
21660 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
21661
21662 @findex watchpoint
21663 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
21664 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
21665 @end table
21666
21667 @node Source Annotations
21668 @section Displaying Source
21669 @cindex annotations for source display
21670
21671 @findex source
21672 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
21673
21674 @smallexample
21675 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
21676 @end smallexample
21677
21678 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
21679 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
21680 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
21681 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
21682 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
21683 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
21684 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
21685 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
21686 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
21687 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
21688 depend on the language).
21689
21690 @node GDB Bugs
21691 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
21692 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
21693 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
21694
21695 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
21696
21697 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
21698 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
21699 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
21700 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
21701
21702 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
21703 information that enables us to fix the bug.
21704
21705 @menu
21706 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
21707 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
21708 @end menu
21709
21710 @node Bug Criteria
21711 @section Have you found a bug?
21712 @cindex bug criteria
21713
21714 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
21715
21716 @itemize @bullet
21717 @cindex fatal signal
21718 @cindex debugger crash
21719 @cindex crash of debugger
21720 @item
21721 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
21722 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
21723
21724 @cindex error on valid input
21725 @item
21726 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
21727 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
21728 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
21729
21730 @cindex invalid input
21731 @item
21732 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
21733 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
21734 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
21735 for traditional practice''.
21736
21737 @item
21738 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
21739 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
21740 @end itemize
21741
21742 @node Bug Reporting
21743 @section How to report bugs
21744 @cindex bug reports
21745 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
21746
21747 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
21748 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
21749 contact that organization first.
21750
21751 You can find contact information for many support companies and
21752 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
21753 distribution.
21754 @c should add a web page ref...
21755
21756 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
21757 @value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
21758 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
21759 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
21760 be used.
21761
21762 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
21763 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
21764 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
21765 @samp{bug-gdb}.
21766
21767 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
21768 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
21769 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
21770 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
21771 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
21772 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
21773 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
21774 bug reports to the mailing list.
21775
21776 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
21777 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
21778 fact or leave it out, state it!
21779
21780 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
21781 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
21782 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
21783 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
21784 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
21785 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
21786 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
21787 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
21788 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
21789
21790 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
21791 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
21792 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
21793 self-contained.
21794
21795 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
21796 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
21797 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
21798 bugs properly.
21799
21800 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
21801
21802 @itemize @bullet
21803 @item
21804 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
21805 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
21806 version}.
21807
21808 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
21809 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
21810
21811 @item
21812 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
21813 version number.
21814
21815 @item
21816 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
21817 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
21818
21819 @item
21820 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
21821 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
21822 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
21823 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
21824 compilers.
21825
21826 @item
21827 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
21828 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
21829 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
21830 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
21831
21832 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
21833 and then we might not encounter the bug.
21834
21835 @item
21836 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
21837 reproduce the bug.
21838
21839 @item
21840 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
21841 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
21842
21843 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
21844 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
21845 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
21846 a chance to make a mistake.
21847
21848 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
21849 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
21850 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
21851 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
21852 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
21853 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
21854 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
21855 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
21856
21857 @pindex script
21858 @cindex recording a session script
21859 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
21860 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
21861 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
21862 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
21863
21864 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
21865 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
21866
21867 @item
21868 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
21869 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
21870 it by context, not by line number.
21871
21872 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
21873 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
21874
21875 @end itemize
21876
21877 Here are some things that are not necessary:
21878
21879 @itemize @bullet
21880 @item
21881 A description of the envelope of the bug.
21882
21883 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
21884 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
21885 changes will not affect it.
21886
21887 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
21888 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
21889 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
21890 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
21891
21892 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
21893 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
21894 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
21895 less time, and so on.
21896
21897 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
21898 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
21899
21900 @item
21901 A patch for the bug.
21902
21903 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
21904 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
21905 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
21906 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
21907
21908 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
21909 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
21910 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
21911 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
21912
21913 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
21914 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
21915 help us to understand.
21916
21917 @item
21918 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
21919
21920 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
21921 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
21922 @end itemize
21923
21924 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
21925 @c and consists of the two following files:
21926 @c rluser.texinfo
21927 @c inc-hist.texinfo
21928 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
21929 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
21930 @include rluser.texi
21931 @include inc-hist.texinfo
21932
21933
21934 @node Formatting Documentation
21935 @appendix Formatting Documentation
21936
21937 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
21938 @cindex reference card
21939 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
21940 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
21941 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
21942 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
21943 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
21944 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
21945
21946 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
21947 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
21948
21949 @smallexample
21950 make refcard.dvi
21951 @end smallexample
21952
21953 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
21954 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
21955 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
21956 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
21957 your @sc{dvi} output program.
21958
21959 @cindex documentation
21960
21961 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
21962 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
21963 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
21964 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
21965 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
21966 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
21967
21968 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
21969 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
21970 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
21971 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
21972 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
21973 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
21974 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
21975 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
21976
21977 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
21978 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
21979 @code{makeinfo}.
21980
21981 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
21982 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
21983 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
21984
21985 @smallexample
21986 cd gdb
21987 make gdb.info
21988 @end smallexample
21989
21990 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
21991 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
21992 Texinfo definitions file.
21993
21994 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
21995 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
21996 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
21997 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
21998 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
21999 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
22000 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
22001
22002 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
22003 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
22004 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
22005 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
22006 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
22007 directory.
22008
22009 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
22010 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
22011 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
22012 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
22013
22014 @smallexample
22015 make gdb.dvi
22016 @end smallexample
22017
22018 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
22019
22020 @node Installing GDB
22021 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
22022 @cindex installation
22023
22024 @menu
22025 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22026 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @code{configure} script
22027 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22028 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
22029 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
22030 @end menu
22031
22032 @node Requirements
22033 @section Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22034 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
22035
22036 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
22037 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
22038
22039 @heading Tools/packages necessary for building @value{GDBN}
22040 @table @asis
22041 @item ISO C90 compiler
22042 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
22043 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
22044
22045 @end table
22046
22047 @heading Tools/packages optional for building @value{GDBN}
22048 @table @asis
22049 @item Expat
22050 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
22051 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
22052 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
22053 The @code{configure} script will search for this library in several
22054 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
22055 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
22056
22057 Expat is used currently only used to implement some remote-specific
22058 features.
22059
22060 @end table
22061
22062 @node Running Configure
22063 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @code{configure} script
22064 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
22065 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
22066 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
22067 build the @code{gdb} program.
22068 @iftex
22069 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
22070 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
22071 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
22072 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
22073 @end iftex
22074
22075 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
22076 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
22077 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
22078
22079 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
22080 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
22081
22082 @table @code
22083 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
22084 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
22085
22086 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
22087 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
22088
22089 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
22090 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
22091
22092 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
22093 @sc{gnu} include files
22094
22095 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
22096 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
22097
22098 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
22099 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
22100
22101 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
22102 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
22103
22104 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
22105 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
22106
22107 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
22108 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
22109 @end table
22110
22111 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
22112 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
22113 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
22114
22115 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
22116 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
22117 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
22118 argument.
22119
22120 For example:
22121
22122 @smallexample
22123 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22124 ./configure @var{host}
22125 make
22126 @end smallexample
22127
22128 @noindent
22129 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
22130 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
22131 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
22132 correct value by examining your system.)
22133
22134 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
22135 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
22136 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
22137 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
22138
22139 @need 750
22140 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
22141 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
22142 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
22143
22144 @smallexample
22145 sh configure @var{host}
22146 @end smallexample
22147
22148 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
22149 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
22150 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
22151 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
22152 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
22153
22154 You should run the @code{configure} script from the top directory in the
22155 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
22156 @code{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
22157 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
22158 if you run the first @code{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
22159 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
22160 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
22161 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
22162 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22163
22164 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
22165 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
22166 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
22167 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
22168 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
22169
22170 @node Separate Objdir
22171 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22172
22173 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
22174 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
22175 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
22176 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
22177 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
22178 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
22179 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
22180 program specified there.
22181
22182 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
22183 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
22184 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
22185 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
22186 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
22187 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
22188
22189 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
22190 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
22191
22192 @smallexample
22193 @group
22194 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22195 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
22196 cd ../gdb-sun4
22197 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
22198 make
22199 @end group
22200 @end smallexample
22201
22202 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
22203 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
22204 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
22205 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
22206 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
22207 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
22208
22209 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
22210 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
22211 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
22212 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
22213 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22214
22215 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
22216 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
22217 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
22218 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
22219 You specify a cross-debugging target by
22220 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
22221
22222 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
22223 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
22224 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
22225
22226 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
22227 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
22228 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
22229 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22230 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22231
22232 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22233 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
22234 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
22235 with each other.
22236
22237 @node Config Names
22238 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
22239
22240 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
22241 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
22242 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
22243 of information in the following pattern:
22244
22245 @smallexample
22246 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
22247 @end smallexample
22248
22249 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
22250 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
22251 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
22252
22253 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
22254 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
22255 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
22256 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
22257 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
22258 abbreviations---for example:
22259
22260 @smallexample
22261 % sh config.sub i386-linux
22262 i386-pc-linux-gnu
22263 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
22264 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
22265 % sh config.sub hp9k700
22266 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
22267 % sh config.sub sun4
22268 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
22269 % sh config.sub sun3
22270 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
22271 % sh config.sub i986v
22272 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
22273 @end smallexample
22274
22275 @noindent
22276 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
22277 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
22278
22279 @node Configure Options
22280 @section @code{configure} options
22281
22282 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
22283 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
22284 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
22285 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
22286
22287 @smallexample
22288 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
22289 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22290 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22291 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
22292 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
22293 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
22294 @var{host}
22295 @end smallexample
22296
22297 @noindent
22298 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
22299 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
22300 @samp{--}.
22301
22302 @table @code
22303 @item --help
22304 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
22305
22306 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
22307 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
22308 @file{@var{dir}}.
22309
22310 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
22311 Configure the source to install programs under directory
22312 @file{@var{dir}}.
22313
22314 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
22315 @need 2000
22316 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
22317 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
22318 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
22319 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
22320 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
22321 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
22322 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
22323 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
22324 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
22325 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
22326 @var{dirname}.
22327
22328 @item --norecursion
22329 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
22330 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
22331
22332 @item --target=@var{target}
22333 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
22334 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
22335 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
22336
22337 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
22338
22339 @item @var{host} @dots{}
22340 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
22341
22342 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
22343 @end table
22344
22345 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
22346 needed for special purposes only.
22347
22348 @node Maintenance Commands
22349 @appendix Maintenance Commands
22350 @cindex maintenance commands
22351 @cindex internal commands
22352
22353 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
22354 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
22355 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
22356 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
22357 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
22358
22359 @table @code
22360 @kindex maint agent
22361 @item maint agent @var{expression}
22362 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
22363 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
22364 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
22365
22366 @kindex maint info breakpoints
22367 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
22368 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
22369 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
22370 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
22371 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
22372 is shown:
22373
22374 @table @code
22375 @item breakpoint
22376 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
22377
22378 @item watchpoint
22379 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
22380
22381 @item longjmp
22382 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
22383 @code{longjmp} calls.
22384
22385 @item longjmp resume
22386 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
22387
22388 @item until
22389 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
22390
22391 @item finish
22392 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
22393
22394 @item shlib events
22395 Shared library events.
22396
22397 @end table
22398
22399 @kindex maint check-symtabs
22400 @item maint check-symtabs
22401 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
22402
22403 @kindex maint cplus first_component
22404 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
22405 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
22406
22407 @kindex maint cplus namespace
22408 @item maint cplus namespace
22409 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
22410
22411 @kindex maint demangle
22412 @item maint demangle @var{name}
22413 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C manled @var{name}.
22414
22415 @kindex maint deprecate
22416 @kindex maint undeprecate
22417 @cindex deprecated commands
22418 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
22419 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
22420 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
22421 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
22422 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
22423 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
22424 the replacement as part of the warning.
22425
22426 @kindex maint dump-me
22427 @item maint dump-me
22428 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
22429 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
22430 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
22431 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
22432
22433 @kindex maint internal-error
22434 @kindex maint internal-warning
22435 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22436 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22437 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
22438 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
22439 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
22440 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
22441 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
22442 @value{GDBN} session.
22443
22444 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
22445 used as the text of the error or warning message.
22446
22447 Here's an example of using @code{indernal-error}:
22448
22449 @smallexample
22450 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
22451 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
22452 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
22453 debugging may prove unreliable.
22454 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22455 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22456 (@value{GDBP})
22457 @end smallexample
22458
22459 @kindex maint packet
22460 @item maint packet @var{text}
22461 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
22462 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
22463 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
22464 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
22465 checksum.
22466
22467 @kindex maint print architecture
22468 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22469 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
22470 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
22471
22472 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
22473 @item maint print dummy-frames
22474 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
22475
22476 @smallexample
22477 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
22478 @dots{}
22479 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
22480 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
22481 58 return (a + b);
22482 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
22483 @dots{}
22484 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
22485 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
22486 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
22487 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
22488 (@value{GDBP})
22489 @end smallexample
22490
22491 Takes an optional file parameter.
22492
22493 @kindex maint print registers
22494 @kindex maint print raw-registers
22495 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
22496 @kindex maint print register-groups
22497 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22498 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22499 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22500 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22501 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
22502
22503 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
22504 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
22505 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
22506 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
22507 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
22508 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
22509
22510 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
22511 write the information.
22512
22513 @kindex maint print reggroups
22514 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22515 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
22516 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
22517 information.
22518
22519 The register groups info looks like this:
22520
22521 @smallexample
22522 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
22523 Group Type
22524 general user
22525 float user
22526 all user
22527 vector user
22528 system user
22529 save internal
22530 restore internal
22531 @end smallexample
22532
22533 @kindex flushregs
22534 @item flushregs
22535 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
22536
22537 @kindex maint print objfiles
22538 @cindex info for known object files
22539 @item maint print objfiles
22540 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
22541 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
22542 and symtabs.
22543
22544 @kindex maint print statistics
22545 @cindex bcache statistics
22546 @item maint print statistics
22547 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
22548 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
22549 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
22550 of minimal, partical, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
22551 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
22552 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
22553 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
22554 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
22555 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
22556 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
22557 lengths.
22558
22559 @kindex maint print type
22560 @cindex type chain of a data type
22561 @item maint print type @var{expr}
22562 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
22563 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
22564 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
22565 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
22566 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
22567
22568 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22569 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22570 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22571 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22572 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
22573
22574 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
22575 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
22576 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
22577 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
22578 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
22579 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
22580 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
22581 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
22582 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
22583
22584 @kindex maint set profile
22585 @kindex maint show profile
22586 @cindex profiling GDB
22587 @item maint set profile
22588 @itemx maint show profile
22589 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
22590
22591 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
22592 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
22593 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
22594 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
22595 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
22596 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
22597 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
22598
22599 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
22600 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
22601
22602 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
22603 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
22604 @item maint show-debug-regs
22605 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
22606 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
22607 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when GDB inserts or
22608 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
22609 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
22610
22611 @kindex maint space
22612 @cindex memory used by commands
22613 @item maint space
22614 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
22615 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
22616 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
22617 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
22618 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22619
22620 @kindex maint time
22621 @cindex time of command execution
22622 @item maint time
22623 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
22624 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
22625 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
22626 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
22627 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22628
22629 @kindex maint translate-address
22630 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
22631 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
22632 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
22633 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
22634 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
22635 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
22636 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
22637
22638 @end table
22639
22640 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
22641 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
22642
22643 @table @code
22644 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
22645 @kindex set watchdog
22646 @cindex watchdog timer
22647 @cindex timeout for commands
22648 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
22649 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
22650 reports and error and the command is aborted.
22651
22652 @item show watchdog
22653 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
22654 @end table
22655
22656 @node Remote Protocol
22657 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
22658
22659 @menu
22660 * Overview::
22661 * Packets::
22662 * Stop Reply Packets::
22663 * General Query Packets::
22664 * Register Packet Format::
22665 * Tracepoint Packets::
22666 * Interrupts::
22667 * Examples::
22668 * File-I/O remote protocol extension::
22669 * Memory map format::
22670 @end menu
22671
22672 @node Overview
22673 @section Overview
22674
22675 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
22676 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
22677 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
22678 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
22679
22680 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
22681 transmitted and received data respectfully.
22682
22683 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
22684 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
22685 @cindex remote serial protocol
22686 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
22687 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
22688 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
22689 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
22690
22691 @smallexample
22692 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22693 @end smallexample
22694 @noindent
22695
22696 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
22697 @noindent
22698 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
22699 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
22700 eight bit unsigned checksum).
22701
22702 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
22703 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
22704
22705 @smallexample
22706 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22707 @end smallexample
22708
22709 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
22710 @noindent
22711 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
22712 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
22713 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
22714
22715 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
22716 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
22717 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
22718 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
22719 retransmission):
22720
22721 @smallexample
22722 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22723 <- @code{+}
22724 @end smallexample
22725 @noindent
22726
22727 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
22728 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
22729 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
22730 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
22731
22732 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
22733 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
22734 exceptions).
22735
22736 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
22737 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
22738 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
22739 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
22740
22741 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
22742 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
22743 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
22744
22745 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
22746 @anchor{Binary Data}
22747 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
22748 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
22749 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
22750 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
22751 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
22752 binary data.
22753
22754 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
22755 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
22756 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
22757 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
22758 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
22759 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
22760 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
22761 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
22762 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
22763 (described next).
22764
22765 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
22766 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
22767 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
22768 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
22769 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
22770 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
22771 value greater than 126 should not be used.
22772
22773 So:
22774 @smallexample
22775 "@code{0* }"
22776 @end smallexample
22777 @noindent
22778 means the same as "0000".
22779
22780 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
22781 error number. That number is not well defined.
22782
22783 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
22784 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
22785 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
22786 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
22787 on that response.
22788
22789 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
22790 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
22791 optional.
22792
22793 @node Packets
22794 @section Packets
22795
22796 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
22797 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
22798 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for details about the File
22799 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
22800
22801 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
22802 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
22803 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
22804 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
22805 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
22806 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
22807 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
22808 @var{baz}. GDB does not transmit a space character between the
22809 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
22810 @var{baz}.
22811
22812 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
22813 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
22814
22815 Here are the packet descriptions.
22816
22817 @table @samp
22818
22819 @item !
22820 @cindex @samp{!} packet
22821 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
22822 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
22823 debugged.
22824
22825 Reply:
22826 @table @samp
22827 @item OK
22828 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
22829 @end table
22830
22831 @item ?
22832 @cindex @samp{?} packet
22833 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
22834 step and continue.
22835
22836 Reply:
22837 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22838
22839 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
22840 @cindex @samp{A} packet
22841 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
22842 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
22843 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
22844
22845 Reply:
22846 @table @samp
22847 @item OK
22848 The arguments were set.
22849 @item E @var{NN}
22850 An error occurred.
22851 @end table
22852
22853 @item b @var{baud}
22854 @cindex @samp{b} packet
22855 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
22856 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
22857
22858 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
22859 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
22860 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
22861
22862 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
22863 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
22864 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
22865 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
22866 of view, nothing actually happened.}
22867
22868 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
22869 @cindex @samp{B} packet
22870 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
22871 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
22872
22873 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
22874 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
22875
22876 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
22877 @cindex @samp{c} packet
22878 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
22879 resume at current address.
22880
22881 Reply:
22882 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22883
22884 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
22885 @cindex @samp{C} packet
22886 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
22887 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
22888
22889 Reply:
22890 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22891
22892 @item d
22893 @cindex @samp{d} packet
22894 Toggle debug flag.
22895
22896 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
22897 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
22898
22899 @item D
22900 @cindex @samp{D} packet
22901 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
22902 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
22903
22904 Reply:
22905 @table @samp
22906 @item OK
22907 for success
22908 @item E @var{NN}
22909 for an error
22910 @end table
22911
22912 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
22913 @cindex @samp{F} packet
22914 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
22915 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
22916 remote protocol extension}, for the specification.
22917
22918 @item g
22919 @anchor{read registers packet}
22920 @cindex @samp{g} packet
22921 Read general registers.
22922
22923 Reply:
22924 @table @samp
22925 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22926 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
22927 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
22928 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
22929 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros
22930 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The
22931 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
22932 @item E @var{NN}
22933 for an error.
22934 @end table
22935
22936 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
22937 @cindex @samp{G} packet
22938 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
22939 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
22940
22941 Reply:
22942 @table @samp
22943 @item OK
22944 for success
22945 @item E @var{NN}
22946 for an error
22947 @end table
22948
22949 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
22950 @cindex @samp{H} packet
22951 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
22952 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
22953 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
22954 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
22955 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
22956
22957 Reply:
22958 @table @samp
22959 @item OK
22960 for success
22961 @item E @var{NN}
22962 for an error
22963 @end table
22964
22965 @c FIXME: JTC:
22966 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
22967 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
22968 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
22969 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
22970 @c described. For example:
22971 @c
22972 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22973 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
22974 @c otherwise returns current registers.
22975 @c
22976 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22977 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
22978 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
22979
22980 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
22981 @anchor{cycle step packet}
22982 @cindex @samp{i} packet
22983 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
22984 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
22985 step starting at that address.
22986
22987 @item I
22988 @cindex @samp{I} packet
22989 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
22990 step packet}.
22991
22992 @item k
22993 @cindex @samp{k} packet
22994 Kill request.
22995
22996 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
22997 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
22998 thread?)}.
22999
23000 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
23001 @cindex @samp{m} packet
23002 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23003 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
23004
23005 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
23006 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
23007 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
23008 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
23009 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
23010 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
23011 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
23012 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
23013
23014 Reply:
23015 @table @samp
23016 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23017 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
23018 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
23019 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
23020 @item E @var{NN}
23021 @var{NN} is errno
23022 @end table
23023
23024 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23025 @cindex @samp{M} packet
23026 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23027 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
23028 hexadecimal number.
23029
23030 Reply:
23031 @table @samp
23032 @item OK
23033 for success
23034 @item E @var{NN}
23035 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
23036 written).
23037 @end table
23038
23039 @item p @var{n}
23040 @cindex @samp{p} packet
23041 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
23042 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
23043 register value is encoded.
23044
23045 Reply:
23046 @table @samp
23047 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23048 the register's value
23049 @item E @var{NN}
23050 for an error
23051 @item
23052 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
23053 @end table
23054
23055 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
23056 @anchor{write register packet}
23057 @cindex @samp{P} packet
23058 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
23059 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
23060 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
23061
23062 Reply:
23063 @table @samp
23064 @item OK
23065 for success
23066 @item E @var{NN}
23067 for an error
23068 @end table
23069
23070 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23071 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23072 @cindex @samp{q} packet
23073 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
23074 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
23075 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
23076
23077 @item r
23078 @cindex @samp{r} packet
23079 Reset the entire system.
23080
23081 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
23082
23083 @item R @var{XX}
23084 @cindex @samp{R} packet
23085 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
23086 This packet is only available in extended mode.
23087
23088 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
23089
23090 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23091 @cindex @samp{s} packet
23092 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
23093 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
23094
23095 Reply:
23096 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23097
23098 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23099 @anchor{step with signal packet}
23100 @cindex @samp{S} packet
23101 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
23102 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
23103
23104 Reply:
23105 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23106
23107 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
23108 @cindex @samp{t} packet
23109 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
23110 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
23111 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
23112
23113 @item T @var{XX}
23114 @cindex @samp{T} packet
23115 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
23116
23117 Reply:
23118 @table @samp
23119 @item OK
23120 thread is still alive
23121 @item E @var{NN}
23122 thread is dead
23123 @end table
23124
23125 @item v
23126 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
23127 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
23128
23129 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
23130 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
23131 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
23132 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
23133 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
23134 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
23135 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
23136 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
23137
23138 @table @samp
23139 @item c
23140 Continue.
23141 @item C @var{sig}
23142 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23143 @item s
23144 Step.
23145 @item S @var{sig}
23146 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23147 @end table
23148
23149 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
23150 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
23151
23152 Reply:
23153 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23154
23155 @item vCont?
23156 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
23157 Request a list of actions supporetd by the @samp{vCont} packet.
23158
23159 Reply:
23160 @table @samp
23161 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
23162 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
23163 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
23164 @item
23165 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
23166 @end table
23167
23168 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
23169 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
23170 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
23171 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
23172 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
23173 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory map
23174 format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
23175 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
23176 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23177 packet is received.
23178
23179 Reply:
23180 @table @samp
23181 @item OK
23182 for success
23183 @item E @var{NN}
23184 for an error
23185 @end table
23186
23187 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23188 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
23189 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
23190 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
23191 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
23192 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
23193 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
23194 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
23195 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
23196 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
23197 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
23198 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
23199
23200
23201 Reply:
23202 @table @samp
23203 @item OK
23204 for success
23205 @item E.memtype
23206 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
23207 @item E @var{NN}
23208 for an error
23209 @end table
23210
23211 @item vFlashDone
23212 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
23213 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
23214 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
23215 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
23216 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
23217 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23218 request is completed.
23219
23220 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23221 @anchor{X packet}
23222 @cindex @samp{X} packet
23223 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
23224 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
23225 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
23226
23227 Reply:
23228 @table @samp
23229 @item OK
23230 for success
23231 @item E @var{NN}
23232 for an error
23233 @end table
23234
23235 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23236 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23237 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
23238 @cindex @samp{z} packet
23239 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
23240 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
23241 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
23242 @var{length} bytes.
23243
23244 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
23245 separately.
23246
23247 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
23248 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
23249 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
23250 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
23251 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
23252 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
23253
23254 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23255 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23256 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
23257 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
23258 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
23259 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23260
23261 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
23262 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
23263 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
23264 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
23265 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
23266
23267 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
23268 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
23269 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
23270 target, is not defined.}
23271
23272 Reply:
23273 @table @samp
23274 @item OK
23275 success
23276 @item
23277 not supported
23278 @item E @var{NN}
23279 for an error
23280 @end table
23281
23282 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23283 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23284 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
23285 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
23286 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
23287 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23288
23289 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
23290 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
23291
23292 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
23293 movement.}
23294
23295 Reply:
23296 @table @samp
23297 @item OK
23298 success
23299 @item
23300 not supported
23301 @item E @var{NN}
23302 for an error
23303 @end table
23304
23305 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23306 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23307 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
23308 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
23309 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
23310
23311 Reply:
23312 @table @samp
23313 @item OK
23314 success
23315 @item
23316 not supported
23317 @item E @var{NN}
23318 for an error
23319 @end table
23320
23321 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23322 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23323 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
23324 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
23325 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
23326
23327 Reply:
23328 @table @samp
23329 @item OK
23330 success
23331 @item
23332 not supported
23333 @item E @var{NN}
23334 for an error
23335 @end table
23336
23337 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23338 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23339 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
23340 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
23341 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
23342
23343 Reply:
23344 @table @samp
23345 @item OK
23346 success
23347 @item
23348 not supported
23349 @item E @var{NN}
23350 for an error
23351 @end table
23352
23353 @end table
23354
23355 @node Stop Reply Packets
23356 @section Stop Reply Packets
23357 @cindex stop reply packets
23358
23359 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
23360 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
23361 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
23362 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
23363 number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal
23364 numbering conventions is used.
23365
23366 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
23367 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
23368 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
23369 components.
23370
23371 @table @samp
23372
23373 @item S @var{AA}
23374 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23375 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
23376 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
23377
23378 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
23379 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
23380 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23381 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
23382 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
23383 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
23384 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
23385 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
23386 @enumerate
23387 @item
23388 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
23389 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
23390 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
23391 two-digit hex number.
23392 @item
23393 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
23394 hex.
23395 @item
23396 If @var{n} is @samp{watch}, @samp{rwatch}, or @samp{awatch}, then the
23397 packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
23398 hex.
23399 @item
23400 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
23401 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
23402 future.
23403 @end enumerate
23404
23405 @item W @var{AA}
23406 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
23407 applicable to certain targets.
23408
23409 @item X @var{AA}
23410 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
23411
23412 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
23413 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
23414 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
23415 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
23416 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
23417
23418 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
23419 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
23420 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
23421 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
23422 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for a list of implemented
23423 system calls.
23424
23425 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
23426 this very system call.
23427
23428 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
23429 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
23430 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
23431 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
23432 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O remote
23433 protocol extension}, for more details.
23434
23435 @end table
23436
23437 @node General Query Packets
23438 @section General Query Packets
23439 @cindex remote query requests
23440
23441 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
23442 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
23443 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
23444 sending information to and from the stub.
23445
23446 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
23447 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
23448 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
23449 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
23450 conventions:
23451
23452 @itemize @bullet
23453 @item
23454 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
23455 @item
23456 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
23457 letter.
23458 @item
23459 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
23460 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
23461 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
23462 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
23463 @end itemize
23464
23465 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
23466 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
23467 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
23468 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
23469 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
23470 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
23471 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
23472 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
23473 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
23474 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
23475 packet.}.
23476
23477 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
23478 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
23479 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
23480 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
23481 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
23482
23483 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
23484
23485 @table @samp
23486
23487 @item qC
23488 @cindex current thread, remote request
23489 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
23490 Return the current thread id.
23491
23492 Reply:
23493 @table @samp
23494 @item QC @var{pid}
23495 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
23496 @item @r{(anything else)}
23497 Any other reply implies the old pid.
23498 @end table
23499
23500 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
23501 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
23502 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
23503 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
23504 Reply:
23505 @table @samp
23506 @item E @var{NN}
23507 An error (such as memory fault)
23508 @item C @var{crc32}
23509 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
23510 @end table
23511
23512 @item qfThreadInfo
23513 @itemx qsThreadInfo
23514 @cindex list active threads, remote request
23515 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
23516 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
23517 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
23518 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
23519 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
23520 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
23521 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
23522 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
23523
23524 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
23525
23526 Reply:
23527 @table @samp
23528 @item m @var{id}
23529 A single thread id
23530 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
23531 a comma-separated list of thread ids
23532 @item l
23533 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
23534 @end table
23535
23536 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
23537 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
23538 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
23539 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
23540 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
23541
23542 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
23543 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
23544 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
23545 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
23546 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
23547
23548 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
23549 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
23550
23551 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
23552 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
23553 information associated with the variable.)
23554
23555 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI specific encoding of the
23556 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
23557 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
23558 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
23559 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
23560 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
23561
23562 Reply:
23563 @table @samp
23564 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23565 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
23566 local storage requested.
23567
23568 @item E @var{nn}
23569 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23570
23571 @item
23572 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
23573 @end table
23574
23575 Use of this request packet is controlled by the @code{set remote
23576 get-thread-local-storage-address} command (@pxref{Remote
23577 configuration, set remote get-thread-local-storage-address}).
23578
23579 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
23580 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
23581 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
23582 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
23583 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
23584 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
23585 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
23586
23587 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
23588
23589 Reply:
23590 @table @samp
23591 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
23592 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
23593 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
23594 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
23595 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
23596 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
23597 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
23598 @end table
23599
23600 @item qOffsets
23601 @cindex section offsets, remote request
23602 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
23603 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
23604 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
23605 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
23606 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
23607
23608 Reply:
23609 @table @samp
23610 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy};Bss=@var{zzz}
23611 @end table
23612
23613 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
23614 @cindex thread information, remote request
23615 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
23616 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
23617 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
23618
23619 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
23620 (see below).
23621
23622 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
23623
23624 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
23625 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
23626 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
23627 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
23628 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
23629 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
23630 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
23631 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
23632 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
23633
23634 Reply:
23635 @table @samp
23636 @item OK
23637 A command response with no output.
23638 @item @var{OUTPUT}
23639 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
23640 @item E @var{NN}
23641 Indicate a badly formed request.
23642 @item
23643 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
23644 @end table
23645
23646 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
23647 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23648 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23649 packets.)
23650
23651 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
23652 @cindex supported packets, remote query
23653 @cindex features of the remote protocol
23654 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
23655 @anchor{qSupported}
23656 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
23657 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
23658 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
23659 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
23660 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
23661 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
23662 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
23663 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
23664 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
23665 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
23666 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
23667 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
23668 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
23669 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
23670
23671 Reply:
23672 @table @samp
23673 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
23674 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
23675 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
23676 possible forms).
23677 @item
23678 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
23679 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
23680 @end table
23681
23682 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
23683 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
23684 are:
23685
23686 @table @samp
23687 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
23688 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
23689 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
23690 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
23691 @item @var{name}+
23692 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
23693 need an associated value.
23694 @item @var{name}-
23695 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
23696 @item @var{name}?
23697 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
23698 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
23699 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
23700 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
23701 @end table
23702
23703 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
23704 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
23705 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
23706 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
23707 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
23708
23709 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
23710 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
23711 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
23712 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
23713 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
23714 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
23715 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
23716 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
23717 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
23718 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
23719 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
23720 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
23721 all the features it supports.
23722
23723 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
23724 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
23725
23726 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
23727 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
23728 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
23729 form response.
23730
23731 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
23732 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
23733 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
23734 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
23735
23736 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
23737 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
23738 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
23739 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
23740 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
23741
23742 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
23743
23744 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.2 0.2 0.2
23745 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
23746 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
23747 @item Feature Name
23748 @tab Value Required
23749 @tab Default
23750 @tab Probe Allowed
23751
23752 @item @samp{PacketSize}
23753 @tab Yes
23754 @tab @samp{-}
23755 @tab No
23756
23757 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
23758 @tab No
23759 @tab @samp{-}
23760 @tab Yes
23761
23762 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
23763 @tab No
23764 @tab @samp{-}
23765 @tab Yes
23766
23767 @end multitable
23768
23769 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
23770
23771 @table @samp
23772 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
23773 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
23774 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
23775 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
23776 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
23777 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
23778 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
23779 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
23780 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
23781 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
23782
23783 @item qXfer:auxv:read
23784 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
23785 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
23786
23787 @end table
23788
23789 @item qSymbol::
23790 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
23791 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
23792 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
23793 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
23794
23795 Reply:
23796 @table @samp
23797 @item OK
23798 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23799 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23800 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
23801 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
23802 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
23803 below.
23804 @end table
23805
23806 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
23807 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
23808
23809 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
23810 target has previously requested.
23811
23812 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
23813 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
23814 will be empty.
23815
23816 Reply:
23817 @table @samp
23818 @item OK
23819 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23820 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23821 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
23822 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
23823 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
23824 @end table
23825
23826 @item QTDP
23827 @itemx QTFrame
23828 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23829
23830 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
23831 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
23832 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
23833 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
23834 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
23835 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
23836 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
23837 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
23838 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
23839 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
23840
23841 Reply:
23842 @table @samp
23843 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23844 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
23845 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
23846 the thread's attributes.
23847 @end table
23848
23849 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
23850 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23851 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23852 packets.)
23853
23854 @item QTStart
23855 @itemx QTStop
23856 @itemx QTinit
23857 @itemx QTro
23858 @itemx qTStatus
23859 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23860
23861 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
23862 @cindex read special object, remote request
23863 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
23864 @anchor{qXfer read}
23865 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
23866 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
23867 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
23868 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to the object; it can supply
23869 additional details about what data to access.
23870
23871 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
23872 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
23873 formats, listed below.
23874
23875 @table @samp
23876 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
23877 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
23878 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
23879 auxiliary vector}, and @ref{Remote configuration,
23880 read-aux-vector-packet}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
23881
23882 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23883 by suppling an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23884 @end table
23885
23886 @table @samp
23887 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
23888 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
23889 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory map format}. The
23890 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
23891 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
23892
23893 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23894 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23895 @end table
23896
23897 Reply:
23898 @table @samp
23899 @item m @var{data}
23900 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
23901 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
23902 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
23903 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
23904 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
23905 request.
23906
23907 @item l @var{data}
23908 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
23909 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
23910 than the @var{length} in the request.
23911
23912 @item l
23913 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
23914 There is no more data to be read.
23915
23916 @item E00
23917 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
23918
23919 @item E @var{nn}
23920 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
23921 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
23922
23923 @item
23924 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
23925 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
23926 @end table
23927
23928 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
23929 @cindex write data into object, remote request
23930 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
23931 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
23932 into the data. @samp{@var{data}@dots{}} is the binary-encoded data
23933 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
23934 is specific to the object; it can supply additional details about what data
23935 to access.
23936
23937 No requests of this form are presently in use. This specification
23938 serves as a placeholder to document the common format that new
23939 specific request specifications ought to use.
23940
23941 Reply:
23942 @table @samp
23943 @item @var{nn}
23944 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
23945 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
23946
23947 @item E00
23948 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
23949
23950 @item E @var{nn}
23951 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
23952 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
23953
23954 @item
23955 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
23956 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
23957 @end table
23958
23959 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
23960 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
23961 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
23962 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
23963 must respond with an empty packet.
23964
23965 @end table
23966
23967 @node Register Packet Format
23968 @section Register Packet Format
23969
23970 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
23971 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
23972 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
23973 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
23974 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
23975 most-significant - least-significant.
23976
23977 @table @r
23978
23979 @item MIPS32
23980
23981 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
23982 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
23983 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
23984
23985 @item MIPS64
23986
23987 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
23988 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
23989 as @code{MIPS32}.
23990
23991 @end table
23992
23993 @node Tracepoint Packets
23994 @section Tracepoint Packets
23995 @cindex tracepoint packets
23996 @cindex packets, tracepoint
23997
23998 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
23999 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
24000
24001 @table @samp
24002
24003 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
24004 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
24005 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
24006 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
24007 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
24008 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
24009 tracepoint's actions.
24010
24011 Replies:
24012 @table @samp
24013 @item OK
24014 The packet was understood and carried out.
24015 @item
24016 The packet was not recognized.
24017 @end table
24018
24019 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
24020 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
24021 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
24022 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
24023 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
24024 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
24025 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
24026
24027 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
24028 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
24029 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
24030 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
24031 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
24032 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
24033 tracepoint actions.
24034
24035 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
24036 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
24037 following forms:
24038
24039 @table @samp
24040
24041 @item R @var{mask}
24042 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
24043 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
24044 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
24045 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
24046 not fit in a 32-bit word.
24047
24048 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
24049 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
24050 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
24051 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
24052 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
24053 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
24054 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
24055
24056 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
24057 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
24058 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
24059 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
24060 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
24061 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
24062 packet).
24063
24064 @end table
24065
24066 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
24067 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
24068 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
24069 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
24070 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
24071 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
24072 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
24073 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
24074
24075 Replies:
24076 @table @samp
24077 @item OK
24078 The packet was understood and carried out.
24079 @item
24080 The packet was not recognized.
24081 @end table
24082
24083 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
24084 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
24085 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
24086 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
24087
24088 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
24089 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
24090 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
24091 one of the following forms:
24092
24093 @table @samp
24094 @item F @var{f}
24095 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
24096 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
24097 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
24098
24099 @item T @var{t}
24100 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
24101 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
24102
24103 @end table
24104
24105 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
24106 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24107 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
24108 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
24109
24110 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
24111 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24112 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
24113 is a hexadecimal number.
24114
24115 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
24116 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24117 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
24118 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
24119 numbers.
24120
24121 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
24122 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
24123 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
24124
24125 @item QTStart
24126 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
24127 hits in the trace frame buffer.
24128
24129 @item QTStop
24130 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
24131
24132 @item QTinit
24133 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
24134
24135 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
24136 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
24137 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
24138 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
24139
24140 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
24141 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
24142 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
24143 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
24144
24145 @item qTStatus
24146 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
24147
24148 Replies:
24149 @table @samp
24150 @item T0
24151 There is no trace experiment running.
24152 @item T1
24153 There is a trace experiment running.
24154 @end table
24155
24156 @end table
24157
24158
24159 @node Interrupts
24160 @section Interrupts
24161 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
24162
24163 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
24164 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
24165 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
24166 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
24167
24168 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
24169 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
24170 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
24171 interfaces.
24172
24173 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
24174 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
24175 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
24176 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
24177 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
24178 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
24179 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
24180 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
24181
24182 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
24183 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
24184 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
24185 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
24186 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
24187 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
24188 program is stopped will be discarded.
24189
24190 @node Examples
24191 @section Examples
24192
24193 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
24194 does not get any direct output:
24195
24196 @smallexample
24197 -> @code{R00}
24198 <- @code{+}
24199 @emph{target restarts}
24200 -> @code{?}
24201 <- @code{+}
24202 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24203 -> @code{+}
24204 @end smallexample
24205
24206 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
24207
24208 @smallexample
24209 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
24210 <- @code{+}
24211 -> @code{s}
24212 <- @code{+}
24213 @emph{time passes}
24214 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24215 -> @code{+}
24216 -> @code{g}
24217 <- @code{+}
24218 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
24219 -> @code{+}
24220 @end smallexample
24221
24222 @node File-I/O remote protocol extension
24223 @section File-I/O remote protocol extension
24224 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
24225
24226 @menu
24227 * File-I/O Overview::
24228 * Protocol basics::
24229 * The F request packet::
24230 * The F reply packet::
24231 * The Ctrl-C message::
24232 * Console I/O::
24233 * List of supported calls::
24234 * Protocol specific representation of datatypes::
24235 * Constants::
24236 * File-I/O Examples::
24237 @end menu
24238
24239 @node File-I/O Overview
24240 @subsection File-I/O Overview
24241 @cindex file-i/o overview
24242
24243 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
24244 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
24245 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
24246 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
24247 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
24248 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
24249
24250 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
24251 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
24252 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
24253 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
24254 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
24255
24256 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
24257 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24258 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
24259 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
24260 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
24261 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
24262 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
24263
24264 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
24265 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
24266 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
24267 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
24268 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
24269
24270 @smallexample
24271 (@value{GDBP}) continue
24272 <- target requests 'system call X'
24273 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
24274 -> GDB returns result
24275 ... target continues, GDB returns to wait for the target
24276 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
24277 @end smallexample
24278
24279 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
24280 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
24281 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
24282 system are not supported by this protocol.
24283
24284 @node Protocol basics
24285 @subsection Protocol basics
24286 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
24287
24288 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
24289 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
24290 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
24291 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
24292 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
24293 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
24294 to call the appropriate host system call:
24295
24296 @itemize @bullet
24297 @item
24298 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
24299
24300 @item
24301 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
24302 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
24303 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
24304 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol specific representation.
24305
24306 @end itemize
24307
24308 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
24309
24310 @itemize @bullet
24311 @item
24312 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
24313 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
24314 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
24315 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
24316 packet.
24317
24318 @item
24319 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
24320 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
24321
24322 @item
24323 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
24324
24325 @item
24326 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
24327
24328 @item
24329 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
24330 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
24331 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
24332 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
24333 packet.
24334
24335 @end itemize
24336
24337 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
24338 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
24339
24340 @itemize @bullet
24341 @item
24342 Return value.
24343
24344 @item
24345 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
24346
24347 @item
24348 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
24349
24350 @end itemize
24351
24352 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
24353 the latest continue or step action.
24354
24355 @node The F request packet
24356 @subsection The @code{F} request packet
24357 @cindex file-i/o request packet
24358 @cindex @code{F} request packet
24359
24360 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
24361
24362 @table @samp
24363 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
24364
24365 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
24366 This is just the name of the function.
24367
24368 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
24369 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
24370 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
24371 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
24372 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
24373 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
24374 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
24375
24376 @end table
24377
24378
24379
24380 @node The F reply packet
24381 @subsection The @code{F} reply packet
24382 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
24383 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
24384
24385 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
24386
24387 @table @samp
24388
24389 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call specific attachment}
24390
24391 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
24392
24393 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol specific representation.
24394 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
24395
24396 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
24397 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
24398 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
24399
24400 @smallexample
24401 F0,0,C
24402 @end smallexample
24403
24404 @noindent
24405 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
24406
24407 @smallexample
24408 F-1,4,C
24409 @end smallexample
24410
24411 @noindent
24412 assuming 4 is the protocol specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
24413
24414 @end table
24415
24416
24417 @node The Ctrl-C message
24418 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} message
24419 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
24420
24421 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
24422 reply packet (@pxref{The F reply packet}),
24423 the target should behave as if it had
24424 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
24425 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
24426 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
24427 packet.
24428
24429 It's important for the target to know in which
24430 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
24431
24432 @itemize @bullet
24433 @item
24434 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
24435
24436 @item
24437 The system call on the host has been finished.
24438
24439 @end itemize
24440
24441 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
24442 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
24443 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
24444 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
24445 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
24446 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
24447
24448 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
24449 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
24450 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
24451 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
24452 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
24453 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
24454 or the full action has been completed.
24455
24456 @node Console I/O
24457 @subsection Console I/O
24458 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
24459
24460 By default and if not explicitely closed by the target system, the file
24461 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
24462 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
24463 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
24464 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
24465 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
24466 conditions is met:
24467
24468 @itemize @bullet
24469 @item
24470 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
24471 @code{read}
24472 system call is treated as finished.
24473
24474 @item
24475 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
24476 newline.
24477
24478 @item
24479 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
24480 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
24481
24482 @end itemize
24483
24484 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
24485 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
24486 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
24487 is stopped at the user's request.
24488
24489
24490 @node List of supported calls
24491 @subsection List of supported calls
24492 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
24493
24494 @menu
24495 * open::
24496 * close::
24497 * read::
24498 * write::
24499 * lseek::
24500 * rename::
24501 * unlink::
24502 * stat/fstat::
24503 * gettimeofday::
24504 * isatty::
24505 * system::
24506 @end menu
24507
24508 @node open
24509 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
24510 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
24511
24512 @table @asis
24513 @item Synopsis:
24514 @smallexample
24515 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
24516 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
24517 @end smallexample
24518
24519 @item Request:
24520 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
24521
24522 @noindent
24523 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24524
24525 @table @code
24526 @item O_CREAT
24527 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
24528 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
24529 are concerned.
24530
24531 @item O_EXCL
24532 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
24533 an error and open() fails.
24534
24535 @item O_TRUNC
24536 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
24537 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
24538 truncated to zero length.
24539
24540 @item O_APPEND
24541 The file is opened in append mode.
24542
24543 @item O_RDONLY
24544 The file is opened for reading only.
24545
24546 @item O_WRONLY
24547 The file is opened for writing only.
24548
24549 @item O_RDWR
24550 The file is opened for reading and writing.
24551 @end table
24552
24553 @noindent
24554 Other bits are silently ignored.
24555
24556
24557 @noindent
24558 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24559
24560 @table @code
24561 @item S_IRUSR
24562 User has read permission.
24563
24564 @item S_IWUSR
24565 User has write permission.
24566
24567 @item S_IRGRP
24568 Group has read permission.
24569
24570 @item S_IWGRP
24571 Group has write permission.
24572
24573 @item S_IROTH
24574 Others have read permission.
24575
24576 @item S_IWOTH
24577 Others have write permission.
24578 @end table
24579
24580 @noindent
24581 Other bits are silently ignored.
24582
24583
24584 @item Return value:
24585 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
24586 occurred.
24587
24588 @item Errors:
24589
24590 @table @code
24591 @item EEXIST
24592 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
24593
24594 @item EISDIR
24595 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
24596
24597 @item EACCES
24598 The requested access is not allowed.
24599
24600 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24601 @var{pathname} was too long.
24602
24603 @item ENOENT
24604 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24605
24606 @item ENODEV
24607 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
24608
24609 @item EROFS
24610 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
24611 write access was requested.
24612
24613 @item EFAULT
24614 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
24615
24616 @item ENOSPC
24617 No space on device to create the file.
24618
24619 @item EMFILE
24620 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
24621
24622 @item ENFILE
24623 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
24624 has been reached.
24625
24626 @item EINTR
24627 The call was interrupted by the user.
24628 @end table
24629
24630 @end table
24631
24632 @node close
24633 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
24634 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
24635
24636 @table @asis
24637 @item Synopsis:
24638 @smallexample
24639 int close(int fd);
24640 @end smallexample
24641
24642 @item Request:
24643 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
24644
24645 @item Return value:
24646 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
24647
24648 @item Errors:
24649
24650 @table @code
24651 @item EBADF
24652 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
24653
24654 @item EINTR
24655 The call was interrupted by the user.
24656 @end table
24657
24658 @end table
24659
24660 @node read
24661 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
24662 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
24663
24664 @table @asis
24665 @item Synopsis:
24666 @smallexample
24667 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
24668 @end smallexample
24669
24670 @item Request:
24671 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24672
24673 @item Return value:
24674 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
24675 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
24676 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
24677
24678 @item Errors:
24679
24680 @table @code
24681 @item EBADF
24682 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24683 reading.
24684
24685 @item EFAULT
24686 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24687
24688 @item EINTR
24689 The call was interrupted by the user.
24690 @end table
24691
24692 @end table
24693
24694 @node write
24695 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
24696 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
24697
24698 @table @asis
24699 @item Synopsis:
24700 @smallexample
24701 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
24702 @end smallexample
24703
24704 @item Request:
24705 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24706
24707 @item Return value:
24708 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
24709 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
24710 is returned.
24711
24712 @item Errors:
24713
24714 @table @code
24715 @item EBADF
24716 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24717 writing.
24718
24719 @item EFAULT
24720 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24721
24722 @item EFBIG
24723 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
24724 host specific maximum file size allowed.
24725
24726 @item ENOSPC
24727 No space on device to write the data.
24728
24729 @item EINTR
24730 The call was interrupted by the user.
24731 @end table
24732
24733 @end table
24734
24735 @node lseek
24736 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
24737 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
24738
24739 @table @asis
24740 @item Synopsis:
24741 @smallexample
24742 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
24743 @end smallexample
24744
24745 @item Request:
24746 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
24747
24748 @var{flag} is one of:
24749
24750 @table @code
24751 @item SEEK_SET
24752 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
24753
24754 @item SEEK_CUR
24755 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
24756 bytes.
24757
24758 @item SEEK_END
24759 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
24760 bytes.
24761 @end table
24762
24763 @item Return value:
24764 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
24765 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
24766 value of -1 is returned.
24767
24768 @item Errors:
24769
24770 @table @code
24771 @item EBADF
24772 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
24773
24774 @item ESPIPE
24775 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
24776
24777 @item EINVAL
24778 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
24779
24780 @item EINTR
24781 The call was interrupted by the user.
24782 @end table
24783
24784 @end table
24785
24786 @node rename
24787 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
24788 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
24789
24790 @table @asis
24791 @item Synopsis:
24792 @smallexample
24793 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
24794 @end smallexample
24795
24796 @item Request:
24797 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
24798
24799 @item Return value:
24800 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24801
24802 @item Errors:
24803
24804 @table @code
24805 @item EISDIR
24806 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
24807 directory.
24808
24809 @item EEXIST
24810 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
24811
24812 @item EBUSY
24813 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
24814 process.
24815
24816 @item EINVAL
24817 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
24818 of itself.
24819
24820 @item ENOTDIR
24821 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
24822 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
24823 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
24824
24825 @item EFAULT
24826 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
24827
24828 @item EACCES
24829 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24830
24831 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24832
24833 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
24834
24835 @item ENOENT
24836 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
24837
24838 @item EROFS
24839 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24840
24841 @item ENOSPC
24842 The device containing the file has no room for the new
24843 directory entry.
24844
24845 @item EINTR
24846 The call was interrupted by the user.
24847 @end table
24848
24849 @end table
24850
24851 @node unlink
24852 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
24853 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
24854
24855 @table @asis
24856 @item Synopsis:
24857 @smallexample
24858 int unlink(const char *pathname);
24859 @end smallexample
24860
24861 @item Request:
24862 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
24863
24864 @item Return value:
24865 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24866
24867 @item Errors:
24868
24869 @table @code
24870 @item EACCES
24871 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24872
24873 @item EPERM
24874 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
24875
24876 @item EBUSY
24877 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
24878 being used by another process.
24879
24880 @item EFAULT
24881 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24882
24883 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24884 @var{pathname} was too long.
24885
24886 @item ENOENT
24887 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24888
24889 @item ENOTDIR
24890 A component of the path is not a directory.
24891
24892 @item EROFS
24893 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24894
24895 @item EINTR
24896 The call was interrupted by the user.
24897 @end table
24898
24899 @end table
24900
24901 @node stat/fstat
24902 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
24903 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
24904 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
24905
24906 @table @asis
24907 @item Synopsis:
24908 @smallexample
24909 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
24910 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
24911 @end smallexample
24912
24913 @item Request:
24914 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
24915 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
24916
24917 @item Return value:
24918 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24919
24920 @item Errors:
24921
24922 @table @code
24923 @item EBADF
24924 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
24925
24926 @item ENOENT
24927 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
24928 path is an empty string.
24929
24930 @item ENOTDIR
24931 A component of the path is not a directory.
24932
24933 @item EFAULT
24934 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24935
24936 @item EACCES
24937 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24938
24939 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24940 @var{pathname} was too long.
24941
24942 @item EINTR
24943 The call was interrupted by the user.
24944 @end table
24945
24946 @end table
24947
24948 @node gettimeofday
24949 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
24950 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
24951
24952 @table @asis
24953 @item Synopsis:
24954 @smallexample
24955 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
24956 @end smallexample
24957
24958 @item Request:
24959 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
24960
24961 @item Return value:
24962 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
24963
24964 @item Errors:
24965
24966 @table @code
24967 @item EINVAL
24968 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
24969
24970 @item EFAULT
24971 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24972 @end table
24973
24974 @end table
24975
24976 @node isatty
24977 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
24978 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
24979
24980 @table @asis
24981 @item Synopsis:
24982 @smallexample
24983 int isatty(int fd);
24984 @end smallexample
24985
24986 @item Request:
24987 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
24988
24989 @item Return value:
24990 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
24991
24992 @item Errors:
24993
24994 @table @code
24995 @item EINTR
24996 The call was interrupted by the user.
24997 @end table
24998
24999 @end table
25000
25001 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
25002 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
25003 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
25004 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
25005 needed.
25006
25007
25008 @node system
25009 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
25010 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
25011
25012 @table @asis
25013 @item Synopsis:
25014 @smallexample
25015 int system(const char *command);
25016 @end smallexample
25017
25018 @item Request:
25019 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
25020
25021 @item Return value:
25022 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
25023 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
25024 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
25025 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
25026 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
25027 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
25028 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
25029
25030 @item Errors:
25031
25032 @table @code
25033 @item EINTR
25034 The call was interrupted by the user.
25035 @end table
25036
25037 @end table
25038
25039 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
25040 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
25041 the host is simplified before it's returned
25042 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
25043 is discarded, and the return value consists
25044 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
25045
25046 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
25047 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
25048 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
25049
25050 @table @code
25051 @item set remote system-call-allowed
25052 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
25053 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
25054 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
25055
25056 @item show remote system-call-allowed
25057 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
25058 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
25059 protocol.
25060 @end table
25061
25062 @node Protocol specific representation of datatypes
25063 @subsection Protocol specific representation of datatypes
25064 @cindex protocol specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25065
25066 @menu
25067 * Integral datatypes::
25068 * Pointer values::
25069 * Memory transfer::
25070 * struct stat::
25071 * struct timeval::
25072 @end menu
25073
25074 @node Integral datatypes
25075 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral datatypes
25076 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25077
25078 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
25079 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
25080 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
25081
25082 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
25083 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
25084
25085 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
25086
25087 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
25088 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
25089
25090 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
25091
25092 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
25093 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
25094 byte order.
25095
25096 @node Pointer values
25097 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer values
25098 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
25099
25100 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
25101 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
25102 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
25103 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
25104
25105 @smallexample
25106 @code{1aaf/12}
25107 @end smallexample
25108
25109 @noindent
25110 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
25111 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
25112 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
25113 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
25114
25115 @smallexample
25116 @code{123456/d}
25117 @end smallexample
25118
25119 @node Memory transfer
25120 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory transfer
25121 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
25122
25123 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
25124 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol specific format
25125 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
25126 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
25127 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
25128 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
25129 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
25130
25131
25132 @node struct stat
25133 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
25134 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
25135
25136 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
25137 is defined as follows:
25138
25139 @smallexample
25140 struct stat @{
25141 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
25142 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
25143 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
25144 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
25145 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
25146 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
25147 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
25148 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
25149 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
25150 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
25151 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
25152 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
25153 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
25154 @};
25155 @end smallexample
25156
25157 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25158 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
25159 structure is of size 64 bytes.
25160
25161 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
25162 range of values.
25163
25164 @table @code
25165
25166 @item st_dev
25167 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
25168
25169 @item st_ino
25170 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25171
25172 @item st_mode
25173 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
25174 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
25175
25176 @item st_uid
25177 @itemx st_gid
25178 @itemx st_rdev
25179 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25180
25181 @item st_atime
25182 @itemx st_mtime
25183 @itemx st_ctime
25184 These values have a host and file system dependent
25185 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
25186 support exact timing values.
25187 @end table
25188
25189 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
25190 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
25191 continuing.
25192
25193 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
25194 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
25195 get truncated on the target.
25196
25197 @node struct timeval
25198 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
25199 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
25200
25201 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
25202 is defined as follows:
25203
25204 @smallexample
25205 struct timeval @{
25206 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
25207 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
25208 @};
25209 @end smallexample
25210
25211 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25212 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
25213 structure is of size 8 bytes.
25214
25215 @node Constants
25216 @subsection Constants
25217 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
25218
25219 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
25220 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
25221 values before and after the call as needed.
25222
25223 @menu
25224 * Open flags::
25225 * mode_t values::
25226 * Errno values::
25227 * Lseek flags::
25228 * Limits::
25229 @end menu
25230
25231 @node Open flags
25232 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open flags
25233 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
25234
25235 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
25236
25237 @smallexample
25238 O_RDONLY 0x0
25239 O_WRONLY 0x1
25240 O_RDWR 0x2
25241 O_APPEND 0x8
25242 O_CREAT 0x200
25243 O_TRUNC 0x400
25244 O_EXCL 0x800
25245 @end smallexample
25246
25247 @node mode_t values
25248 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t values
25249 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
25250
25251 All values are given in octal representation.
25252
25253 @smallexample
25254 S_IFREG 0100000
25255 S_IFDIR 040000
25256 S_IRUSR 0400
25257 S_IWUSR 0200
25258 S_IXUSR 0100
25259 S_IRGRP 040
25260 S_IWGRP 020
25261 S_IXGRP 010
25262 S_IROTH 04
25263 S_IWOTH 02
25264 S_IXOTH 01
25265 @end smallexample
25266
25267 @node Errno values
25268 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno values
25269 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
25270
25271 All values are given in decimal representation.
25272
25273 @smallexample
25274 EPERM 1
25275 ENOENT 2
25276 EINTR 4
25277 EBADF 9
25278 EACCES 13
25279 EFAULT 14
25280 EBUSY 16
25281 EEXIST 17
25282 ENODEV 19
25283 ENOTDIR 20
25284 EISDIR 21
25285 EINVAL 22
25286 ENFILE 23
25287 EMFILE 24
25288 EFBIG 27
25289 ENOSPC 28
25290 ESPIPE 29
25291 EROFS 30
25292 ENAMETOOLONG 91
25293 EUNKNOWN 9999
25294 @end smallexample
25295
25296 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
25297 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
25298
25299 @node Lseek flags
25300 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek flags
25301 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
25302
25303 @smallexample
25304 SEEK_SET 0
25305 SEEK_CUR 1
25306 SEEK_END 2
25307 @end smallexample
25308
25309 @node Limits
25310 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
25311 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
25312
25313 All values are given in decimal representation.
25314
25315 @smallexample
25316 INT_MIN -2147483648
25317 INT_MAX 2147483647
25318 UINT_MAX 4294967295
25319 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
25320 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
25321 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
25322 @end smallexample
25323
25324 @node File-I/O Examples
25325 @subsection File-I/O Examples
25326 @cindex file-i/o examples
25327
25328 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25329 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
25330
25331 @smallexample
25332 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
25333 @emph{request memory read from target}
25334 -> @code{m1234,6}
25335 <- XXXXXX
25336 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
25337 -> @code{F6}
25338 @end smallexample
25339
25340 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25341 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
25342
25343 @smallexample
25344 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25345 @emph{request memory write to target}
25346 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25347 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
25348 -> @code{F6}
25349 @end smallexample
25350
25351 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
25352 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
25353
25354 @smallexample
25355 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25356 -> @code{F-1,9}
25357 @end smallexample
25358
25359 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
25360 host is called:
25361
25362 @smallexample
25363 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25364 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
25365 <- @code{T02}
25366 @end smallexample
25367
25368 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
25369 host is called:
25370
25371 @smallexample
25372 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25373 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25374 <- @code{T02}
25375 @end smallexample
25376
25377 @node Memory map format
25378 @section Memory map format
25379 @cindex memory map format
25380
25381 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
25382 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
25383 memory map.
25384
25385 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
25386 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
25387 lists memory regions. The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
25388
25389 @smallexample
25390 <?xml version="1.0"?>
25391 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
25392 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
25393 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
25394 <memory-map>
25395 region...
25396 </memory-map>
25397 @end smallexample
25398
25399 Each region can be either:
25400
25401 @itemize
25402
25403 @item
25404 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
25405 bytes from there:
25406
25407 @smallexample
25408 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25409 @end smallexample
25410
25411
25412 @item
25413 A region of read-only memory:
25414
25415 @smallexample
25416 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25417 @end smallexample
25418
25419
25420 @item
25421 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
25422 bytes in length:
25423
25424 @smallexample
25425 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
25426 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
25427 </memory>
25428 @end smallexample
25429
25430 @end itemize
25431
25432 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
25433 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
25434 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
25435
25436 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
25437
25438 @smallexample
25439 <!-- ................................................... -->
25440 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
25441 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
25442 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
25443 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
25444 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
25445 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
25446 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
25447 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
25448 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
25449 and its type, or device. -->
25450 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
25451 start CDATA #REQUIRED
25452 length CDATA #REQUIRED
25453 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
25454 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
25455 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
25456 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
25457 @end smallexample
25458
25459 @include agentexpr.texi
25460
25461 @include gpl.texi
25462
25463 @raisesections
25464 @include fdl.texi
25465 @lowersections
25466
25467 @node Index
25468 @unnumbered Index
25469
25470 @printindex cp
25471
25472 @tex
25473 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
25474 % meantime:
25475 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
25476 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
25477 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
25478 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
25479 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
25480 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
25481 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
25482 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
25483 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
25484 \page\colophon
25485 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
25486 @end tex
25487
25488 @bye
This page took 0.598297 seconds and 3 git commands to generate.